One of the best ways to enhance the enjoyment of your new vehicle is toread this manual. In it, you will learn how to operate its driving controls andconvenience items. Afterwards, keep this owner’s manual in your vehicle soyou can refer to it at any time.
Several warranties protect your new vehicle. Read the warranty bookletthoroughly so you understand the coverages and are aware of your rightsand responsibilities.
As you read this manual, you willfind information that is preceded bya symbol. Thisinformation is intended to help youavoid damage to your vehicle, otherproperty, or the environment.
Congratulations! Your selection of a 2010 Honda Insight was a wiseinvestment. It will give you years of driving pleasure.
Maintaining your vehicle according to the maintenance minder shown in theinstrument panel helps to keep your driving trouble-free while it preservesyour investment. When your vehicle needs maintenance, keep in mind thatyour dealer’s staff is specially trained in servicing the many systems uniqueto your vehicle. Your dealer is dedicated to your satisfaction and will bepleased to answer any questions and concerns.
Introduction
i
09/01/13 09:16:06 31TM8600 0002
2010 Insight
California Proposition 65 Warning
This product contains or emits chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birthdefects or other reproductive harm.
Event Data Recorders
This data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by anyone elseexcept as legally required or with the permission of the vehicle owner.
Service Diagnostic RecordersThis vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record information about powertrain performance. The datacan be used to verify emissions law requirements and/or help technicians diagnose and solve service problems. It mayalso be combined with data from other sources for research purposes, but it remains confidential.
Introduction
WARNING:
This vehicle is equipped with one or more devices commonly referred to as event data recorders. Thesedevices record front seat belt use, front passenger seat occupancy, airbag deployment data, and the failureof any airbag system component.
ii
08/12/27 11:26:12 31TM8600 0003
2010 Insight
-
-
-
-
-
-
To help you make informeddecisions about safety, we haveprovided operating procedures andother information on labels and inthis manual. This information alertsyou to potential hazards that couldhurt you or others.
You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,including:
preceded by a safety alert symbol and one ofthree signal words: , , or .These signal words mean:
such as Important Safety Reminders or ImportantSafety Precautions.
such as Driver and Passenger Safety.
This entire book is filled with important safety information please read itcarefully.
Your safety, and the safety of others,is very important. And operating thisvehicle safely is an importantresponsibility.
Of course, it is not practical orpossible to warn you about all thehazards associated with operating ormaintaining your vehicle. You mustuse your own good judgement.
on the vehicle.
how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.
Safety Messages
Safety Headings
Safety Section
Safety Labels
Instructions
A Few Words About Safety
DANGER WARNING CAUTION
iii
You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.
You CAN be HURT if you don’t followinstructions.
08/12/27 11:26:22 31TM8600 0004
2010 Insight
(seat belts, SRS, and child protection)
(fluid capacities and tire pressures)
(main controls)
(indicators, gauges, multi-information display, dashboard, and steering column)
(climate control, audio, steering wheel, security, cruise control, and other convenience items)
(fuel, vehicle break-in, and cargo loading)
(engine and transmission operation)
(minder, fluid checking, minor services, and vehicle storage)
(vehicle specifications, tires, and emissions controls)
(warranty and contact information)
(how to order)
(flat tire, jump starting, overheating, and fuses)
Contents
............................................................Driver and Passenger Safety . 5
................................................................................................................................................Index . I
Service Information Summary
...............................................................................................Your Vehicle at a Glance . 3
.......Instruments and Controls . 59
............Features . 159
.......................................................................Before Driving . 283
.........................................................................................Driving . 301
.................................................Maintenance . 335
..............................................Technical Information . 415
..................Warranty and Customer Relations (U.S. and Canada only) . 431
..................................................................................Authorized Manuals (U.S. only) . 435
........................................Taking Care of the Unexpected . 385
1
09/01/13 09:16:20 31TM8600 0006
00X31-TM8-6000 © 2009 American Honda Motor Co., Inc. - All Rights Reserved
2010 Insight Online Reference Owner's Manual
2010 Insight
Owner's Identification Form
A summary of the information youneed when you pull up to the fuelpump.
How to order manuals and othertechnical literature.
A convenient reference to thesections in this manual.
A quick reference to the maincontrols in your vehicle.
What gasoline to use, how to break-in your new vehicle, and how to loadluggage and other cargo.
The proper way to start the engine,shift the transmission, and park.
A summary of the warrantiescovering your new vehicle, and howto contact us for any reason. Refer toyour warranty manual for detailedinformation.
The maintenance minder shows youwhen you need to take your vehicleto the dealer for maintenance service.There is also a list of things to checkand instructions on how to checkthem.
ID numbers, dimensions, capacities,and technical information.
This section covers several problemsmotorists sometimes experience,and details how to handle them.
Important information about theproper use and care of your vehicle’sseat belts, an overview of thesupplemental restraint system, andvaluable information on how toprotect children with child restraints.
Explains the purpose of eachinstrument panel indicator and gauge,the multi-information display, andhow to use the controls on thedashboard and steering column.
How to operate the climate controlsystem, the audio system, and otherconvenience features.
Overview of Contents
Contents
Your Vehicle at a Glance
Driver and Passenger Safety
Instruments and Controls
Before Driving
Driving
Maintenance
Warranty and CustomerRelations(U.S. and Canada only)
Authorized Manuals(U.S. only)
Index
Service Information Summary
Technical Information
Taking Care of the Unexpected
Features
2
08/12/27 11:26:50 31TM8600 0007
2010 Insight
*
*
*
*
*
CONTINUEDIf equipped:
Your Vehicle at a GlanceY
ourV
ehicleata
Glance
3
DOOR LOCK TAB
ACCESSORY POWERSOCKET
ECON BUTTON
USB ADAPTER CABLE
MULTI-INFORMATIONDISPLAY
HAZARD WARNINGBUTTON
AUDIO SYSTEM
INSTRUMENT PANEL INDICATORS
(P.166)NAVIGATION SYSTEM(P.198)
PADDLE SHIFTERS(P.316)
GAUGES(P.72)
(P.287)
DRIVER’S FRONTAIRBAG(P.10)
MIRRORCONTROLS
(P.62)
PASSENGER’SFRONT AIRBAG(P.10)
CLIMATE CONTROLSYSTEM
POWER WINDOWSWITCHES
POWER DOOR LOCKMASTER SWITCH
HOOD RELEASEHANDLE
(P.144)
(P.130)
(P.130)
(P.146)
(P.124)
(P.153)
AUTOMATICTRANSMISSION(CVT)(P.311)
(P.122)(P.72, 75)
(P.183, 191)
(P.160)
08/12/27 11:26:57 31TM8600 0008
2010 Insight
***
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Only on vehicles equipped with navigation system. Refer to the navigation system manual.
To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel.1 :2 :3 :
If equipped.
Your Vehicle at a Glance
4
AUXILIARY INPUT JACK
NAVIGATION SYSTEM VOICECONTROL BUTTONS
REMOTE AUDIO CONTROLBUTTONS
ECON BUTTON
(P.251)
(P.73) (P.256)
AUDIO SYSTEM(P.166)
CLOCK(P.254)
NAVIGATION SYSTEM (P.198)
(P.252)
ACCESSORY POWERSOCKET(P.259)
(P.259)
HAZARD WARNING BUTTON
PASSENGER AIRBAGOFF INDICATOR
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER/HEATED MIRROR
BLUETOOTH HANDSFREELINKSYSTEM VOICE CONTROL BUTTONS
HEADLIGHTS/TURN SIGNALS
INSTRUMENT PANELBRIGHTNESS CONTROLKNOB
STEERING WHEELADJUSTMENT
MULTI-INFORMATIONBUTTONS
CRUISE CONTROL BUTTONSMULTI-INFORMATION BUTTONS
WINDSHIELD WIPERS/WASHERSHAZARD WARNINGBUTTON
VEHICLE STABILITYASSIST (VSA ) SYSTEMOFF SWITCH
KM/MILE CHANGE KNOB
HORN
(P.35)
AUXILIARY INPUT JACK (P.252)
(P.333)
MIRROR CONTROLS
(P.118)
(P.144)
(P.124)
(P.125)
(P.153)
(P.122)
(P.122)
(P.117)
(P.121)
(P.76)
(P.123/145)
(P.76)
2
3
2
2
2
3
2
3
2
2
2
2
1
2
08/12/27 11:27:07 31TM8600 0009
2010 Insight
-
This section gives you importantinformation about how to protectyourself and your passengers. Itshows you how to use seat belts. Itexplains how your airbags work. Andit tells you how to properly restraininfants and children in your vehicle.
.........Important Safety Precautions . 6.......Your Vehicle’s Safety Features . 8
.......................................Seat Belts . 9.........................................Airbags . 10
.........Protecting Adults and Teens . 12.....1. Close and Lock the Doors . 12
...........2. Adjust the Front Seats . 14............3. Adjust the Seat-Backs . 15
...4. Adjust the Head Restraints . 165. Fasten and Position the
.............................Seat Belts . 176. Maintain a Proper Sitting
................................Position . 18.....Advice for Pregnant Women . 19...Additional Safety Precautions . 20
Additional Information About.......................Your Seat Belts . 21
..Seat Belt System Components . 21......................Lap/Shoulder Belt . 22
Automatic Seat Belt...............................Tensioners . 23
...............Seat Belt Maintenance . 24Additional Information About
...........................Your Airbags . 25......Airbag System Components . 25
How Your Front Airbags.........................................Work . 28
...How Your Side Airbags Work . 32How Your Side Curtain Airbags
.........................................Work . 33..How the SRS Indicator Works . 34
How the Side Airbag Off......................Indicator Works . 34
How the Passenger Airbag Off......................Indicator Works . 35
.............................Airbag Service . 36...Additional Safety Precautions . 37
Protecting Children General................................Guidelines . 38
All Children Must Be...............................Restrained . 38
All Children Should Sit in a.................................Back Seat . 39
The Passenger’s Front Airbag.........Can Pose Serious Risks . 39
If You Must Drive with Several...................................Children . 41
If a Child Requires Close..................................Attention . 41
...Additional Safety Precautions . 42Protecting Infants and Small
...................................Children . 43.......................Protecting Infants . 43
.........Protecting Small Children . 44.....................Selecting a Child Seat . 45....................Installing a Child Seat . 46
...............................With LATCH . 47.........With a Lap/Shoulder Belt . 49
..............................With a Tether . 50...........Protecting Larger Children . 52
...............Checking Seat Belt Fit . 52..................Using a Booster Seat . 53
When Can a Larger Child Sit in.........................................Front . 54
...Additional Safety Precautions . 55.............Carbon Monoxide Hazard . 56
...................................Safety Labels . 57
Driver and Passenger SafetyD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
5
08/12/27 11:27:11 31TM8600 0010
2010 Insight
-
You’ll find many safetyrecommendations throughout thissection, and throughout this manual.The recommendations on this pageare the ones we consider to be themost important.
While airbags can save lives, theycan cause serious or fatal injuries tooccupants who sit too close to them,or are not properly restrained.Infants, young children, and shortadults are at the greatest risk. Besure to follow all instructions andwarnings in this manual.
Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Evenone drink can reduce your ability torespond to changing conditions, andyour reaction time gets worse withevery additional drink. So don’t drinkand drive, and don’t let your friendsdrink and drive, either.
A seat belt is your best protection inall types of collisions. Airbags aredesigned to supplement seat belts,not replace them. So even thoughyour vehicle is equipped with airbags,make sure you and your passengersalways wear your seat belts, andwear them properly (see page ).
Children age 12 and under shouldride properly restrained in a backseat, not the front seat. Infants andsmall children should be restrainedin a child seat. Larger childrenshould use a booster seat and a lap/shoulder belt until they can use thebelt properly without a booster seat(see pages ).
17
38 55
Important Safety Precautions
Be Aware of Airbag Hazards
Don’t Drink and DriveRestrain All Children
Always Wear Your Seat Belt
6
08/12/27 11:27:18 31TM8600 0011
2010 Insight
Engaging in mobile phoneconversation or other activities thatkeep you from paying close attentionto the road, other vehicles andpedestrians could lead to a crash.Remember, situations can changequickly, and only you can decidewhen it is safe to divert attentionaway from driving.
Excessive speed is a major factor incrash injuries and deaths. Generally,the higher the speed, the greater therisk, but serious injuries can alsooccur at lower speeds. Never drivefaster than is safe for currentconditions, regardless of themaximum speed posted.
Having a tire blowout or amechanical failure can be extremelyhazardous. To reduce the possibilityof such problems, check your tirepressures and condition frequently,and perform all regularly scheduledmaintenance (see page ).375
Pay Appropriate Attention to theTask of Driving Safely
Control Your Speed
Keep Your Vehicle in SafeCondition
Important Safety PrecautionsD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
7
08/12/27 11:27:24 31TM8600 0012
2010 Insight
Your vehicle is equipped with manyfeatures that work together toprotect you and your passengersduring a crash.
The following pages explain how youcan take an active role in protectingyourself and your passengers.
Some features do not require anyaction on your part. These include astrong steel framework that forms asafety cage around the passengercompartment, front and rear crushzones, a collapsible steering column,and tensioners that tighten the frontseat belts in a crash.
However, you and your passengerscan’t take full advantage of thesefeatures unless you remain sitting inthe correct position and
. In fact, some safetyfeatures can contribute to injuries ifthey are not used properly.
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
always wearyour seat belts
8
(2)
(6)
(4)
(7)(2)
(10)
(8)(12)
(5)
(11)
(1) (8) (3) (9) (9)
(1) Safety Cage(2) Crush Zone(3) Seats and Seat-Backs(4) Head Restraints(5) Collapsible Steering Column(6) Seat Belts(7) Front Airbags(8) Side Airbags(9) Side Curtain Airbags(10) Front Seat Belt Tensioners(11) Door Locks(12) Front Seat Belt Buckle Tensioners
08/12/27 11:27:31 31TM8600 0013
2010 Insight
----
Your vehicle is equipped with seatbelts in all seating positions.
Seat belts are the single mosteffective safety device for adults andlarger children. (Infants and smallerchildren must be properly restrainedin child seats.)
Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, eventhough your vehicle has airbags.
When properly worn, seat belts:
Keep you connected to the vehicleso you can take advantage of thevehicle’s built-in safety features.
Help keep you from being thrownagainst the inside of the vehicleand against other occupants.
Keep you from being thrown outof the vehicle.
Help keep you in a good positionshould the airbags ever deploy. Agood position reduces the risk ofinjury from an inflating airbag andallows you to get the bestadvantage from the airbag.
Of course, seat belts cannotcompletely protect you in everycrash. But in most cases, seat beltscan reduce your risk of seriousinjury.
Always wear your seat belt, andmake sure you wear it properly.
Your seat belt system also includesan indicator on the instrument paneland a beeper to remind you and yourpassengers to fasten your seat belts.
Help protect you in almost everytype of crash, including:
frontal impactsside impactsrear impactsrollovers
In addition, most states and allCanadian provinces and territoriesrequire you to wear seat belts.
Seat Belts
Why Wear Seat Belts
What You Should Do:
Your Vehicle’s Safety FeaturesD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
9
Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, eventhough your vehicle has airbags.
Be sure you and yourpassengers always wear seatbelts and wear them properly.
08/12/27 11:27:42 31TM8600 0014
2010 Insight
Your vehicle has a supplementalrestraint system (SRS) with frontairbags to help protect the heads andchests of the driver and a front seatpassenger during a moderate tosevere frontal collision (see page
for more information on howyour front airbags work).
Your vehicle also has side airbags tohelp protect the upper torso of thedriver or a front seat passengerduring a moderate to severe sideimpact (see page for moreinformation on how your side airbagswork).
In addition, your vehicle has sidecurtain airbags to help protect theheads of the driver, front passenger,and passengers in the outer rearseating positions during a moderateto severe side or front impact (seepage for more information on howyour side curtain airbags work).
28
32
33
Airbags
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
10
08/12/27 11:27:49 31TM8600 0015
2010 Insight
The most important things you needto know about your airbags are:
They are designed to supplementthe seat belts.
To dotheir job, airbags must inflate withtremendous force. So whileairbags help save lives, they cancause minor injuries or moreserious or even fatal injuries ifoccupants are not properlyrestrained or sitting properly.
Always wearyour seat belt properly, and situpright and as far back from thesteering wheel as possible whileallowing full control of the vehicle. Afront passenger should move theirseat as far back from the dashboardas possible.
The rest of this section gives moredetailed information about how youcan maximize your safety.
Remember, however, that no safetysystem can prevent all injuries ordeaths that can occur in a severecrash, even when seat belts areproperly worn and the airbags deploy.
Airbags do not replace seat belts.
Airbags offer no protection in rearimpacts, or minor frontal or sidecollisions.
Airbags can pose hazards.
What you should do:
Your Vehicle’s Safety FeaturesD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
11
08/12/27 11:27:55 31TM8600 0016
2010 Insight
-See pages for importantguidelines on how to properlyprotect infants, small children, andlarger children who ride in yourvehicle.
The following pages provideinstructions on how to properlyprotect the driver, adult passengers,and teenage children who are largeenough and mature enough to driveor ride in the front.
Your vehicle has a door/hatch open indicator (red)
on the instrument panel to indicatewhen any door or the hatch is nottightly closed.
See page for how to lock thedoors, and page for how the door/hatch open indicator works.
Your vehicle also has a door andhatch open indicator on the multi-information display to indicate whena specific door or the hatch is nottightly closed. You will see theappropriate indicator(s) for eachcondition.
You will also hear a beep when youturn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position, and each time you openany door or the hatch with the key inthe ON (II) position.
The above illustration shows that alldoors and the hatch are open.
After everyone has entered thevehicle, be sure the doors and thehatch are closed and locked.
38 55
68130
Introduction Close and Lock the Doors1.
Protecting Adults and Teens
12
08/12/27 11:28:04 31TM8600 0017
2010 Insight
Locking the doors reduces thechance of someone being thrown outof the vehicle during a crash, and ithelps prevent passengers fromaccidentally opening a door andfalling out.
Your vehicle has the auto doorlocking/unlocking feature. For moreinformation, see page .
Locking the doors and the hatch alsohelps prevent an outsider fromunexpectedly opening a door or thehatch when you come to a stop.
When one or more doors or thehatch are not tightly closed, thecorresponding indicator for eachcondition will come on.
The above example shows the frontright and rear left doors, and thehatch open.
When the hatch is not tightly closed,this indicator will come on. 106
Protecting Adults and TeensD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
13
08/12/27 11:28:11 31TM8600 0018
2010 Insight
Adjust the driver’s seat as far to therear as possible while allowing you tomaintain full control of the vehicle.Have a front passenger adjust theirseat as far to the rear as possible.
If you sit too close to the steeringwheel or dashboard, you can beseriously injured by an inflating frontairbag, or by striking the steeringwheel or dashboard.
The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that driversallow at least 10 inches (25 cm)between the center of the steeringwheel and the chest. In addition toadjusting the seat, you can adjust thesteering wheel up and down, and inand out (see page ).
If you cannot get far enough awayfrom the steering wheel and stillreach the controls, we recommendthat you investigate whether sometype of adaptive equipment may help.
Once a seat is adjusted correctly,rock it back and forth to make sure itis locked in position.
See page for how to adjust thefront seats.
125138
Adjust the Front Seats2.
Protecting Adults and Teens
14
Sitting too close to a frontairbag can result in seriousinjury or death if the frontairbags inflate.
Always sit as far back from thefront airbags as possible.
08/12/27 11:28:17 31TM8600 0019
2010 Insight
Adjust the driver’s seat-back to acomfortable, upright position,leaving ample space between yourchest and the airbag cover in thecenter of the steering wheel.
Passengers with adjustable seat-backs should also adjust their seat-back to a comfortable, uprightposition.
Reclining a seat-back so that theshoulder part of the belt no longerrests against the occupant’s chestreduces the protective capability ofthe belt. It also increases the chanceof sliding under the belt in a crashand being seriously injured. Thefarther a seat-back is reclined, thegreater the risk of injury.
See page for how to adjust theseat-backs.
138
Adjust the Seat-Backs3.
Protecting Adults and TeensD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
15
Reclining the seat-back too farcan result in serious injury ordeath in a crash.
Adjust the seat-back to anupright position, and sit wellback in the seat.
08/12/27 11:28:24 31TM8600 0020
2010 Insight
Adjust the driver’s head restraint sothe center of the back of your headrests against the center of therestraint.
Have passengers adjust their headrestraints properly as well. Tallerpersons should adjust their restraintas high as possible.
Properly adjusted head restraintswill help protect occupants fromwhiplash and other crash injuries.
See page for how to adjust thehead restraints and how the driver’sand front passenger’s active headrestraints work.
139
Adjust the Head Restraints4.
Protecting Adults and Teens
16
Improperly positioning headrestraints reduces theireffectiveness, and you can beseriously injured in a crash.
Make sure head restraints arein place and positioned properlybefore driving.
08/12/27 11:28:30 31TM8600 0021
2010 Insight
Position the lap part of the belt aslow as possible across your hips,then pull up on the shoulder part ofthe belt so the lap part fits snugly.This lets your strong pelvic bonestake the force of a crash and reducesthe chance of internal injuries.
Insert the latch plate into the buckle,then tug on the belt to make sure thebelt is securely latched. Check thatthe belt is not twisted, because atwisted belt can cause seriousinjuries in a crash.
If the seat belt touches or crossesyour neck, or if it crosses your arminstead of your shoulder, you need toadjust the seat belt anchor height.
If necessary, pull up on the belt againto remove any slack, then check thatthe belt rests across the center ofyour chest and over your shoulder.
This spreads the forces of a crashover the strongest bones in yourupper body.
CONTINUED
Fasten and Position the SeatBelts
5.
Protecting Adults and TeensD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
17
Improperly positioning the seatbelts can cause serious injuryor death in a crash.
Make sure all seat belts areproperly positioned beforedriving.
08/12/27 11:28:37 31TM8600 0022
2010 Insight
This could causevery serious injuries in a crash.
If a seat belt does not seem to workproperly, it may not protect theoccupant in a crash.
Using a seatbelt that is not working properly canresult in serious injury or death.Have your dealer check the belt assoon as possible.
See page for additionalinformation about your seat beltsand how to take care of them.
Sitting improperly can increase thechance of injury during a crash. Forexample, if an occupant slouches,lies down, turns sideways, sitsforward, leans forward or sideways,or puts one or both feet up, thechance of injury during a crash isgreatly increased.
The front seats have adjustable seatbelt anchors. To adjust the height ofan anchor, squeeze the two releasebuttons, and slide the anchor up ordown as needed (it has fourpositions).
After all occupants have adjustedtheir seats and head restraints, andput on their seat belts, it is veryimportant that they continue to situpright, well back in their seats, withtheir feet on the floor, until thevehicle is safely parked and theengine is off.
21
Maintain a Proper SittingPosition
6.Never place the shoulder portion of alap/shoulder belt under your arm orbehind your back.
No one should sit in a seat with aninoperative seat belt.
Protecting Adults and Teens
18
RELEASE BUTTONS
08/12/27 11:28:44 31TM8600 0023
2010 Insight
If you are pregnant, the best way toprotect yourself and your unbornchild when driving or riding in avehicle is to always wear a seat belt,and keep the lap part of the belt aslow as possible across the hips.
When driving, remember to situpright and adjust the seat as farback as possible while allowing fullcontrol of the vehicle. When ridingas a front passenger, adjust the seatas far back as possible.
This will reduce the risk of injuriesto both you and your unborn childthat can be caused by a crash or aninflating front airbag.
Each time you have a checkup, askyour doctor if it’s okay for you todrive.
In addition, an occupant who is out ofposition in the front seat can beseriously or fatally injured in a crashby striking interior parts of thevehicle or being struck by aninflating front airbag.
Advice for Pregnant Women
Protecting Adults and TeensD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
19
Sitting improperly or out ofposition can result in seriousinjury or death in a crash.
Always sit upright, well back inthe seat, with your feet on thefloor.
08/12/27 11:28:51 31TM8600 0024
2010 Insight
Carrying hard or sharpobjects on your lap, or driving witha pipe or other sharp object inyour mouth, can result in injuriesif your front airbag inflates.
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.
Devices intended to improveoccupant comfort or reposition theshoulder part of a seat belt canreduce the protective capability ofthe seat belt and increase thechance of serious injury in a crash.
Objects onthe covers marked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG’’could interfere with the properoperation of the airbags or bepropelled inside the vehicle andhurt someone if the airbags inflate.
If yourhands or arms are close to anairbag cover, they could be injuredif the airbag inflates.
If a side airbag or aside curtain airbag inflates, a cupholder or other hard objectattached on or near the door couldbe propelled inside the vehicle andhurt someone.
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.
A passenger who is notwearing a seat belt during a crashor emergency stop can be thrownagainst the inside of the vehicle,against other occupants, or out ofthe vehicle.
Improperly replacingor covering front seat-back coverscan prevent your side airbags frominflating during a side impact.
Do not place hard or sharp objectsbetween yourself and a frontairbag.
Two people should never use thesame seat belt.
Do not put any accessories on seatbelts.
Do not attach or place objects onthe front airbag covers.
Keep your hands and arms awayfrom the airbag covers.
Do not attach hard objects on ornear a door.
Never let passengers ride in thecargo area or on top of a folded-down back seat.
Passengers should not stand up orchange seats while the vehicle ismoving.
Do not cover or replace front seat-back covers without consultingyour dealer.
Additional Safety Precautions
Protecting Adults and Teens
20
08/12/27 11:28:58 31TM8600 0025
2010 Insight
Your seat belt system includes lap/shoulder belts in all seating positions.The front seat belts are alsoequipped with automatic seat belttensioners.
This system uses the same sensorsas the front airbags to monitorwhether the front seat belts arelatched or unlatched, and how muchweight is on the front passenger’sseat (see pages and ).
In addition to the seat belt reminderindicator in the instrument panel,you will also see a ‘‘FASTEN SEATBELT’’ or ‘‘FASTEN PASSENGERSEAT BELT’’ message. This remainsdisplayed if you ignore it and do notfasten the seat belt while driving.
When no one is sitting in the frontpassenger’s seat, or a child or smalladult is riding there, the indicatorshould not come on and the beepershould not sound.
This system monitors the front seatbelts. If you turn the ignition switchto the ON (II) position before yourseat belt is fastened, the beeper willsound and the indicator will flash. Ifyour seat belt is not fastened beforethe beeper stops, the indicator willstop flashing but remain on.
The seat belt system includes anindicator on the instrument paneland a beeper to remind you and yourpassengers to fasten your seat belts.
You will also see a ‘‘FASTEN SEATBELT’’ message on the multi-information display.
If a front passenger does not fastentheir seat belt, the indicator willcome on about 6 seconds after theignition switch is turned to the ON(II) position.
If either the driver or a frontpassenger does not fasten their seatbelt while driving, the beeper willsound and the indicator will flashagain at regular intervals.
30 31
CONTINUED
Seat Belt System Components Seat Belt Indicator
Additional Information About Your Seat BeltsD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
21
08/12/27 11:29:08 31TM8600 0026
2010 Insight
If the indicator comes on or thebeeper sounds when the driver’s seatbelt is latched and there is no frontseat passenger and no items on thefront seat, something may beinterfering with the monitoringsystem. Look for and remove:
Any items under the frontpassenger’s seat.
Any object(s) hanging on the seator in the seat-back pocket.
Any object on the floor that istouching the rear of the seat-back.
If no obstructions are found, haveyour vehicle checked by a dealer.
All seat belts have an emergencylocking retractor. In normal driving,the retractor lets you move freely inyour seat while it keeps sometension on the belt. During a collisionor sudden stop, the retractorautomatically locks the belt to helprestrain your body.
The lap/shoulder belt goes overyour shoulder, across your chest,and across your hips.
To fasten the belt, insert the latchplate into the buckle, then tug on thebelt to make sure the buckle islatched (see page for how toproperly position the belt).
To unlock the belt, press the redPRESS button on the buckle. Guidethe belt across your body so that itretracts completely. After exiting thevehicle, be sure the belt is out of theway and will not get closed in thedoor.
The seat belts in all positions exceptthe driver’s have a lockable retractorthat must be activated to secure achild seat (see page ).
17
49
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Lap/Shoulder Belt
22
08/12/27 11:29:16 31TM8600 0027
2010 Insight
The tensioners can also be activatedduring a collision in which the frontairbags . In this case, theairbags would not be needed, but theextra tension in the seat belt couldbe helpful.
When the tensioners are activated,the seat belts will remain tight untilthey are unbuckled.
For added protection, the front seatbelts are equipped with automaticseat belt tensioners. When activated,the tensioners immediately tightenthe belts to help hold the driver anda front passenger in position.
The tensioners are designed toactivate in any collision severeenough to cause the front airbags todeploy.
If the shoulder part of the belt ispulled all the way out, the lockableretractor will activate. The belt willretract, but it will not allow thepassenger to move freely.
To deactivate the lockable retractor,unlatch the buckle and let the seatbelt fully retract. To refasten theseat belt, pull it out only as far asneeded.
do not deploy
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
23
08/12/27 11:29:23 31TM8600 0028
2010 Insight
For safety, you should check thecondition of your seat belts regularly.
Pull each belt out fully, and look forfrays, cuts, burns, and wear. Checkthat the latches work smoothly andthe belts retract easily. If a belt doesnot retract easily, cleaning the beltmay correct the problem (see page
). Any belt that is not in goodcondition or working properly willnot provide good protection andshould be replaced as soon aspossible.
Honda provides a limited warrantyon seat belts. See your
booklet fordetails.
If a seat belt is worn during a crash,it must be replaced by your dealer. Abelt that has been worn during acrash may not provide the same levelof protection in a subsequent crash.
The dealer should also inspect theanchors for damage and replacethem if needed. If the automatic seatbelt tensioners activate during acrash, they must be replaced.369
HondaWarranty Information
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Seat Belt Maintenance
24
Not checking or maintainingseat belts can result in seriousinjury or death if the seat beltsdo not work properly whenneeded.
Check your seat belts regularlyand have any problemcorrected as soon as possible.
08/12/27 11:29:29 31TM8600 0029
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
Airbag System Components
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
25
(8)(1) (2) (3)
(5)
(4)
(7)
(5)
(4)
(6)
(10) (9)
(11)
(1) Driver’s Front Airbag(2) Passenger’s Front Airbag(3) Control Unit(4) Front Seat Belt Tensioners(5) Side Airbags(6) Driver’s Seat Position Sensor(7) Front Passenger’s Weight Sensors(8) Passenger Airbag Off Indicator(9) Occupant Position Detection System (OPDS) Sensors(10) Front Passenger’s Weight Sensors/OPDS Sensors Control Unit(11) Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator
08/12/27 11:29:35 31TM8600 0030
2010 Insight
Two SRS (supplemental restraintsystem) front airbags. The driver’sairbag is stored in the center ofthe steering wheel; the frontpassenger’s airbag is stored in thedashboard. Both are marked ‘‘SRSAIRBAG’’ (see page ).
Two side airbags, one for thedriver and one for a frontpassenger. The airbags are storedin the outer edges of the seat-backs. Both are marked ‘‘SIDEAIRBAG’’ (see page ).
Two side curtain airbags, one foreach side of the vehicle. Theairbags are stored in the ceiling,above the side windows. The frontand rear pillars are marked ‘‘SIDECURTAIN AIRBAG’’ (see page
).
Your Airbag System includes:
28
32
33
Additional Information About Your Airbags
26
(12) Front Impact Sensors(13) Side Impact Sensors (First)(14) Side Impact Sensors (Second)(15) Side Curtain Airbags(16) Rear Safing Sensor
(13)
(12)
(15)
(16)
(14)
08/12/27 11:29:42 31TM8600 0031
2010 Insight
Sensors that can detect amoderate to severe front impact orside impact.
An indicator on the instrumentpanel that alerts you that thepassenger’s side airbag has beenturned off (see page ).
An indicator on the dashboard thatalerts you that the passenger’sfront airbag has been turned off(see page ).
Emergency backup power in caseyour vehicle’s electrical system isdisconnected in a crash.
Automatic front seat belttensioners (see page ).
Sensors that can detect whetherthe driver’s seat belt and thefront passenger’s seat belt arelatched or unlatched (see page
).
Weight sensors that monitor theweight on the front passenger’sseat. If the weight is about 65lbs (29 kg) or less (the weightof an infant or small child), thepassenger’s front airbag will beturned off (see page ).
An indicator on the instrumentpanel that alerts you to a possibleproblem with your airbags,sensors, or seat belt tensioners(see page ).
A sophisticated electronic systemthat continually monitors andrecords information about thesensors, the control unit, theairbag activators, the seat belttensioners, and driver and frontpassenger seat belt use when theignition switch is in the ON (II)position.
Sensors that can detect whethera child is in the passenger’s sideairbag path and signal thecontrol unit to turn the airbagoff (see page ).
A driver’s seat position sensor thatmonitors the distance of the seatfrom the front airbag. If the seat istoo far forward, the airbag willinflate with less force (see page
).
23
32
21
30
30
34
34
35
Additional Information About Your AirbagsD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
27
08/12/27 11:29:50 31TM8600 0032
2010 Insight
The total time for inflation anddeflation is one-tenth of a second, sofast that most occupants are notaware that the airbags deployed untilthey see them lying in their laps.
After inflating, the front airbagsimmediately deflate, so they won’tinterfere with the driver’s visibility,or the ability to steer or operateother controls.
During a frontal crash, your seat beltrestrains your lower body and torso,and the front airbag helps protectyour head and chest.
Although both airbags normallyinflate within a split second of eachother, it is possible for only oneairbag to deploy.
This can happen if the severity of acollision is at the margin, orthreshold, that determines whetheror not the airbags will deploy. Insuch cases, the seat belt will providesufficient protection, and thesupplemental protection offered bythe airbag would be minimal.
If you ever have a moderate tosevere frontal collision, sensors willdetect the vehicle’s rapiddeceleration.
Only the driver’s airbag will deploy ifthere is no passenger in the frontseat, or if the advanced airbagsystem has turned the passenger’sairbag off (see page ).
If the rate of deceleration is highenough, the control unit will inflatethe driver’s and front passenger’sairbags, at the time and with theforce needed. 35
How Your Front Airbags Work
Additional Information About Your Airbags
28
08/12/27 11:29:58 31TM8600 0033
2010 Insight
Your front airbags are also dual-threshold airbags. Airbags with thisfeature have two deploymentthresholds that depend on whethersensors detect the occupant iswearing a seat belt or not.
If the occupant’s belt is ,the airbag will deploy at a slightlylower threshold, because theoccupant would need extraprotection.
If the occupant’s belt is , theairbag will inflate at a slightly higherthreshold, when the airbag would beneeded to supplement the protectionprovided by the seat belt.
Your front airbags are dual-stageairbags. This means they have twoinflation stages that can be ignitedsequentially or simultaneously,depending on crash severity.
In a crash, both stageswill ignite simultaneously to providethe quickest and greatest protection.
In a crash, one stage willignite first, then the second stagewill ignite a split second later. Thisprovides longer airbag inflation timewith a little less force.
After a crash, you may see whatlooks like smoke. This is actuallypowder from the airbag’s surface.Although the powder is not harmful,people with respiratory problemsmay experience some temporarydiscomfort. If this occurs, get out ofthe vehicle as soon as it is safe to doso.
CONTINUED
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Dual-Threshold Airbags
not latched
latched
Dual-Stage Airbags
more severe
less severe
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
29
08/12/27 11:30:06 31TM8600 0034
2010 Insight
The driver’s advanced front airbagsystem includes a seat positionsensor under the seat. If the seat istoo far forward, the airbag willinflate with less force, regardless ofthe severity of the impact.
If there is a problem with the sensor,the SRS indicator will come on, andthe airbag will inflate in the normalmanner regardless of the driver’sseating position.
The passenger’s advanced frontairbag system has weight sensorsunder the seat. Although Hondadoes not encourage carrying aninfant or small child in front, if thesensors detect the weight of aninfant or small child (up to about 65lbs or 29 kg), the system willautomatically turn the passenger’sfront airbag off.
Your front airbags are also advancedairbags. The main purpose of thisfeature is to help prevent airbag-caused injuries to short drivers andchildren or small statured adults whoride in front.
For both advanced airbags to workproperly:
Occupants must sit upright andwear their seat belts properly.
Do not spill any liquids on orunder the seats, cover the sensors,or put any objects or metal itemsunder the front seats.
Failure to follow these instructionscould damage the sensors or preventthem from working properly.
Advanced Airbags
Additional Information About Your Airbags
30
DRIVER’SSEATPOSITIONSENSOR
PASSENGER’SSEAT WEIGHTSENSORS
08/12/27 11:30:14 31TM8600 0035
2010 Insight
Be aware that objects placed on thepassenger’s seat can also cause theairbag to be turned off.
When the passenger airbag getsturned off by the weight sensors, a‘‘passenger airbag off’’ indicator inthe center of the dashboard comeson (see page ).
If the weight sensors detect there isno passenger in the front seat, theairbag is automatically turned off.However, the passenger airbag offindicator in this situation will notcome on.
To ensure that the passenger’sadvanced front airbag system willwork properly,
This includes:
A rear passenger pushing orpulling on the back of the frontpassenger’s seat.
Moving the front seat forciblyback against cargo on the seat orfloor behind it.
Hanging heavy items on the frontpassenger seat, or placing heavyitems in the seat-back pocket.
Moving the front seat or seat-backforcibly back against the foldedrear seat.
Back seat passengers should notwedge objects or intentionallyforce their feet under the frontpassenger seat.
35
Additional Information About Your Airbags
do not do anythingthat would increase or decrease theweight on the front passenger’s seat.
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
31
08/12/27 11:30:21 31TM8600 0036
2010 Insight
To get the best protection from theside airbags, front seat occupantsshould wear their seat belts and situpright and well back in their seats.
Only one airbag will deploy during aside impact. If the impact is on thepassenger’s side, the passenger’sside airbag will deploy even if thereis no passenger.
Your vehicle has a side airbag cutoffsystem designed primarily to protecta child riding in the front passenger’sseat.
Although Honda does not encouragechildren to ride in front, if theposition sensors detect a child hasleaned into the side airbag’sdeployment path, the airbag will shutoff.
The side airbag may also shut off if ashort adult leans sideways, or alarger adult slouches and leanssideways into the airbag’sdeployment path.
Objects placed on the frontpassenger seat can also cause theside airbag to be shut off.
If you ever have a moderate tosevere side impact, sensors willdetect rapid acceleration and signalthe control unit to instantly inflateeither the driver’s or the passenger’sside airbag.
How Your Side Airbags Work
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Side Airbag Cutoff System
32
08/12/27 11:30:29 31TM8600 0037
2010 Insight
If the side airbag off indicator comeson (see page ), have thepassenger sit upright. Once thepassenger is out of the airbag’sdeployment path, the system willturn the airbag back on, and theindicator will go out.
There will be some delay betweenthe moment the passenger movesinto or out of the airbag deploymentpath and when the indicator comeson or goes off.
If the impact is on the passenger’sside, the passenger’s side curtainairbag will inflate even if there are nooccupants on that side of the vehicle.
In a moderate to severe side impact,sensors will detect rapid accelerationand signal the control unit toinstantly inflate the side curtainairbag and activate the seat belttensioner on the driver’s or thepassenger’s side of the vehicle.
A front seat passenger should notuse a cushion or another object as abackrest. It may prevent the cutoffsystem from working properly.
To get the best protection from theside curtain airbags, occupantsshould wear their seat belts and situpright and well back in their seats.
One or both side curtain airbags mayinflate in a moderate to severefrontal collision which causes thefront airbags to deploy.
34
Additional Information About Your Airbags
How Your Side Curtain AirbagsWork
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
33
SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG
08/12/27 11:30:37 31TM8600 0038
2010 Insight
If the indicator comes on at anyother time, or does not come on at all,you should have the system checkedby your dealer. For example:
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, this indicatorcomes on for several seconds thengoes off. This tells you the system isworking properly.
If the indicator comes on orflashes on and off while you drive.
If the indicator stays on after theengine starts.
If the SRS indicator does not comeon after you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position.
The SRS indicator alerts you to apotential problem with your airbagsor seat belt tensioners.
This indicator alerts you that thepassenger’s side airbag has beenautomatically shut off. It doesmean there is a problem with yourside airbags.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, the indicatorshould come on for several secondsand then go off (see page ). If itdoesn’t come on, stays on, or comeson while driving without a passengerin the front seat, have the systemchecked.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKAIRBAG SYSTEM’’ message on themulti-information display.
If you see any of these indications,the airbags and seat belt tensionersmay not work properly when youneed them.
You will also see a ‘‘PASSENGERSIDE AIRBAG OFF’’ message on themulti-information display.
65
Additional Information About Your Airbags
How the SRS IndicatorWorks
How the SideAirbag OffIndicator Works
not
34
U.S. Canada
Ignoring the SRS indicator canresult in serious injury or deathif the airbag systems ortensioners do not work properly.
Have your vehicle checked by adealer as soon as possible ifthe SRS indicator alerts you toa possible problem.
08/12/27 11:30:49 31TM8600 0039
2010 Insight
This indicator alerts you that thepassenger’s front airbag has beenshut off because weight sensorsdetect about 65 lbs (29 kg) or less(the weight of an infant or smallchild) on the front passenger’s seat.It does there is a problemwith the airbag.
The passenger airbag off indicatormay come on and off repeatedly ifthe total weight on the seat is nearthe airbag cutoff threshold.
If an adult or teenage passenger isriding in front, move the seat as farto the rear as possible, and have thepassenger sit upright and wear theseat belt properly.
Be aware that objects placed on thefront seat can cause the indicator tocome on.
If no weight is detected on the frontseat, the airbag will be automaticallyshut off. However, the indicator willnot come on.
CONTINUED
Additional Information About Your Airbags
How the Passenger Airbag OffIndicator Works
not mean
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
35
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR
Canada
U.S.
On vehicle with navigation system On vehicle without navigation system
Canada
U.S.
08/12/27 11:30:57 31TM8600 0040
2010 Insight
Take your vehicle to anauthorized dealer as soon aspossible. If you ignore thisindication, your airbags may notoperate properly.
Even if yourairbags do not inflate, your dealershould inspect the driver’s seatposition sensor, the frontpassenger’s weight sensors, thefront seat belt tensioners, and allseat belts and their anchors wornduring a crash to make sure theyare operating properly.
Your airbag systems are virtuallymaintenance free, and there are noparts you can safely service.However, you must have yourvehicle serviced if:
Any airbagthat has deployed must bereplaced along with the controlunit and other related parts. Anyseat belt tensioner that activatesmust also be replaced.
Do not try to remove or replaceany airbag by yourself. This mustbe done by an authorized dealer ora knowledgeable body shop.
If no obstructions are found, haveyour vehicle checked by a dealer assoon as possible.
If the indicator comes on with nofront seat passenger and no objectson the seat, or with an adult ridingthere, something may be interferingwith the weight sensors. Look forand remove:
Any items under the frontpassenger’s seat.
Any object(s) hanging on the seator in the seat-back pocket.
Any object on the floor that istouching the rear of the seat-back.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
The SRS indicator alerts you to aproblem.
If your vehicle has a moderate tosevere impact.
An airbag ever inflates.
Airbag Service
36
08/12/27 11:31:05 31TM8600 0041
2010 Insight
If water oranother liquid soaks into a seat-back, it can prevent the side airbagcutoff system from workingproperly.
This could make thedriver’s seat position sensor or thefront passenger’s weight sensorsineffective. If it is necessary toremove or modify a front seat toaccommodate a person withdisabilities, first contact HondaAutomobile Customer Service at(800) 999-1009.
Tampering could causethe airbags to deploy, possiblycausing very serious injury.
Together, airbags andseat belts provide the bestprotection.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Do not expose the front passenger’sseat-back to liquid.
Do not remove or modify a frontseat without consulting yourdealer.
Do not tamper with airbagcomponents or wiring for anyreason.
Do not attempt to deactivate yourairbags.
Additional Safety Precautions
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
37
08/12/27 11:31:10 31TM8600 0042
2010 Insight
--
-
Children depend on adults to protectthem. However, despite their bestintentions, many adults do not knowhow to protect childpassengers.
If you have children, or ever need todrive with a child in your vehicle, besure to read this section. It beginswith important general guidelines,then presents special information forinfants, small children, and largerchildren.
(see pages ).(see pages ).
Each year, many children are injuredor killed in vehicle crashes becausethey are either unrestrained or notproperly restrained. In fact, vehicleaccidents are the number one causeof the death of children age 12 andunder.
To reduce the number of childdeaths and injuries, every state,Canadian province and territoryrequires that infants and children beproperly restrained when they ride ina vehicle.
43 5152 55
properly
All Children Must Be Restrained
Larger children must be restrainedwith a lap/shoulder belt and ride ona booster seat until the seat belt f itsthem properly
Infants and small children must berestrained in an approved child seatthat is properly secured to thevehicle
Protecting Children General Guidelines
38
Children who are unrestrainedor improperly restrained can beseriously injured or killed in acrash.
Any child too small for a seatbelt should be properlyrestrained in a child seat. Alarger child should be properlyrestrained with a seat belt anduse a booster seat if necessary.
08/12/27 11:31:18 31TM8600 0043
2010 Insight
-
According to accident statistics,children of all ages and sizes aresafer when they are restrained in aback seat.
Whenever possible,larger children should sit in the backseat, on a booster seat if needed, andbe properly restrained with a seatbelt. (See page for importantinformation about protecting largerchildren.)
Front airbags have been designed tohelp protect adults in a moderate tosevere frontal collision. To do this,the passenger’s front airbag is quitelarge, and it can inflate with enoughforce to cause very serious injuries.
If the vehicle seat istoo far forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating front airbag can strike thechild with enough force to kill orvery seriously injure a small child.
The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that all childrenaged 12 and under be properlyrestrained in a back seat. Somestates have laws restricting wherechildren may ride.
Children who ride in back are lesslikely to be injured by strikinginterior vehicle parts during acollision or hard braking. Also,children cannot be injured by aninflating front airbag when they ridein the back.
Even though your vehicle has anadvanced front airbag system thatautomatically turns the passenger’sfront airbag off under certaincircumstances (see page ), pleasefollow these guidelines:
Ifthe airbag inflates, it can hit the backof the child seat with enough forceto kill or very seriously injure aninfant.
35
52
CONTINUED
All Children Should Sit in a BackSeat
The Passenger’s Front AirbagCan Pose Serious Risks
Protecting Children General Guidelines
Small Children
Larger ChildrenChildren who have outgrown childseats are also at risk of being injuredor killed by an inflating passenger’sfront airbag.
Placing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag canbe hazardous.
Never put a rear-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag.
Infants
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
39
08/12/27 11:31:28 31TM8600 0044
2010 Insight
-
To remind you of the passenger’sfront airbag hazards, and thatchildren must be properly restrainedin a back seat, your vehicle haswarning labels on the dashboard(U.S. models) and on the front visors.Please read and follow theinstructions on these labels.
Canadian Models
U.S. Models
Protecting Children General Guidelines
40
SUN VISORS DASHBOARD
SUN VISORS
08/12/27 11:31:41 31TM8600 0045
2010 Insight
-
Many parents say they prefer to putan infant or a small child in the frontpassenger seat so they can watch thechild, or because the child requiresattention.
Placing a child in the front seatexposes the child to hazards in afrontal collision, and paying closeattention to a child distracts thedriver from the important tasks ofdriving, placing both of you at risk.
Your vehicle has a back seat wherechildren can be properly restrained.If you ever have to carry a group ofchildren, and a child must ride infront:
Place the largest child in the frontseat, provided the child is largeenough to wear the lap/shoulderbelt properly (see page ).
Move the vehicle seat as far to therear as possible (see page ).
Have the child sit upright and wellback in the seat (see page ).
Make sure the seat belt is properlypositioned and secured (see page
).
If a child requires close physicalattention or frequent visual contact,we strongly recommend that anotheradult ride with the child in the backseat. The back seat is far safer for achild than the front.
52
18
17
138
If You Must Drive with SeveralChildren
If a Child Requires CloseAttention
Protecting Children General GuidelinesD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
41
08/12/27 11:31:49 31TM8600 0046
2010 Insight
-
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.
If you are not wearing aseat belt in a crash, you could bethrown forward and crush thechild against the dashboard or aseat-back. If you are wearing aseat belt, the child can be tornfrom your arms and be seriouslyhurt or killed.
During a crash, thebelt could press deep into the childand cause serious or fatal injuries.
This can preventchildren from accidentally fallingout (see page ).
If a child wraps a looseseat belt around their neck, theycan be seriously or fatally injured.(See pages and for how toactivate and deactivate thelockable retractor.)
Leaving children withoutadult supervision is illegal in moststates, Canadian provinces/territories, and can be veryhazardous.
For example, infants and smallchildren left in a vehicle on a hotday can die from heatstroke. Achild left alone with the key in theignition switch can accidentally setthe vehicle in motion, possiblyinjuring themselves or others.
Childrenwho play in vehicles canaccidentally get trapped inside thevehicle. Teach your children not toplay in or around vehicles.
Even very youngchildren learn how to unlockvehicle doors, turn on the ignitionswitch, and open the hatch, whichcan lead to accidental injury ordeath.
49 50
131
Additional Safety Precautions
Never let two children use thesame seat belt.
Never hold an infant or child onyour lap.
Never put a seat belt over yourselfand a child.
Use the childproof door locks toprevent children from opening therear doors.
Make sure any unused seat beltthat a child can reach is buckled,the lockable retractor is activated,and the belt is fully retracted andlocked.
Do not leave children alone in avehicle.
Lock all doors and the hatch whenyour vehicle is not in use.
Keep vehicle keys and remotetransmitters out of the reach ofchildren.
Protecting Children General Guidelines
42
08/12/27 11:31:57 31TM8600 0047
2010 Insight
When properly installed, a rear-facing child seat may prevent thedriver or a front passenger frommoving their seat as far back asrecommended, or from locking theirseat-back in the desired position.
Two types of seats may be used: aseat designed exclusively for infants,or a convertible seat used in the rear-facing, reclining mode.
If placedfacing forward, an infant could bevery seriously injured during afrontal collision.
A rear-facing child seat can be placedin any seating position in the backseat, but not in the front.
If the passenger’s front airbaginflates, it can hit the back of thechild seat with enough force to kill orseriously injure an infant.
An infant must be properlyrestrained in a rear-facing, recliningchild seat until the child reaches theseat maker’s weight or height limitfor the seat, and the child is at leastone year old.
Only a rear-facing child seat providesproper support for a baby’s head,neck, and back.
It could also interfere with properoperation of the passenger’sadvanced front airbag system.
CONTINUED
Protecting Infants
Child Seat Type
Do not put a rear-facing child seat ina forward-facing position.
Never put arear-facing child seat in the frontseat.
Rear-facing Child Seat Placement
Protecting Infants and Small ChildrenD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
43
08/12/27 11:32:06 31TM8600 0048
2010 Insight
In any of these situations, westrongly recommend that you installthe child seat directly behind thefront passenger’s seat, move the seatas far forward as needed, and leave itunoccupied. Or, you may wish to geta smaller rear-facing child seat.
If the vehicle seat is toofar forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating airbag can strike the childwith enough force to cause veryserious or fatal injuries.
We strongly recommend placing aforward-facing child seat in a backseat, not the front.
We also recommend that a smallchild use the child seat until the childreaches the weight or height limitfor the seat.
Of the different seats available, werecommend those that have a five-point harness system as shown.
Many states, Canadian provinces andterritories allow a child one year ofage or older who also meets theminimum size and weightrequirements to transition from arear-facing child seat to a forwardfacing seat. Know the requirementswhere you are driving and follow thechild seat instructions. Many expertsrecommend use of a rear-facing seatup to age two, if the child’s height
and weight are appropriate for arear-facing seat.
Protecting Small Children
Child Seat Type
Placing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s airbag can behazardous.
Child Seat Placement
Protecting Infants and Small Children
44
Placing a rear-facing child seatin the front seat can result inserious injury or death during acollision.
Always place a rear-facing childseat in the back seat, not thefront.
08/12/27 11:32:15 31TM8600 0049
2010 Insight
Conventional child seats must besecured to a vehicle with a seat belt,whereas LATCH-compatible seatsare secured by attaching the seat tohardware built into the two outerseating positions in the back seat.
Since LATCH-compatible child seatsare easier to install and reduce thepossibility of improper installation,we recommend selecting this style.
When buying a child seat, you needto choose either a conventional childseat, or one designed for use withthe Lower Anchors and Tethers forCHildren (LATCH) system.
In seating positions and vehicles notequipped with LATCH, a LATCH-compatible child seat can be installedusing a seat belt.
Whatever type of seat you choose, toprovide proper protection, a childseat should meet threerequirements:
Look for FMVSS213 or CMVSS 213 on the box.
Rear-facing for infants, forward-facing for small children.
Before purchasing a conventionalchild seat, or using a previouslypurchased one, we recommend thatyou test the seat in the specificvehicle seating position or positionswhere the seat will be used.
Even with advanced front airbagsthat automatically turn thepassenger’s front airbag off (seepage ), a back seat is the safestplace for a small child.
If it is necessary to put a forward-facing child seat in the front, movethe vehicle seat as far to the rear aspossible, and be sure the child seat isfirmly secured to the vehicle and thechild is properly strapped in the seat.
35
Selecting a Child Seat
Protecting Infants and Small Children, Selecting a Child Seat
The child seat should meet U.S. orCanadian Motor Vehicle SafetyStandard 213.
The child seat should be of theproper type and size to fit the child.
The child seat should fit thevehicle seating position (orpositions) where it will be used.
1.
2.
3.
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
45
Placing a forward-facing childseat in the front seat can resultin serious injury or death if thefront airbag inflates.
If you must place a forward-facing child seat in front, movethe vehicle seat as far back aspossible, and properly restrainthe child.
08/12/27 11:32:25 31TM8600 0050
2010 Insight
After selecting a proper child seatand a good place to install the seat,there are three main steps ininstalling the seat:
All child seats must besecured to the vehicle with the lappart of a lap/shoulder belt or withthe LATCH (Lower Anchors andTethers for CHildren) system. Achild whose seat is not properlysecured to the vehicle can beendangered in a crash.
After installing a childseat, push and pull the seatforward and from side-to-side toverify that it is secure.
A child seat secured with a seat beltshould be installed as firmly aspossible. However, it does not needto be ‘‘rock solid.’’ Some side-to-sidemovement can be expected andshould not reduce the child seat’seffectiveness.
If the child seat is not secure, tryinstalling it in a different seatingposition, or use a different style ofchild seat that can be firmly secured.
Make sure the child is properlystrapped in the child seataccording to the child seat maker’sinstructions. A child who is notproperly secured in a child seatcan be seriously injured in a crash.
The following pages provideguidelines on how to properly installa child seat. A forward-facing childseat is used in all examples, but theinstructions are the same for a rear-facing child seat.
Installing a Child Seat
Installing a Child Seat
Properly secure the child seat tothe vehicle.
Make sure the child seat is firmlysecured.
Secure the child in the child seat.
1.
3.
2.
46
08/12/27 11:32:32 31TM8600 0051
2010 Insight
To install a LATCH-compatible childseat:
Place the child seat on the vehicleseat, then attach the seat to thelower anchors according to thechild seat maker’s instructions.
Some LATCH-compatible seatshave a rigid-type connector asshown above.Make sure there are no objects
near the anchors that couldprevent a secure connectionbetween the child seat and theanchors.
Move the seat belt buckle ortongue away from the loweranchors.
Your vehicle is equipped withLATCH (Lower Anchors andTethers for CHildren) at the outerrear seats.
The lower anchors are locatedbetween the seat-back and seatbottom, and are to be used only witha child seat designed for use withLATCH.
The location of each lower anchor isindicated by a small button above theanchor point.
You can find lower anchors in theslits in the seat-backs.
1.
2.
3.
CONTINUED
Installing a Child Seat withLATCH
Installing a Child SeatD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
47
BUTTON
LOWER ANCHORS Rigid type
08/12/27 11:32:42 31TM8600 0052
2010 Insight
Other LATCH-compatible seats havea flexible-type connector as shownabove.
Whatever type you have, followthe child seat maker’s instructionsfor adjusting or tightening the fit.
Lift the head restraint (see page), then route the tether strap
through the legs of the headrestraint and over the seat-back,making sure the strap is nottwisted.
Push and pull the child seatforward and from side-to-side toverify that it is secure.
If the tether strap is too long andcannot be tightened firmly, find aroute where the strap can betightened securely.
Attach the tether strap hook to thetether anchor, then tighten thestrap as instructed by the childseat maker.
6.
5.
4.
7.
139
Installing a Child Seat
48
ANCHOR
TETHER STRAP HOOK
Flexible type
08/12/27 11:32:49 31TM8600 0053
2010 Insight
When not using the LATCH system,all child seats must be secured to thevehicle with the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt.
To activate the lockable retractor,slowly pull the shoulder part of thebelt all the way out until it stops,then let the belt feed back into theretractor.
After the belt has retracted, tug onit. If the belt is locked, you will notbe able to pull it out. If you can pullthe belt out, it is not locked, andyou will need to repeat these steps.
In addition, the lap/shoulder belts inall seating positions except thedriver’s have a lockable retractorthat must be activated to secure achild seat.
With the child seat in the desiredseating position, route the beltthrough the child seat accordingto the seat maker’s instructions,then insert the latch plate into thebuckle and remove any slack fromthe lap portion of the belt.
1. 2.
3.
CONTINUED
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Belt
Installing a Child SeatD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
49
08/12/27 11:32:57 31TM8600 0054
2010 Insight
After confirming that the belt islocked, grab the shoulder part ofthe belt near the buckle, and pullup to remove any slack from thelap part of the belt. Remember, ifthe lap part of the belt is not tight,the child seat will not be secure.
Push and pull the child seatforward and from side-to-side toverify that it is secure enough tostay upright during normal drivingmaneuvers. If the child seat is notsecure, unlatch the belt, allow it toretract fully, then repeat thesesteps.
To remove slack, it may help toput weight on the child seat, orpush on the back of the seat whilepulling up on the belt.
To deactivate the lockable retractorand remove a child seat, unlatch thebuckle, unroute the seat belt, and letthe belt fully retract.
A child seat with a tether can beinstalled in any seating position inthe back seat, using one of theanchorage points shown above.
Since a tether can provide additionalsecurity to the lap/shoulder beltinstallation, we recommend using atether whenever one is required oravailable.
4. 5.
Installing a Child Seat with aTether
Installing a Child Seat
50
ANCHORAGE POINTS
ANCHOR
08/12/27 11:33:05 31TM8600 0055
2010 Insight
After properly securing the childseat (see page ), lift the headrestraint, then route the tetherstrap over the seat-back andthrough the head restraint legs.
Attach the tether strap hook to theanchor, making sure the strap isnot twisted.
Tighten the strap according to theseat maker’s instructions.
If the tether strap is too long andcannot be tightened firmly, find aroute where the strap can betightened securely.
1.
2.
3.49
Installing a Child SeatD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
51
ANCHORANCHOR
Outer Position Center PositionTETHER STRAP HOOKTETHER STRAP HOOK
08/12/27 11:33:11 31TM8600 0056
2010 Insight
To determine if a lap/shoulder beltproperly fits a child, have the childput on the seat belt, then askyourself:
Does the child sit all the way backagainst the seat?
Do the child’s knees bendcomfortably over the edge of theseat?
The following pages giveinstructions on how to check properseat belt fit, what kind of boosterseat to use if one is needed, andimportant precautions for a childwho must sit in front.
When a child reaches therecommended weight or height limitfor a forward-facing child seat, thechild should sit in a back seat on abooster seat and wear the lap/shoulder belt.
1.
2.
Checking Seat Belt Fit
Protecting Larger Children
52
Allowing a child age 12 or underto sit in front can result in injuryor death if the passenger’s frontairbag inflates.
If a child must ride in front,move the vehicle seat as farback as possible, use a boosterseat if needed, have the childsit up properly and wear theseat belt properly.
08/12/27 11:33:18 31TM8600 0057
2010 Insight
Does the shoulder belt crossbetween the child’s neck and arm?
Is the lap part of the belt as low aspossible, touching the child’sthighs?
Will the child be able to stayseated like this for the whole trip?
If you answer yes to all thesequestions, the child is ready to wearthe lap/shoulder belt correctly. Ifyou answer no to any question, thechild needs to ride on a booster seat. A child who has outgrown a forward-
facing child seat should ride in aback seat and use a booster seatuntil the lap/shoulder belt fits themproperly without the booster.
Booster seats can be high-back orlow-back. Whichever style you select,make sure the booster seat meetsfederal safety standards (see page
) and that you follow the boosterseat maker’s instructions.
A child may continue using a boosterseat until the tops of their ears areeven with the top of the vehicle’s orbooster’s seat-back. A child of thisheight should be tall enough to usethe lap/shoulder belt without abooster seat.
If a child who uses a booster seatmust ride in front, move the vehicleseat as far back as possible, and besure the child is wearing the seatbelt properly.
Some states, Canadian provinces andterritories also require children touse a booster seat until they reach agiven age or weight (e.g., 6 years or60 lbs). Be sure to check currentlaws in the states, provinces and
territories where you intend to drive.3.
4.
5.45
Using a Booster Seat
Protecting Larger ChildrenD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
53
08/12/27 11:33:27 31TM8600 0058
2010 Insight
If the passenger’s front airbaginflates in a moderate to severefrontal collision, the airbag can causeserious injuries to a child who isunrestrained, improperly restrained,sitting too close to the airbag, or outof position.
A side airbag also poses risks. If anypart of a larger child’s body is in thepath of a deploying side airbag, thechild could receive possibly seriousinjuries.
Physically, a child must be largeenough for the lap/shoulder belt toproperly fit (see pages and ). Ifthe seat belt does not fit properly,with or without the child sitting on abooster seat, the child should not sitin front.
To safely ride in front, a child mustbe able to follow the rules, includingsitting properly, and wearing the seatbelt properly throughout a ride.
If you decide that a child can safelyride up front, be sure to:
Carefully read the owner’s manual,and make sure you understand allseat belt instructions and all safetyinformation.
Move the vehicle seat to the rear-most position.
Have the child sit up straight, backagainst the seat, and feet on ornear the floor.
Check that the child’s seat belt isproperly and securely positioned.
Of course, children vary widely. Andwhile age may be one indicator ofwhen a child can safely ride in front,there are other important factors youshould consider.
The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that all childrenage 12 and under be properlyrestrained in a back seat.
Supervise the child. Even maturechildren sometimes need to bereminded to fasten the seat beltsor sit properly.
17 52
When Can a Larger Child Sit inFront
Physical Size
Maturity
Protecting Larger Children
54
08/12/27 11:33:37 31TM8600 0059
2010 Insight
This could resultin serious neck injuries during acrash.
This couldcause very serious injuries duringa crash. It also increases thechance that the child will slideunder the belt in a crash and beinjured.
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.
Devices intended toimprove a child’s comfort orreposition the shoulder part of aseat belt can make the belt lesseffective and increase the chanceof serious injury in a crash.
Additional Safety PrecautionsDo not let a child wear a seat beltacross the neck.
Do not let a child put the shoulderpart of a seat belt behind the backor under the arm.
Two children should never use thesame seat belt.
Do not put any accessories on aseat belt.
Protecting Larger ChildrenD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
55
08/12/27 11:33:42 31TM8600 0060
2010 Insight
Your vehicle’s exhaust containscarbon monoxide gas. Carbonmonoxide should not enter thevehicle in normal driving if youmaintain your vehicle properly andfollow the information on this page.
High levels of carbon monoxide cancollect rapidly in enclosed areas,such as a garage. Do not run theengine with the garage door closed.Even with the door open, run theengine only long enough to move thevehicle out of the garage.
If you must sit in your parked vehiclewith the engine running, even in anunconfined area, adjust the heatingand cooling system as follows:
The vehicle is raised for an oilchange.
Have the exhaust system inspectedfor leaks whenever:
You notice a change in the soundof the exhaust.
The vehicle was in a collision thatmay have damaged the underside.
Select the fresh air mode.Select the mode.Set the fan speed to high.Set the temperature control to acomfortable setting.
With the hatch open, airflow can pullexhaust gas into your vehicle’sinterior and create a hazardouscondition. If you must drive with thehatch open, open all the windows,and set the climate control system asshown below.
1.2.3.4.
Carbon Monoxide Hazard
56
Carbon monoxide gas is toxic.Breathing it can causeunconsciousness and even killyou.
Avoid any enclosed areas oractivities that expose you tocarbon monoxide.
08/12/27 11:33:50 31TM8600 0061
2010 Insight
These labels are in the locationsshown. They warn you of potentialhazards that could cause seriousinjury or death. Read these labelscarefully.
If a label comes off or becomes hardto read (except for the U.S.dashboard label which may beremoved by the owner), contact yourdealer for a replacement.
CONTINUED
U.S. models
Canadian models
U.S. models only
Safety LabelsD
riverand
Passenger
Safety
57
DASHBOARD
RADIATOR CAP
SUN VISORS
08/12/27 11:34:04 31TM8600 0062
2010 Insight
U.S. models Canadian models
Safety Labels
58
DOORJAMBS
08/12/27 11:34:13 31TM8600 0063
2010 Insight
This section gives information aboutthe controls and displays thatcontribute to the daily operation ofyour vehicle. All the essentialcontrols are within easy reach.
...........................Control Locations . 60............................Instrument Panel . 61
..........Instrument Panel Indicators . 62.............................................Gauges . 72
.............Multi-Information Display . 75Controls Near the Steering
.........................................Wheel . 116Windshield Wipers and
.....................................Washers . 117.......Turn Signals and Headlights . 118
.........Daytime Running Lights . 120......Instrument Panel Brightness . 121
...............Hazard Warning Button . 122
...............Rear Window Defogger . 123...................................Econ Button . 124
......Steering Wheel Adjustments . 125.............................Keys and Locks . 126
......................Immobilizer System . 127..............................Ignition Switch . 128
....................................Door Locks . 130............Childproof Door Locks . 131
.....................Remote Transmitter . 132..............................................Hatch . 136
................Unlocking the Hatch . 137...............................................Seats . 138
...........Front Seat Adjustments . 138
Driver’s Seat Height............................Adjustment . 138
........................Head Restraints . 139.Folding the Rear Seats Down . 142
......................................Armrest . 143...........................................Mirrors . 144
..Adjusting the Power Mirrors . 144..............Power Mirror Heaters . 145
............................Power Windows . 146...............................Parking Brake . 148
.........Interior Convenience Items . 149.....................Cargo Area Cover . 150
...............Under Floor Storages . 152...Floor Storage Compartment . 152
.....................Beverage Holders . 153........Accessory Power Sockets . 153
.............Console Compartment . 154..................................Glove Box . 154
...............................Center Tray . 155..........................Center Pockets . 155
..................................Coat Hook . 156
..................................Sun Visors . 156............................Vanity Mirror . 156
...............................Interior Lights . 157
Instruments and ControlsInstrum
entsand
Controls
59
08/12/27 11:34:17 31TM8600 0064
2010 Insight
*
* *
*
If equipped:
Control Locations
60
POWER WINDOWSWITCHES
DOOR LOCK TAB
GAUGES
POWER DOOR LOCKMASTER SWITCH
HAZARD WARNINGBUTTON
CLIMATE CONTROLSYSTEM
PARKING BRAKE LEVER
ECON BUTTON
HOOD RELEASE HANDLE
PADDLE SHIFTERS USB ADAPTER CABLE
MULTI-INFORMATIONDISPLAY
(P.287)
(P.316)
(P.311)
(P.160)
(P.35)
PASSENGER AIRBAGOFF INDICATOR
(P.72)INSTRUMENT PANEL INDICATORS(P.62)
(P.124)
(P.130)
(P.130)
(P.146)
(P.183,191)
(P.148)
(P.122)(P.72, 75)
AUDIO SYSTEM(P.166, 198)NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AUTOMATICTRANSMISSION (CVT)
Model with navigation system is shown.
08/12/27 11:34:24 31TM8600 0065
2010 Insight
*
*
***
The U.S. instrument panel is shown. Differences for the Canadian models are noted in the text.
Instrument PanelInstrum
entsand
Controls
61
SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR
LIGHTS ON INDICATOR
SEAT BELT REMINDERINDICATOR
ANTI-LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM(ABS) INDICATOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINTSYSTEM (SRS) INDICATOR
SYSTEM MESSAGEINDICATORBRAKE SYSTEM INDICATOR
(AMBER)
VSA OFF INDICATOR
MALFUNCTIONINDICATOR LAMP PARKING BRAKE AND
BRAKE SYSTEMINDICATOR (RED)
DOOR/HATCH OPENINDICATOR
SIDE AIRBAG OFFINDICATOR
VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST(VSA) SYSTEM INDICATOR
IMMOBILIZERSYSTEM INDICATOR
IMA SYSTEMINDICATOR
HIGH BEAMINDICATOR
ELECTRIC POWER STEERINGINDICATOR
(P.64)
(P.65, 332)
(P.63)
(P.66)
(P.62, 403)
(P.63, 402)
: If equipped (P.62)
(P.64)
(P.63, 404)
(P.65)
(P.68)
(P.68)
(P.69)
(P.64)
(P.69)
HIGH TEMPERATURE INDICATOR (P.67)
LOW TEMPERATURE INDICATOR(P.67)
(P.70)
(P.66)
CRUISE MAIN INDICATOR (P.69)
CRUISE CONTROL INDICATOR (P.69)
LOW OIL PRESSUREINDICATOR (P.62, 401) LOW TIRE PRESSURE/
TPMS INDICATOR
12 VOLT BATTERYCHARGING SYSTEMINDICATOR
(P.70)
ECON MODE INDICATOR (P.71)
(P.70)
AUTO IDLE STOP INDICATOR
LOW FUEL INDICATOR
(P.65, 332)
(P.66, 321, 322)
08/12/27 11:34:34 31TM8600 0066
2010 Insight
The instrument panel has manyindicators to give you importantinformation about your vehicle.
If your front passenger does notfasten their seat belt, the indicatorcomes on about 6 seconds after theignition switch is turned to the ON(II) position.
This indicator comes on when youturn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position. It reminds you and yourpassengers to fasten your seat belts.A beeper also sounds if you have notfastened your seat belt.
You will also see a ‘‘FASTEN SEATBELT’’ message on the multi-information display.
If you turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position before fasteningyour seat belt, the beeper soundsand the indicator flashes. If you donot fasten your seat belt before thebeeper stops, the indicator stopsflashing but remains on.
If either of you do not fasten yourseat belt while driving, the beeperwill sound and the indicator will flashagain at regular intervals, and youwill see a ‘‘FASTEN SEAT BELT’’ or‘‘FASTEN PASSENGER SEATBELT’’ message on the multi-information display. For moreinformation, see page .
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKEMISSION SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display. Formore information, see page .
The engine can be severely damagedif this indicator flashes or stays onwhen the engine is running, and youwill see a ‘‘CHECK ENGINE OILLEVEL’’ message on the multi-information display. For moreinformation, see page .
21
403
401
Instrument Panel Indicators
Seat Belt ReminderIndicator
Malfunction IndicatorLamp
Low Oil PressureIndicator
62
08/12/27 11:34:42 31TM8600 0067
2010 Insight
If it stays on after you have fullyreleased the parking brake whilethe engine is running, or if itcomes on while driving, it canindicate a problem in the brakesystem. You will also see a‘‘BRAKE FLUID LOW’’ or‘‘CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM’’message on the multi-informationdisplay. For more information, seepage .
This indicator comes on briefly whenyou turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position. It will then go off ifyou have inserted a properly codedignition key. If it is not a properlycoded key, the indicator will blink,and the engine’s fuel system will bedisabled (see page ).
This indicator has two functions:
If you drive without releasing theparking brake, a beeper will sound,and you will also see a ‘‘RELEASEPARKING BRAKE’’ message onthe multi-information display (seepage ).
It comes on when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. It is a reminder to checkthe parking brake. Driving withthe parking brake not fullyreleased can damage the brakesand tires.
If this indicator comes on when theengine is running, the 12 volt batteryis not being charged, and you willalso see a ‘‘CHECK CHARGINGSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display. For moreinformation, see page .
1.
2.
404
402
148126
Instrument Panel Indicators
Immobilizer SystemIndicator
Parking Brake andBrake SystemIndicator (Red)
12 Volt Battery ChargingSystem Indicator
Instruments
andC
ontrols
63
U.S. Canada
08/12/27 11:34:51 31TM8600 0068
2010 Insight
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position, and START (III) position.When the brake system indicator(amber) comes on and stays on,there is a problem with the CreepAid System or Brake Assist (thenormal brake operates properly).Have your vehicle checked by yourdealer. For more information, seepage .
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK BRAKESYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
This indicator comes on briefly whenyou turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position. If it comes on atany other time, it indicates apotential problem with your frontairbags. This indicator will also alertyou to a potential problem with yourside airbags, passenger’s side airbagcutoff system, side curtain airbags,automatic seat belt tensioners,driver’s seat position sensor, or thefront passenger’s weight sensors.You will also see a ‘‘CHECKAIRBAG SYSTEM’’ message on themulti-information display. For moreinformation, see page .
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position, and when the ignitionswitch is turned to the START (III)position. If this indicator comes on atany other time, there is a problem inthe ABS. If this happens, take thevehicle to your dealer to have itchecked. With this indicator on, yourvehicle still has normal brakingability but no anti-lock function. Youwill also see a ‘‘CHECK ABSSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display. For moreinformation, see page .
324
89326 34
Instrument Panel Indicators
Brake SystemIndicator(Amber)
Anti-lock Brake System(ABS) Indicator
Supplemental RestraintSystem Indicator
64
U.S. Canada
08/12/27 11:34:59 31TM8600 0069
2010 Insight
If equippedIf equipped It comes on as a reminder that you
have turned off the vehicle stabilityassist (VSA) system.
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position, and when the ignitionswitch is turned to the START (III)position. For more information, seepage .
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position, and when the ignitionswitch is turned to the START (III)position.It flashes when VSA is active (seepage ).
If it comes on and stays on at anyother time, or it does not come onwhen you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, there is aproblem with the VSA system. Youwill also see a ‘‘CHECK VSASYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display. Take yourvehicle to a dealer to have it checked.Without VSA, your vehicle still hasnormal driving ability, but will nothave VSA traction and stabilityenhancement. For more information,see page .
This indicator comes on briefly whenyou turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position. If it comes on atany other time, it indicates that thepassenger’s side airbag hasautomatically shut off. You will alsosee a ‘‘PASSENGER SIDE AIRBAGOFF’’ message on the multi-information display. For moreinformation, see page .34
332
332
332
Instrument Panel Indicators
VSA Off IndicatorVehicle Stability Assist(VSA) System IndicatorSide Airbag Off
Indicator
Instruments
andC
ontrols
65
U.S. Canada
08/12/27 11:35:10 31TM8600 0070
2010 Insight
If this happens, pull to the side of theroad when it is safe, check which tirehas lost pressure, and determine thecause. If it is because of a flat tire,replace the flat tire with the compactspare (see page ), and have theflat tire repaired as soon as possible.If two or more tires are underinflated,call a professional towing service.Refer to page for moreinformation.
If this indicator begins to flash,there is a problem with the tirepressure monitoring system(TPMS). You will also see a‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’message on the multi-informationdisplay. The indicator continues toflash for a while (approximately 1minute), then stays on. If thishappens, have your dealer checkthe system as soon as possible.For more information, see page
.
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position.
This indicator has two functions:
If it comes on while driving, itindicates that one or more of yourvehicle’s tires are significantly lowon pressure.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK TIREPRESSURE’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. If it comes on at any othertime, it indicates a problem in theintegrated motor assist (IMA)system. With the IMA indicator on,the vehicle may not accelerate as itnormally does. Have the vehiclechecked by the dealer as soon aspossible.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK IMASYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display.
See pages and .
1.
2.
321 322
328
412
387
329
Instrument Panel Indicators
Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator
IMA System Indicator
Auto Idle Stop Indicator
66
08/12/27 11:35:21 31TM8600 0071
2010 Insight
If the indicator begins to blink orstays on, you will also see a ‘‘WATERTEMP HOT’’ message on the multi-information display. This warningwill alert you that the engine shouldbe cooled down.
This indicator shows thetemperature of the engine coolant. Itnormally comes on when you turnthe ignition switch to the ON (II)position and goes off after a fewseconds. In normal drivingconditions, this indicator should notblink or stay on. In severe drivingconditions, such as very hot weatheror a long period of uphill driving, thisindicator may blink. This means theengine coolant temperature is high.If the indicator begins to blink whileyou are driving, be sure to slow downto prevent overheating. If theindicator stays on, pull safely to theside of the road and turn off theengine. See page for instructionsand precautions on checking theengine’s cooling system.
Do not drive the vehicle while theindicator is on or the engine may bedamaged.
This indicator shows thetemperature of the engine coolant. Ifthere is no problem, this indicatorcomes on when the engine is cold. Ifit comes on when the engine is warm(normal operating temperature),have the vehicle inspected by yourdealer as soon as possible.
398
Instrument Panel Indicators
High TemperatureIndicator
Low TemperatureIndicator
Instruments
andC
ontrols
67
08/12/27 11:35:28 31TM8600 0072
2010 Insight
This indicator normally comes onwhen you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position and goes offafter the engine starts. If it comes onat any other time, there is a problemin the electric power steering system.
If this happens, stop the vehicle in asafe place and turn off the engine.Reset the system by restarting theengine. The indicator will stay on,but should go off after driving ashort distance. If it does not go off,or comes back on again while driving,take the vehicle to your dealer tohave it checked. With the indicatoron, the EPS may be turned off,making the vehicle harder to steer.
If you turn the steering wheel to thefull left or right position repeatedlywhile stopping or driving at very lowspeed, you may feel slightly hardersteering in order to prevent damageto the steering box caused byoverheating.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK POWERSTEERING SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display.
This indicator comes on red if anydoor or the hatch lid is not closedtightly.
You will also see a correspondingindicator(s) on the multi-informationdisplay to indicate which door and/or the hatch is not closed tightly (seepage ).12
Electric Power Steering(EPS) Indicator
Door/Hatch OpenIndicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
68
08/12/27 11:35:36 31TM8600 0073
2010 Insight
This indicator comes on when youturn on the cruise control system bypressing the CRUISE button on thesteering wheel (see page ).
This indicator comes on when youset the cruise control. See page
for information on operating thecruise control.
This indicator reminds you that theexterior lights are on. It comes onwhen the light switch is in either the
or position. If you turn theignition switch to the ACCESSORY(I) or the LOCK (0) position withoutturning off the light switch, thisindicator will remain on. A reminderchime will also sound when you openthe driver’s door.
This indicator comes on with thehigh beam headlights. For moreinformation, see page .
This indicator also comes on withreduced brightness when thedaytime running lights (DRL) are on(see page ).
The left or right turn signal indicatorblinks when you signal a lane changeor turn. If an indicator does not blinkor blinks rapidly, it usually meansone of the turn signal bulbs isburned out (see pages and ).Replace the bulb as soon as possible,since other drivers cannot see thatyou are signaling.
When you press the hazard warningbutton, both turn signal indicatorsand all turn signals on the outside ofthe vehicle flash.
363 365
256
256
119
120
Cruise Main Indicator
Cruise Control Indicator
Lights On Indicator
High Beam Indicator
Turn Signal andHazard WarningIndicators
Instrument Panel IndicatorsInstrum
entsand
Controls
69
08/12/27 11:35:46 31TM8600 0074
2010 Insight
This indicator is in the fuel gauge. Itcomes on as a reminder that youmust refuel soon. You will also see a‘‘FUEL LOW’’ message on the multi-information display.
When the needle reaches E, there isa very small amount of fuel in thetank.
This indicator comes on when thereis a system message on the multi-information display. Press the INFObutton on the steering wheel (seepage ) to see the message (seepage ).
Most of the time, this indicatorcomes on along with other indicatorsin the instrument panel such as theseat belt reminder indicator, SRSindicator, VSA system indicator, etc.
This indicator comes on when thesecurity system is set. For moreinformation, see page .
When the indicator comes on, thereare about 1.8 U.S. gal (6.9 ) of fuelremaining in the tank.
7689
255
Low Fuel Indicator System MessageIndicator
Security System Indicator
Instrument Panel Indicators
70
LOW FUEL INDICATORSECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR
08/12/27 11:35:55 31TM8600 0075
2010 Insight
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. When you turn the econmode on by pressing the ECONbutton with the ignition switch in theON (II) position, this indicator willcome on.
You will also see the symbol on themulti-information display with ECONON or ECON OFF (see page ).75
ECON Mode Indicator
Instrument Panel IndicatorsInstrum
entsand
Controls
71
08/12/27 11:36:00 31TM8600 0076
2010 Insight
This shows your speed in kilometersper hour (km/h) or miles per hour(mph) depending on the selectedspeedometer display. You can switchthe display between km/h and mph(see page ).
The speedometer also has anambient meter. The color of theambient meter changesautomatically according to yourdriving style (see page ).
You can customize the setting of theambient meter (see page ).
73
306
103
Gauges
Speedometer/Ambient Meter
72
U.S. model is shown.
MULTI-INFORMATIONDISPLAY
SPEEDOMETER/AMBIENT METER
CHARGE/ASSIST GAUGE TACHOMETER FUEL GAUGE
KM/MILE CHANGE KNOB SEL/RESET KNOB
08/12/27 11:36:07 31TM8600 0077
2010 Insight
This shows how much fuel you have.It may show slightly more or lessthan the actual amount. The needlereturns to the bottom after you turnoff the ignition.
To switch the lower segment of themulti-information display betweenthe odometer with the outsidetemperature and trip meter with theoutside temperature, press the sel/reset knob repeatedly. For moreinformation, see page .
Each time you press and hold thekm/mile change knob, thespeedometer reading switchesbetween miles per hour (mph) andkilometers per hour (km/h).
78
Fuel GaugeSel/Reset Knob Km/Mile Change Knob
GaugesInstrum
entsand
Controls
73
SEL/RESET KNOB KM/MILE CHANGE KNOB
Avoid driving with an extremely lowf uel level. Running out of f uel couldcause the engine to misf ire, damagingthe catalytic converter.
08/12/27 11:36:14 31TM8600 0078
2010 Insight
This gauge shows you the charge/discharge status of the IntegratedMotor Assist (IMA). When the IMAis assisting the engine, the pointerstays in the assist gauge (upper partof the gauge). When the IMAbattery is being charged, the pointerstays in the charge gauge (lower partof the gauge).
You can also check the status of theIMA system function on the multi-information display (see page ).
If the IMA battery is too hot or toocold, the IMA system limits the IMAbattery’s output power to protect thebattery. This disables the IMA assistand auto idle stop, even though thebattery level indicator on the multi-information display may show thatthe battery is well-charged (see page
). Therefore, if the motor assistis frequently used, the batterybecomes hot and starts to limit itsoutput power.
It takes a short time to normalize theIMA battery’s output powerdepending on the weather.
84
85
Charge/Assist Gauge
Gauges
74
IMA ASSIST GAUGE
IMA CHARGE GAUGE
08/12/27 11:36:20 31TM8600 0079
2010 Insight
The multi-information display in theinstrument panel displays variousinformation and messages when theignition switch is in the ON (II)position. Some of the messages helpyou operate your vehicle morecomfortably. Others help to keepyou aware of the periodicmaintenance your vehicle needs forcontinued trouble-free driving.
If you do not fasten your seat belt,you will see a ‘‘FASTEN SEATBELT’’ message on the multi-information display when you turnthe ignition switch to the ON (II)position.
These messages go off severalseconds after the key is inserted intothe ignition switch.
There are three types of messages:normal display messages, engine oillife and maintenance messages, andsystem messages.
You can select the displayedlanguage and also customize somevehicle control settings to your likingwith the multi-information displayand the three buttons on the steeringwheel (see page ).
You will see an ‘‘ECON ON’’ or‘‘ECON OFF’’ message on the multi-information display according to theprevious ECON setting when youturn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position (see page ).
76
124
CONTINUED
Normal Display Messages
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
75
ECON is On. ECON is Off.
08/12/27 11:36:28 31TM8600 0080
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
The multi-information displaychanges to the blank display shownabove several seconds after you turnthe ignition switch to the ON (II)position.
With the ignition switch in the ON(II) position, the multi-informationdisplay changes as shown on thenext page each time you press theINFO ( / ) button or the SEL/RESET button.
Multi-Information Display
76
U.S. model is shown.
SEL/RESET BUTTON
INFO ( / ) BUTTON
Models with cruise controlSEL/RESET BUTTON
Models without cruise control
INFO BUTTONS ( / )
08/12/27 11:36:34 31TM8600 0081
2010 Insight
In the normal display mode, theupper and middle segments displaytrip computer information, such asfuel economy or average speed. Thelower segment displays theodometer/trip meter (A/B), outsidetemperature, and engine oil life andmaintenance item code(s).
In the multi-information display, thesystem message is also displayed(see page ) and you cancustomize your vehicle controlsettings (see page ).
The multi-information displayconsists of an upper segment, amiddle segment and a lowersegment.
88
91
CONTINUED
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
77
MIDDLESEGMENT
U.S. model is shown.
LOWERSEGMENT
UPPERSEGMENT
08/12/27 11:36:40 31TM8600 0082
2010 Insight
*
▼▲
*
Multi-Information Display
78
U.S. model is shown.
: This display will be shown when theBluetooth HandsFreeLink is activated.
IMA System PowerFlow Monitor/IMA Battery LevelIndicator(See page 84/85)
: Press the INFO button .
: Press the INFO button .
: Press the SEL/RESET button.
HFL (See page 87)
Average FuelEconomy Record(See page 81)
Engine Oil Life(See page 80)
Outside Temperature(See page 80)
Trip Computer (See page 81)
Eco GuideFeedbackMonitor(See page 81)
08/12/27 11:36:47 31TM8600 0083
2010 Insight
The odometer shows the totaldistance your vehicle has beendriven. It measures miles in U.S.models and kilometers in Canadianmodels. It is illegal under U.S.federal law and Canadian provincialregulations to disconnect, reset, oralter the odometer with the intent tochange the number of miles orkilometers indicated.
This meter shows the number ofmiles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada)driven since you last reset it. Thereare two trip meters: Trip A and TripB. Each trip meter worksindependently, so you can keep trackof two different distances.
When you reset Trip A, average fueleconomy A is reset at the same time.When you reset Trip B, average fueleconomy B is reset.
In the customizing mode, you can setTrip A and average fuel economy Ato reset at the same time when yourefuel your vehicle (see page ).
To reset a trip meter, display it, thenpress and hold the SEL/RESETbutton until the number resets to‘‘0.0’’.
99
Odometer Trip Meter
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
79
TRIP METER A TRIP METER B
ODOMETER U.S. model is shown.
U.S. CANADA
08/12/27 11:36:56 31TM8600 0084
2010 Insight
This shows the outside Fahrenheittemperature in U.S. models, andCelsius temperature in Canadianmodels.
In certain weather conditions,temperature readings near freezing(32°F, 0°C) could mean that ice isforming on the road surface.
You can adjust the outsidetemperature display (see page ).
The temperature sensor is in thefront bumper. The temperaturereading can be affected by heatreflection from the road surface,engine heat, and the exhaust fromsurrounding traffic. This can causean incorrect temperature readingwhen your vehicle speed is under19 mph (30 km/h). When you startyour trip, the sensor is not fullyacclimatized, therefore it may takeseveral minutes until the propertemperature is displayed.
This shows the remaining engine oillife. It shows 100% after the engineoil is replaced and the display is reset.The engine oil life is calculatedbased on engine operating conditions.For more information, see page .337
98
Outside Temperature Engine Oil Life
Multi-Information Display
80
OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE
ENGINE OIL LIFE
U.S. CANADA
08/12/27 11:37:04 31TM8600 0085
2010 Insight
Eco guide feedback monitor consistsof three parts. The eco-drive scoredisplay shows the accumulated ecoscore for one driving cycle. Theacceleration monitor showsacceleration efficiency. Thedeceleration monitor showsdeceleration efficiency. See page
for more information.
The average fuel economy recordsdisplay shows the average fueleconomy (0) for the current drivingcycle and (1-3) for the last threedriving cycles in mpg (U.S. models)or l/100 km (Canadian models).
Indicators in the trip computer show:
Average Fuel Economy
RangeElapsed TimeAverage Vehicle Speed
Instant Fuel Economy
305
CONTINUED
Eco Guide Feedback Monitor Average Fuel Economy Records Trip Computer
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
81
U.S. model is shown.
DECELERATIONMONITOR
ACCELERATIONMONITOR
LATESTAVERAGE FUELECONOMY
PAST AVERAGEFUEL ECONOMY
ECO-DRIVE SCORE DISPLAYU.S. CANADA
08/12/27 11:37:15 31TM8600 0086
2010 Insight
Mile indication (U.S. models)
Kilometer indication (Canadian models)
Average Fuel Economy A
Average Fuel Economy B
: This shows your vehicle’s instantfuel economy in mpg.
: This shows your vehicle’s averagefuel economy in mpg (U.S. models)or liter/100 km (Canadian models)since you last reset trip computer A.
: This shows your vehicle’s averagefuel economy in mpg (U.S. models)or liter/100 km (Canadian models)since you last reset trip computer B.
You can customize the Trip A andAverage Fuel Economy A resetcondition on the multi-informationdisplay (see page ).
: This shows your vehicle’s instantfuel economy in L/100 km.
When you turn off the engine, theinstant fuel economy (mpg or L/100km) is also reset.
The average fuel economy will bereset when you reset the trip meter,or if the vehicle’s 12 volt battery goesdead or is disconnected.
99
Average Fuel Economy A/BInstant Fuel Economy
Multi-Information Display
82
U.S.
CANADA
AVERAGE FUELECONOMY A
AVERAGE FUELECONOMY B
CANADAU.S.
INSTANTFUELECONOMY
08/12/27 11:37:27 31TM8600 0087
2010 Insight
This shows the average speed youare traveling in miles per hour (mph)for U.S. models or kilometers perhour (km/h) for Canadian models.
This shows the accumulatedtraveling time since you last reset it.When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, ELAPSEDTIME is reset.
This shows the estimated distanceyou can travel on the fuel remainingin the fuel tank. This distance isestimated from the fuel economyyou received over the last severalmiles(U.S.) or kilometers (Canada),so it will vary with changes in speed,traffic, etc.
If you want to reset the ELAPSEDTIME manually, go to the tripcomputer’s ELAPSED TIME display,and press and hold the SEL/RESETbutton until the number resets.
You can customize the ELAPSEDTIME reset conditions on the multi-information display (see page ).
To reset the AVG. SPEED reading,press and hold the SEL/RESETbutton until the number resets.
100
ELAPSED TIMERANGE AVG. SPEED
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
83
08/12/27 11:37:34 31TM8600 0088
2010 Insight
The IMA system power flow monitorshows the status of the IMA system.The energy source, and poweringstatus of the engine and IMA motor(engine operation icon and IMAbattery) are represented by arrowson the display The battery levelindicator shows the state of chargeof the IMA battery.
The table in the next column showsthe basic monitoring displayexamples and their descriptions.
ExampleDescriptionsOnly IMA motor ispowering the vehicle andIMA battery is discharging.
IMA motor is assisting theengine with powering thevehicle. IMA battery isdischarging and the systemis consuming fuel.IMA system is chargingIMA battery.
Only engine is poweringvehicle. The system isconsuming fuel.
Engine is powering vehicleand IMA system is chargingIMA battery. The system isconsuming fuel.
IMA System Power Flow Monitor Powering Status
Multi-Information Display
84
IMA BATTERY/BATTERYLEVEL INDICATOR
POWER FLOW
ENGINEOPERATIONICON
08/12/27 11:37:44 31TM8600 0089
2010 Insight
The IMA battery level indicatorshows you the state of charge of thebattery for the Integrated MotorAssist (IMA). This battery isrecharged and discharged by theIMA motor depending on the drivingconditions.
The position of the battery levelreading shows the state of charge ofthe IMA battery. When the batterylevel reading is high, the IMAbattery is well charged. There areseven positions (Level 0-Level 6) ofthe battery level reading.
The battery level reading may dropnear the bottom under drivingconditions that require IMA motorassistance for a long time, such asprolonged acceleration or climbing along hill.
The IMA motor will recharge thebattery as you continue driving.
CONTINUED
IMA Battery Level Indicator
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
85
LEVEL READING
Lowestlevel ofstate ofcharge
Highestlevel ofstate ofcharge
IMA BATTERY LEVEL INDICATOR
Level 0 Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Level 4 Level 5 Level 6
08/12/27 11:37:52 31TM8600 0090
2010 Insight
On vehicle with paddle shifters
On vehicle without paddle shifters
The IMA battery is charged at ahigher rate when the transmission isin L (Low) mode (see page ).
The battery level gauge does notread the battery level directly. Itcalculates the level by continuouslymeasuring the current flow, voltage,and temperature.
If the battery is mostly discharged,the Auto Idle Stop function isdisabled (see page ).
The IMA battery is charged at ahigher rate when the transmission isin LOW (L) range (see page ).
Since the level is not read directly,small sensing errors can, over time,cause the gauge to read higher thanthe actual battery level. The systemwill then perform a correction, andthe battery level gauge reading willdrop suddenly. When this happens,IMA assist and Auto Idle Stop aredisabled until the IMA battery issufficiently recharged by normaldriving.
This correction of the battery levelgauge is normal and does notindicate a problem. If the IMAbattery develops a problem orbecomes deteriorated, the IMAsystem indicator will come on. If thishappens, have the vehicle checkedby your dealer as soon as possible.
320
314
322
Multi-Information Display
86
08/12/27 11:37:59 31TM8600 0091
2010 Insight
To use the system, your cell phoneand the HFL system must be linked.Not all cell phones are compatiblewith this system. Refer to page
for instructions on how to linkyour cell phone to HFL and how toreceive or make phone calls, or visitthe handsfreelink.com website. InCanada, visit , or call 1-(888) 9-HONDA-9.
You can receive or make phone callsfrom your cell phone through yourvehicle’s BluetoothHandsFreeLink (HFL) systemwithout touching your cell phone.
259
www.honda.ca
On models with navigation system
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
87
08/12/27 11:38:04 31TM8600 0092
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
▲ ▼If there is a problem with yourvehicle, for example the engine oillevel is low or a door is not fullyclosed, the multi-information displaywill show you the problem. It doesthis by interrupting the currentdisplay with one or more messages.
The system message(s) triggers theappropriate indicator(s) on theinstrument panel, including thesystem message indicator, to comeon. The system message indicatordoes not go off until the problem(s)is corrected.
You will also hear a beep when thesystem message comes on for thefirst time.
Most of the messages are displayedfor about 5 seconds, and then thenormal display returns. If there areseveral system messages to beshown, the display switches thesemessages every 5 seconds.
To switch the message(s) before 5seconds have elapsed, press theINFO ( / ) button on the steeringwheel.
Even if you press the INFO ( / )button, some messages stay on orcome on again at regular intervalsuntil the problem is corrected.
If the system message indicatorremains lit on the instrument panel,you can see the correspondingmessage(s) again by pressing theINFO ( / ) button repeatedly.
Here is a list of all messages:
System Messages
Multi-Information Display
88
SYSTEM MESSAGE INDICATOR
08/12/27 11:38:12 31TM8600 0093
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
See page12
See page13
See page13
See page21
See page21
See page34
See page34
See page357
See page404
See page403
See page402
See page326
See page401
See page65
See page148
See page404
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
89
U.S.
U.S.
Canada
Canada
08/12/27 11:38:26 31TM8600 0094
2010 Insight
See page332
See page328
See page329
See page399
See page311
See page70
See page68
See page355
See page338
See page339
See page340
See page80
See page286
See page128
See page128
See page129
See page120
Multi-Information Display
90
U.S.only
U.S.only
Canadaonly
08/12/27 11:38:39 31TM8600 0095
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
You can customize some vehiclecontrol settings. To enter thecustomizing mode, press and holdeither INFO button ( / ) for morethan 3 seconds. To change thesettings, the ignition switch must bein the ON (II) position, and thevehicle must be stopped with thetransmission in Park.
If you turn the ignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) or the LOCK (0)position, or move the shift lever outof Park, the display will change tothe normal screen.
If you try to enter the customizingmode while the vehicle is moving,you will see a ‘‘MUST STOP ANDSHIFT TO PARK TO CHANGESETTINGS’’ message and youcannot change the settings.
If you want to change any vehiclecontrol settings, select CHGSETTING, then press the SEL/RESET button.
Refer to the table on the followingpages about the settings you want tocustomize.
CONTINUED
Customized Settings
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
91
08/12/27 11:38:46 31TM8600 0096
2010 Insight
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
- ~± ~
- ~± ~
*
TRIP B
15 sec
Changes the language used in the display.
Changes the outside temperature reading above orbelow its current reading.
Causes trip meter A and the average fuel economyto reset when you refuel.Resets the elapsed time of your current trip.
Changes the displayed measurement on the multi-information display.
Turn the ambient meter feature on or off.
Changes how long (in seconds) the interior lightsstay on after you close the doors.
ENGLISHFRENCHSPANISH
5°F 0°F 5°F(U.S.)
3°C 0°C 3°C(Canada)ONOFFIGN OFFTRIP AAUTOKMMILESONOFF60 sec30 sec
METER SETUP(P.96)
LIGHTING SETUP(P.104)
97
98
99
100
101
103
105
LANGUAGE SELECTION
ADJUST OUTSIDETEMP. DISPLAY
TRIP A RESET with REFUEL
ELAPSED TIME RESET
DISPLAY KM/MILES
METER COLOR CHANGE
INTERIOR LIGHTDIMMING TIME
Default setting:
Description Setting OptionGroup Setup PageMenu Item
Multi-Information Display
92
08/12/27 11:38:52 31TM8600 0097
2010 Insight
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Menu Item Description Setting OptionGroup Setup PageAUTO DOOR LOCK
AUTO DOOR UNLOCK
DOOR LOCK MODE
KEYLESS LOCKACKNOWLEDGMENT
SECURITY RELOCKTIMER
Changes when the doors automatically lock.
Changes when the doors automatically unlock.
Changes which doors unlock with the remotetransmitter in a first push.The exterior lights flash each time you press theLOCK or UNLOCK button. A beeper will alsosound when you press the LOCK button twice.Changes how long it takes (in seconds) for thedoors to relock and the security system to set afteryou unlock but do not open the door.Set/Cancel all the customized settings as default.
SHIFT FROM PWITH VEH SPDOFF
IGN OFFOFFDRIVER DOORALL DOORSONOFF
90 sec60 sec30 secSETCANCEL
DOOR SETUP(P.106)
DEFAULT ALL(P.115)
107
108
110
112
113
115
Default setting:
SHIFT TO P DRIVER DOOR /ALL DOORS
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
93
08/12/27 11:38:58 31TM8600 0098
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
▲▼
▲ ▼
You can customize some of thevehicle control settings to yourpreference. Here are the settingsyou can customize:
METER SETUP
When you want to change thevehicle control settings, press theINFO ( / ) button to select CHGSETTING, then press the SEL/RESET button.
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown on the next page. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe setup you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
If you do not make any changes,select ‘‘EXIT.’’ The display returns tothe normal display.
You can also use the select/resetknob in the instrument panel. Turnthe knob to select a setting and pressit to enter your selection.
If you want the settings as they werewhen the vehicle left the factory,select DEFAULT ALL, as describedon page .
LIGHTING SETUPDOOR SETUP
115
Customize Settings
Multi-Information Display
94
08/12/27 11:39:06 31TM8600 0099
2010 Insight
▼▲
▲ ▼
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
95
NORMAL DISPLAY
CANADA
U.S.
METER SETUPSee page 96
LIGHTING SETUPSee page 104
DOOR SETUPSee page 106
: Press the SEL/RESET button.
: Press the INFO button .
: Press the INFO button .
: Press and hold the INFO ( / ) button.
08/12/27 11:39:13 31TM8600 0100
2010 Insight
▲▼
▲ ▼
▼▲
LANGUAGE SELECTIONADJUST OUTSIDE TEMP.DISPLAY
Here are the four custom settingsfor the meter setup:
TRIP A RESET with REFUEL
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown in the illustration. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe setting you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
While ‘‘METER SETUP’’ is shown,press the SEL/RESET button toenter the customize mode.
METER COLOR CHANGEDISPLAY KM/MILESELAPSED TIME RESET
Meter Setup
Multi-Information Display
96
: Press the SEL/RESET button.
: Press the INFO button .
: Press the INFO button .
See page 103 See page 101
See page 97 See page 98 See page 99 See page100
08/12/27 11:39:24 31TM8600 0101
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
Language Selection
There are three language selectionsyou can make: English, French, andSpanish. To choose the language youwant, follow these instructions:
You can choose this item tocustomize from ‘‘METER SETUP’’by pressing the INFO ( / ) buttonrepeatedly.
Press the SEL/RESET button to seethe selections.
Select the desired language bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then enter your selection by pressingthe SEL/RESET button.
When your selection is successfullycompleted, the display changes asshown above, and then goes back tothe customize item screen.
If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’message appears, go back to‘‘LANGUAGE SELECTION’’ andrepeat the procedure again.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
97
08/12/27 11:39:32 31TM8600 0102
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
Adjust Outside Temp. Display
If you sometimes find that thetemperature reading is a fewdegrees above or below the actualtemperature, you can adjust it byfollowing these instructions:
Adjust the outside temperature valueby pressing the INFO ( / ) buttonrepeatedly. Press the SEL/RESETbutton to set the desired value.
When your selection is successfullycompleted, the display changes asshown above, and then goes back tothe customize item screen.
If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’message appears, go back to‘‘ADJUST OUTSIDE TEMP.DISPLAY’’ and repeat the procedureagain.
You can choose this item tocustomize from ‘‘METER SETUP’’by pressing the INFO ( / ) buttonrepeatedly.Press the SEL/RESET button toenter the setting.
Multi-Information Display
98
Canadian models Canadian modelsU.S. modelsU.S. models
08/12/27 11:39:41 31TM8600 0103
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
Press the SEL/RESET button to seethe selections.
Select ON or OFF by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then enteryour selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
When your selection is successfullycompleted, the display changes asshown above, and then goes back tothe customize item screen.
To cause Trip A and average fuel fortrip A to reset every time you refuelyour vehicle, follow theseinstructions:
You can choose this item tocustomize from ‘‘METER SETUP’’by pressing the INFO ( / ) buttonrepeatedly.
If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’message appears, go back to ‘‘TRIPA RESET with REFUEL’’ and repeatthe procedure again.
Trip A Reset With Refuel
CONTINUED
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
99
08/12/27 11:39:49 31TM8600 0104
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
-
-
-
Elapsed Time Reset
You can choose this item tocustomize from ‘‘METER SETUP’’by pressing the INFO ( / ) buttonrepeatedly.
Press the SEL/RESET button to seethe selections.
Select the desired setting bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then enter your selection by pressingthe SEL/RESET button.
There are three elapsed time resetchoices you can make:
IGN OFF The elapsed time isreset when you turn the ignitionswitch to the LOCK (0) position.
TRIP A The elapsed time is resetwhen Trip A is reset.
TRIP B The elapsed time is resetwhen Trip B is reset.
Multi-Information Display
100
08/12/27 11:39:57 31TM8600 0105
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
When your selection is successfullycompleted, the display changes asshown above, and then goes back tothe customize item screen.
If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’message appears, go back to‘‘ELAPSED TIME RESET’’ andrepeat the procedure again.
To change the displayedmeasurement in the trip computerand trip information and to switchbetween kilometers and miles, followthese instructions:
You can choose this item tocustomize from ‘‘METER SETUP’’by pressing the INFO ( / ) buttonrepeatedly.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information Display
Display Km/Miles
Instruments
andC
ontrols
101
08/12/27 11:40:04 31TM8600 0106
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
Press the SEL/RESET button to seethe selections.
Select AUTO, KM, or MILES bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then enter your selection by pressingthe SEL/RESET button.
AUTO: When you press the km/milechange knob in the instrument panelto switch the speedometer readingbetween miles per hour (mph) andkilometers per hour (km/h), thedisplayed measurement in the tripcomputer and trip information, alsoswitches to kilometers or milesdepending on the selectedspeedometer reading.
KM: The displayed measurement inthe trip computer and tripinformation is set to kilometers.
MILES: The displayed measurementin the trip computer and tripinformation is set to miles.
When your selection is successfullycompleted, the display changes asshown above, and then goes back tothe customize item screen.
If the ‘‘DISPLAY KM/MILESSETTING INCOMPLETE’’ messageappears, go back to ‘‘DISPLAY KM/MILES’’ and repeat the procedureagain.
Multi-Information Display
102
08/12/27 11:40:11 31TM8600 0107
2010 Insight
▲ ▼▲ ▼
You can turn the ambient meterfeature on or off (see page ).
You can choose this item tocustomize from ‘‘METER SETUP’’by pressing the INFO ( / ) buttonrepeatedly.
Press the SEL/RESET button to seethe selections.
Select ON or OFF by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then enteryour selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
When your selection is successfullycompleted, the display changes asshown above, and then goes back tothe customize item screen.
If the ‘‘METER COLOR CHANGESETTING INCOMPLETE’’ messageappears, go back to ‘‘METERCOLOR CHANGE’’ and repeat theprocedure again.
72
Meter Color Change
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
103
08/12/27 11:40:19 31TM8600 0108
2010 Insight
▲▼
▲ ▼
▼▲
There is one custom setting for thelighting setup:
INTERIOR LIGHTDIMMING TIME
While ‘‘LIGHTING SETUP’’ isshown, press the SEL/RESETbutton to enter the customize mode.
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown in the illustration. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe setting you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
Lighting Setup
Multi-Information Display
104
: Press the SEL/RESET button.
: Press the INFO button .
: Press the INFO button .
See page105
08/12/27 11:40:26 31TM8600 0109
2010 Insight
▲▼
▲ ▼
Interior Light Dimming Time
Press the SEL/RESET button to seethe selections.
When your selection is successfullycompleted, the display changes asshown above, and then goes back tothe customize item screen.
If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’message appears, go back to‘‘INTERIOR LIGHT DIMMINGTIME’’ and repeat the procedureagain.
The interior lights fade out when youclose all doors. To change how longthe lights stay on before they fadeout, follow these instructions:
You can choose this item tocustomize from ‘‘LIGHTINGSETUP’’ by pressing the INFO ( /
) button repeatedly.
Select the desired setting (15 SEC,30 SEC, or 60 SEC) by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then enteryour selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
105
08/12/27 11:40:34 31TM8600 0110
2010 Insight
▲▼
▲ ▼
▲▼
AUTO DOOR LOCK
Here are the five custom settings forthe door setup:
While ‘‘DOOR SETUP’’ is shown,press the SEL/RESET button toenter the customize mode.
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown in the illustration. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe setting you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
KEYLESS LOCKACKNOWLEDGMENTSECURITY RELOCK TIMER
AUTO DOOR UNLOCKDOOR LOCK MODE
Door Setup
Multi-Information Display
106
: Press the INFO button .
: Press the INFO button .
: Press the SEL/RESET button.
See page107
See page108
See page113
See page112
See page110
08/12/27 11:40:44 31TM8600 0111
2010 Insight
-
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
-
-
Auto Door LockThere are three settings you canchoose from:
SHIFT FROM PThe doors lock whenever you movethe shift lever out of Park.
Select the desired setting bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then enter your selection by pressingthe SEL/RESET button.
You can choose this item tocustomize from ‘‘DOOR SETUP’’ bypressing the INFO ( / ) buttonrepeatedly.
Press the SEL/RESET button toenter the selecting mode.
WITH VEHICLE SPEEDThe doors lock when the vehiclespeed reaches about 10 mph (about16 km/h).
OFFThe auto door lock mode isdeactivated all the time.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
107
A/T model is shown.
08/12/27 11:40:53 31TM8600 0112
2010 Insight
-
-
When your selection is successfullycompleted, the display changes asshown above, and then goes back tothe customize item screen.
If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’message appears, go back to ‘‘AUTODOOR LOCK’’ and repeat theprocedure again.
There are five possible settings youcan choose from:
DRIVER DOOR WITH SHIFT TO PThe driver’s door unlocks when
you move the shift lever to Park.
ALL DOORS WITH SHIFT TO PAll the doors unlock when you movethe shift lever to Park.
Auto Door Unlock
Multi-Information Display
108
08/12/27 11:40:59 31TM8600 0113
2010 Insight
-
-
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
-
DRIVER DOOR WITH IGN OFFThe driver’s door unlocks when youturn the ignition switch to the LOCK(0) position.
ALL DOORS WITH IGN OFF Allthe doors unlock when you turn theignition switch to the LOCK (0)position.
You can choose this item tocustomize from ‘‘DOOR SETUP’’ bypressing the INFO ( / ) buttonrepeatedly.
Press the SEL/RESET button toenter the selecting mode.
Select the desired setting bypressing the INFO ( / ) button.
For example, you choose ‘‘DRIVERDOOR with SHIFT to P,’’ you willsee the above display.
OFF The auto door unlock isdeactivated all the time.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
109
08/12/27 11:41:07 31TM8600 0114
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
Press the SEL/RESET button toenter your selection.
When your selection is successfullycompleted, the display changes asshown above, and then goes back tothe customize item screen.
If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’message appears, go back to ‘‘AUTODOOR UNLOCK’’ and repeat theprocedure again.
To select whether the driver’s doorunlocks or all the doors unlock whenyou unlock the doors with theremote transmitter or the key, followthese instructions.
You can choose this item tocustomize from ‘‘DOOR SETUP’’ bypressing the INFO ( / ) buttonrepeatedly.
If you choose ‘‘ALL DOORS WithIGN OFF,’’ you will see the abovedisplay.
Door Lock Mode
Multi-Information Display
110
08/12/27 11:41:15 31TM8600 0115
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
Press the SEL/RESET button toenter the selecting mode.
Select the desired setting bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then enter your selection by pressingthe SEL/RESET button.
When your selection is successfullycompleted, the display changes asshown above, and then goes back tothe customize item screen.
If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’message appears, go back to ‘‘DOORLOCK MODE’’ and repeat theprocedure again.
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
111
08/12/27 11:41:21 31TM8600 0116
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
Press the SEL/RESET button toenter the selecting mode.
Select ON or OFF by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then enteryour selection by pressing the SEL/RESET button.
You can choose this item tocustomize from ‘‘DOOR SETUP’’ bypressing the INFO ( / ) buttonrepeatedly.
When you push the LOCK button onthe remote transmitter, someexterior lights flash, and a beepersounds when you push the LOCKbutton again within 5 seconds toverify that the doors and the trunkare locked and the security systemhas set (see page ). You cancustomize the exterior lights not toflash and the beeper not to sound.
255
Keyless Lock Acknowledgment
Multi-Information Display
112
08/12/27 11:41:27 31TM8600 0117
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
Security Relock TimerIf you unlock the doors with theremote transmitter, but do not openany of the doors within 30 seconds,the doors and the fuel fill door,automatically relock, and thesecurity system sets.
You can change this relock timefrom 30 seconds to 60 or 90 seconds.
When your selection is successfullycompleted, the display changes asshown above, and then goes back tothe customize item screen.
If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’message appears, go back to‘‘KEYLESS LOCKACKNOWLEDGMENT’’ and repeatthe procedure again.
You can choose this item tocustomize from ‘‘DOOR SETUP’’ bypressing the INFO ( / ) buttonrepeatedly.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
113
08/12/27 11:41:34 31TM8600 0118
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
If the ‘‘SETTING INCOMPLETE’’message appears, go back to‘‘SECURITY RELOCK TIMER’’ andrepeat the procedure again.
When your selection is successfullycompleted, the display changes asshown above, and then goes back tothe customize item screen.
Press the SEL/RESET button toenter the selecting mode.
Select the desired setting bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then enter your selection by pressingthe SEL/RESET button.
Multi-Information Display
114
08/12/27 11:41:40 31TM8600 0119
2010 Insight
▲ ▼ ▲ ▼If you want to set the default settings,press the INFO ( / ) button toselect DEFAULT ALL, then pressthe SEL/RESET button.
If the setting is not successfullycompleted, ‘‘FAILED’’ is shown forseveral seconds, and then the screengoes back to the normal messagemode. Repeat the same procedure toselect DEFAULT ALL.
If you want to cancel DEFAULTALL, select CANCEL, then press theSEL/RESET button. The screengoes back to the previous display.
To set the default settings, press theINFO ( / ) button to select SETthen press the SEL/RESET button.
When DEFAULT ALL is set, you willsee the above display for severalseconds, then the screen returns tothe default all setting display.
DEFAULT ALL
Multi-Information DisplayInstrum
entsand
Controls
115
08/12/27 11:41:47 31TM8600 0120
2010 Insight
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
***
To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel.
Only on vehicles equipped with navigation system. Refer to the navigation system manual.If equipped
1 :2 :3 :
Controls Near the Steering Wheel
116
HEADLIGHTS/TURN SIGNALS
HORN
INSTRUMENT PANELBRIGHTNESS
VEHICLE STABILITYASSIST (VSA) OFFSWITCH
STEERING WHEELADJUSTMENT
CRUISE CONTROL BUTTONSMULTI-INFORMATION BUTTONS
AUXILIARY INPUT JACK
MULTI-INFORMATION BUTTONS
ECON BUTTON
WINDSHIELD WIPERS/WASHERS
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER/HEATED MIRROR
CLOCK
ACCESSORY POWER SOCKET
REMOTE AUDIOCONTROL BUTTONS
NAVIGATION SYSTEMVOICE CONTROLBUTTONS
BLUETOOTH HANDS-FREE LINK SYSTEMVOICE CONTROL BUTTONS
AUDIO SYSTEM
(P.333)
(P.251)
(P.259)
(P.259)
(P.252)
(P.254)
(P.166)
(P.256)
(P.198)NAVIGATION SYSTEM /AUDIO SYSTEM
MIRROR CONTROLS
(P.118)
(P.144)
(P.124)
(P.125) (P.153)
(P.123/145)
(P.121)
EX model with navigation system is shown.
(P.117)
(P.76)
(P.76)
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
2
3
2
08/12/27 11:41:55 31TM8600 0121
2010 Insight
-
-
-
-
-
---
-
Push the right lever up or down toselect a position.
The wipers run at highspeed until you release the lever.
The wipers are not activated.
The wipers run at low speed.
The wipers run at high speed.
Pull thewiper control lever toward you, andhold it. The washers spray until yourelease the lever. The wipers run atlow speed, then complete one moresweep after you release the lever.
MISTOFFINT IntermittentLO Low speedHI High speedWindshield washers
The length of the wipeinterval is varied automaticallyaccording to vehicle’s speed.
Vary the delay by turning theadjustment ring. If you turn it to theshortest delay ( position), thewipers change to low speedoperation when the vehicle speedexceeds 12 mph (20 km/h).
The length of the wiper interval isvaried automatically according to thevehicle’s speed.
1.2.3.4.5.6.
On all models except LX
MIST
OFF
LO
HI
Windshield Washer
INT
Windshield Wipers and Washers
Instruments
andC
ontrols
117
ADJUSTMENT RING
08/12/27 11:42:05 31TM8600 0122
2010 Insight
Turn SignalOFFParking and interior lightsHeadlights onHigh BeamsFlash high beams
Rotate the switchcounterclockwise also to spray thewindow washer and turn the wiperon.
Hold past ON to activate the rearwindow wiper a few times and tospray the rear window washer.
Rotate the switch clockwise toturn the rear window wiper ON.The wiper operates every 7seconds after completing twosweeps.
When you turn the wiper switch tothe ‘‘OFF’’ position, the wiper willreturn to its parked position.
OFF
The rear window washer uses thesame fluid reservoir as the wind-shield washer.
When you shift the transmission tothe reverse position with the frontwindshield wiper activated, the rearwiper operates automatically even ifthe rear wiper switch is off.
1.2.3.4.5.6.
4.
3.
1.
2.
Turn Signal and HeadlightsRear Window Wiper and Washer
Windshield Wipers and Washers, Turn Signal and Headlights
118
08/12/27 11:42:14 31TM8600 0123
2010 Insight
- - -Push down on theleft lever to signal a left turn and upto signal a right turn. To signal a lanechange, push lightly on the lever andhold it. The lever will return to thecenter when you release it orcomplete a turn.
Turning the switch tothe ‘‘ ’’ position turns on theparking lights, taillights, instrumentpanel lights, side-marker lights, andrear license plate lights.
Turning the switch to the ‘‘ ’’position turns on the headlights.
When the light switch is in the‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ ’’ position, thelights on indicator comes on as areminder.
This indicator stays on if you leavethe lights on and turn the ignitionswitch to the ACCESSORY (I) orLOCK (0) position.
If you leave the lights on with thekey removed from the ignitionswitch, you will hear a reminderchime when you open the driver’sdoor.
Push the left leverforward until you hear a click. Theblue high beam indicator will comeon (see page ). Pull the lever backto return to the low beams.
To flash the high beams, pull thelever back lightly, then release it.The high beams will stay on as longas you hold the lever back.
69
Turn Signal Headlights High Beams
Turn Signals and HeadlightsInstrum
entsand
Controls
119
08/12/27 11:42:21 31TM8600 0124
2010 Insight
With the headlight switch off or inthe position, the high beamheadlights and the high beamindicator come on with reducedbrightness when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position and release the parkingbrake. They remain on until you turnthe ignition switch off, even if youset the parking brake.
The headlights revert to normaloperation when you turn them onwith the switch.
If you see a ‘‘CHECK DRLSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display, there is aproblem with the daytime runninglight system. Take your vehicle to adealer to have it checked.
Daytime Running Lights
Headlights
120
08/12/27 11:42:26 31TM8600 0125
2010 Insight
To reduce glare at night, theinstrument panel illumination dimswhen you turn the light switch to the
or position. Turning theknob to the right until you hear atone will cancel the reducedbrightness.
The instrument panel will illuminatewith reduced brightness when youunlock and open the driver’s door.The brightness will increase slightlywhen you insert the key in theignition switch, then go to normalbrightness when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position.
The knob on the instrument panelcontrols the brightness of theinstrument panel lights. Turn theknob to adjust the brightness withthe ignition switch in the ON (II)position and the parking lights on.
When you turn the knob, the multi-information display changes tovertical bars that show you thecurrent level.
You will hear a tone when you reachthe maximum or minimumbrightness. The brightness levelgoes out about 5 seconds after youstop adjusting.
CONTINUED
Instrument Panel BrightnessInstrum
entsand
Controls
121
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRIGHTNESSCONTROL KNOB
BRIGHTNESS LEVEL
08/12/27 11:42:33 31TM8600 0126
2010 Insight
If you do not insert the key in theignition switch after opening thedriver’s door, the illumination turnsoff about 30 seconds after you closethe door.
If you insert the key but do not turnthe ignition switch to the ON (II)position, the illumination turns off inabout 10 seconds.
Push the button next to the audiosystem to turn on the hazardwarning lights (four-way flashers).This causes all four outside turnsignal lights and both turn signalindicators in the instrument panel toflash. Use the hazard warning lightsif you need to park in a dangerousarea near heavy traffic, or if yourvehicle is disabled.
Hazard Warning Button
Instrument Panel Brightness, Hazard Warning Button
122
HAZARD WARNING BUTTON
08/12/27 11:42:38 31TM8600 0127
2010 Insight
The defogger will shut itself offwithin about 10 to 30 minutesaccording to the outside temperature(over 32°F, 0°C).
Make sure all rear windows are clearand you have good visibility beforestarting to drive.
Pushing this button also turns themirror heaters on or off. For moreinformation, see page .
The defogger and antenna wires onthe inside of all rear windows can beaccidentally damaged. Whencleaning the glass, always wipe side-to-side.The rear window defogger will clear
fog, frost, and thin ice from thewindows. Push the defogger buttonto turn it on and off. The indicator inthe button comes on to show thedefogger is on. It also shuts off whenyou turn off the ignition switch. Youhave to turn the defogger on againwhen you restart the vehicle.
145
U.S. EX models and all Canadian models
Rear Window DefoggerInstrum
entsand
Controls
123
U.S. EX model is shown.
08/12/27 11:42:44 31TM8600 0128
2010 Insight
Press the ECON button to activatethe ECON mode. ECON ON will bedisplayed on the multi-informationdisplay and the ECON modeindicator will illuminate in theinstrument panel. Press the ECONbutton again to turn it off. ECONOFF will appear on the multi-information display.
The ECON button turns the ECONmode on and off. The ECON modehelps you improve your fueleconomy by modifying some vehiclefunctions. When the ECON mode ison:
In addition, when the ECON mode ison, you may get more EcologicalDrive Assist points (see page ).
The climate control system willhave greater temperaturefluctuations
Engine performance will bedifferent
When you turn off and then restartthe engine, the ECON mode settingremains the same as previously set.
304
ECON Button
124
MULTI-INFORMATION DISPLAYECON BUTTON
ECON MODE INDICATOR
08/12/27 11:42:51 31TM8600 0129
2010 Insight
Move the steering wheel so itpoints toward your chest, nottoward your face. Make sure youcan see the instrument panelgauges and indicators.
Make any steering wheeladjustments before you start driving.
Pull the lever under the steeringcolumn toward you until it stops.
Push the lever forward fully tolock the steering wheel in position.
Make sure you have securelylocked the steering wheel in placeby trying to move it up, down, in,and out.
Make sure the lever is positionedsecurely at the bottom of thesteering column as shown.
1.
3.
4.
2.
Steering Wheel AdjustmentsInstrum
entsand
Controls
125
To adjust
To lockLEVER
Adjusting the steering wheelposition while driving maycause you to lose control of thevehicle and be seriously injuredin a crash.
Adjust the steering wheel onlywhen the vehicle is stopped.
08/12/27 11:42:58 31TM8600 0130
2010 Insight
These keys contain electroniccircuits that are activated by theimmobilizer system. They will notwork to start the engine if thecircuits are damaged.
Protect the keys from directsunlight, high temperature, andhigh humidity.
Do not drop the keys or set heavyobjects on them.
Keep the keys away from liquids.If they get wet, dry themimmediately with a soft cloth.
Two ignition keys come with yourvehicle. You should keep one ofthem in a safe place, away from thevehicle, as a spare.
They fit all the locks on your vehicle.
You should have received a keynumber tag with your keys. You willneed this number if you ever have toget a lost key replaced. Use onlyHonda-approved key blanks.
Keys and Locks
126
KEYNUMBERTAG
IGNITION KEYSWITH REMOTETRANSMITTER
08/12/27 11:43:06 31TM8600 0131
2010 Insight
If the system repeatedly does notrecognize the coding of your key,contact your dealer.
Do not attempt to alter this systemor add other devices to it. Electricalproblems could result that may makeyour vehicle inoperable.
If you lose your key and you cannotstart the engine, contact your dealer.
The immobilizer system protectsyour vehicle from theft. If animproperly coded key (or otherdevice) is used, the engine’s fuelsystem is disabled.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, the immobilizersystem indicator should come onbriefly, then go off. If the indicatorstarts to blink, it means the systemdoes not recognize the coding of thekey. Turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position, remove the key,reinsert it, and turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position again.
The system may not recognize yourkey’s coding if another immobilizerkey or other metal object (i.e. keychain) is near the ignition switchwhen you insert the key.
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
Immobilizer SystemInstrum
entsand
Controls
127
Always take the ignition key with youwhenever you leave the vehicle alone.
08/12/27 11:43:13 31TM8600 0132
2010 Insight
- -
The ignition switch has fourpositions: LOCK (0), ACCESSORY(I), ON (II), and START (III).
If the front wheels are turned, theanti-theft lock may make it difficultto turn the key. Firmly turn thesteering wheel to the left or right asyou turn the key.
You can insert orremove the key only in this position.To turn the key, push it in slightly. Ifyour vehicle has an automatictransmission, the shift lever mustalso be in Park.
You canoperate the audio system and theaccessory power sockets in thisposition.
If you leave the key in the ignitionswitch in the ACCESSORY (I)position and open the driver’s door,you will see a ‘‘RETURN IGNITIONSWITCH TO LOCK (0) POSITION’’message on the multi-informationdisplay and hear a reminder beeper.
If you turn the ignition key to theACCESSORY (I) position with thedriver’s door closed, you will see an‘‘ACCESSORY (I) POSITION’’message on the multi-informationdisplay to inform you of the keyposition.
LOCK (0) ACCESSORY (I)
Ignition Switch
128
08/12/27 11:43:19 31TM8600 0133
2010 Insight
-- Use this positiononly to start the engine. The switchreturns to the ON (II) position whenyou let go of the key.
You will hear a reminder beeper ifyou leave the key in the ignitionswitch in the LOCK (0) or theACCESSORY (I) position and openthe driver’s door. Remove the key toturn off the beeper.
You will also see a ‘‘REMOVE KEY’’message on the multi-informationdisplay.
The shift lever must be in Parkbefore you can remove the key fromthe ignition switch.
This is the normal keyposition when driving. Several of theindicators on the instrument panelcome on as a test when you turn theignition switch from theACCESSORY (I) to the ON (II)position.
START (III)ON (II)
Ignition SwitchInstrum
entsand
Controls
129
08/12/27 11:43:24 31TM8600 0134
2010 Insight
The lock tab on any passenger’s doorlocks and unlocks that door.
When the door is unlocked, you cansee the red indicator on the lock tababove the inner door handle.
You can customize the door lock/unlock settings (see page ).
To lock all doors and the hatch, pushthe front of the master door lockswitch on either front door, pull thelock tab rearward on the driver’sdoor, or use the key on the outsidelock on the driver’s door.
Pushing the rear of either masterdoor lock switch will unlock all doorsand the hatch. Pushing forward thelock tab on the driver’s door unlocksonly that door.
All doors and the hatch can belocked from the outside by using thekey in the driver’s door. To unlockonly the driver’s door, insert the key,turn it clockwise, and release it. Theremaining doors and the hatchunlock when you turn the key asecond time within a few seconds.
106
Door Locks
130
Lock
Unlock
LOCK TABMASTER DOOR LOCK SWITCH
To unlock
To lock
08/12/27 11:43:32 31TM8600 0135
2010 Insight
The childproof door locks aredesigned to prevent children seatedin the rear from accidentally openingthe rear doors. Each rear door has alock lever near the edge. With thelever in the LOCK position (lever isdown), the door cannot be openedfrom the inside regardless of theposition of the lock tab. To open thedoor, push the lock tab forward anduse the outside door handle.
To lock any passenger’s door whengetting out of the vehicle, pull thelock tab rearward and close the door.To lock the driver’s door, remove thekey from the ignition switch, pull thelock tab rearward or push the frontof the master switch, then close thedoor.
When the vehicle speed reachesabout 10 mph (U.S.)/15 km/h(Canada) or more, all the doors andthe hatch lock automatically.
When you shift to P after driving, thedriver’s door unlocks.
If you forget and leave the key in theignition switch, lockout preventionwill not allow you to lock the driver’sdoor. With any door or the hatchopen and the key in the ignitionswitch, locking with master doorlock switch is disabled. If the driver’sdoor is closed, the lock tab on thedriver’s door is not disabled. Pullingthe driver’s lock tab rearward willlock all doors or the hatch. If you tryto lock an open driver’s door bypulling the lock tab rearward, thedriver’s door lock tab pops out andunlocks the driver’s door.
Default setting
Lockout Prevention Childproof Door Locks
Door LocksInstrum
entsand
Controls
131
Unlock
Lock
LEVER
08/12/27 11:43:38 31TM8600 0136
2010 Insight
-
-
Press this button once tolock all doors and the hatch. Someexterior lights will flash once. Whenyou push LOCK twice within 5seconds, the horn will sounds toverify that the doors are locked andthe security system has set. Youcannot lock the doors if any door orthe hatch is not fully closed or if thekey is in the ignition switch.
Press this button onceto unlock the driver’s door (or all thedoors and the hatch depending onthe door lock setting). Push it twiceto unlock the remaining doors andthe hatch. Some exterior lights willflash twice when you push thebutton the first time.
If you do not open any door or thehatch within 30 seconds, the doorsautomatically relock and the securitysystem sets.
The ceiling light and the dooractivated spotlights come on whenyou press the UNLOCK button if thelights are in the door activatedposition. If you do not open any dooror the hatch within 30 seconds (orwhatever setting of the interior lightdimming time is set to), the light(s)will fade out. If you relock the doorsand the hatch with the remotetransmitter before 30 seconds haveelapsed, the light(s) will go offimmediately.
To change the lock/unlock settingand the relock timer setting, refer tothe customized settings on page .
The keyless lock acknowledgmentbeep and flashing of the lights canbe deactivated (see page ).
106
112
LOCK
UNLOCK
Remote Transmitter
132
LED LOCK BUTTON
UNLOCKBUTTON
PANICBUTTON
08/12/27 11:43:45 31TM8600 0137
2010 Insight
-Avoid dropping or throwing thetransmitter.
Protect the transmitter fromextreme temperature.
Do not immerse the transmitter inany liquid.
If you lose a transmitter, thereplacement needs to bereprogrammed by your dealer.
If it takes several pushes on thebutton to lock or unlock the doors,replace the battery as soon aspossible.
Battery type: CR1616
To replace the battery:
Press and hold thisbutton for about 1 second to attractattention; the horn will sound, andthe exterior lights will flash for about30 seconds. To cancel panic mode,press any other button on the remotetransmitter, or turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position. Panicmode does not work when the key isin the ignition switch.
CONTINUED
Remote Transmitter Care Replacing the TransmitterBattery
PANIC
Remote TransmitterInstrum
entsand
Controls
133
08/12/27 11:43:53 31TM8600 0138
2010 Insight
+
Remove the screw at the base ofthe transmitter with a smallPhillips-head screwdriver.
Be careful when removingthis screw as the head of the screwcan strip out.
Separate the transmitter by pryingits middle seam with yourfingernail.
Inside the transmitter, separatethe inner cover from the keypadby carefully prying on the edgewith a coin.
Remove the old battery and notethe polarity. Make sure thepolarity of the new battery is thesame ( side facing down), theninsert it in the keypad.
1.
2.
3. 4.
Remote Transmitter
134
NOTE:
SCREW
BATTERY
COIN
08/12/27 11:44:01 31TM8600 0139
2010 Insight
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
An improperly disposed of batterycan hurt the environment.Always confirm local regulations forbattery disposal.
Install the parts in reverse order.5.
Remote TransmitterInstrum
entsand
Controls
135
08/12/27 11:44:06 31TM8600 0140
2010 Insight
The hatch will lock or unlock whenyou lock/unlock the driver’s doorwith the key, the remote transmitter,the master door lock switch, or thelock tab on the driver’s door.
To unlock the hatch, turn the keyclockwise twice, push the rear of themaster door lock switch, or pushUNLOCK twice on the remotetransmitter.
To open the hatch, pull and lift upthe release. To close the hatch, usethe handle to lower it, then pressdown on the back edge.
Keep the hatch closed at all timeswhile driving to avoid damaging thehatch and to prevent exhaust gasfrom getting into the interior. See
on page.56
Carbon Monoxide Hazard
Hatch
136
INNER HANDLE
RELEASE
08/12/27 11:44:13 31TM8600 0141
2010 Insight
If the power door lock system cannotunlock the hatch, unlock it manually.
Place a cloth on the top side of thecover, then use a small flat-tippedscrewdriver to remove the cover onthe back of the hatch.
Push the release lever to the lowerright as shown, and push the hatchto open it.
If you need to unlock the hatchmanually, it means there is aproblem with the hatch. Have thevehicle checked by your dealer.
Unlocking the Hatch
HatchInstrum
entsand
Controls
137
Unlock
COVER
RELEASE LEVER
08/12/27 11:44:19 31TM8600 0142
2010 Insight
-
The height of your driver’s seat isadjustable. To raise the seat,repeatedly pull up the lever on theoutside of the seat cushion. To lowerthe seat, push the lever downrepeatedly.
To change the seat-back angle of thefront seat, pull up the lever on theoutside of the seat bottom.
Once a seat is adjusted correctly,rock it back and forth to make sure itis locked in position.To adjust the seat forward or
backward, pull up on the bar underthe seat cushion’s front edge. Movethe seat to the desired position, andrelease the bar. Try to move the seatto make sure it is locked in position.
Make all adjustments before youstart driving.
See pages for important safetyinformation and warnings about how toproperly position seats and seat-backs.
14 15Driver’s Seat Height AdjustmentFront Seat Adjustments
Seats
138
08/12/27 11:44:26 31TM8600 0143
2010 Insight
See page for important safetyinformation and a warning aboutimproperly positioning head restraints.
16
Your vehicle is equipped with headrestraints in all seating positions tohelp protect you and yourpassengers from whiplash and otherinjuries.
They are most effective when youadjust them so the center of the backof the occupant’s head rests againstthe center of the restraint.
The head restraints adjust for height.You need both hands to adjust arestraint. Do not attempt to adjust itwhile driving. To raise it, pull upward.To lower the restraint, push therelease button sideways, and pushthe restraint down.
CONTINUED
Head Restraints
Adjusting the Head Restraint
SeatsInstrum
entsand
Controls
139
LEGS SEAT-BACK
RELEASEBUTTON
Front Position CUSHION
08/12/27 11:44:34 31TM8600 0144
2010 Insight
To remove a head restraint forcleaning or repair, pull it up as far asit will go. Push the release button,then pull the restraint out of the seat-back.
When reinstalling a head restraint,put the legs back in place. Thenadjust it to the appropriate heightwhile pressing the release button.
Make sure the head restraint locksin position when you reinstall it.
When a passenger is seated in therear seat, the head restraint shouldbe adjusted up or down, to match thepassenger’s height.
The Seat-back must be foldedforward (see page ) to get ceilingclearance for removal of the headrestraints.
142
For Rear Seat Head Restraints
Removing the Head Restraint
Seats
140
LEGS SEAT-BACK SEAT-BACKLEGS
RELEASEBUTTON
Rear Outer Position
CUSHION
Rear Center Position
CUSHION
RELEASEBUTTON
Failure to reinstall the headrestraints can result in severeinjury during a crash.
Always replace the headrestraints before driving.
08/12/27 11:44:42 31TM8600 0145
2010 Insight
The driver’s and front passenger’sseats have active head restraints. Ifthe vehicle is struck severely fromthe rear, the occupant properlysecured with the seat belt will bepushed against the seat-back and thehead restraint will automaticallymove forward.
This reduces the distance betweenthe restraint and the occupant’s head.It also helps protect the occupants
against whiplash and injuries to theneck and upper spine.
After a collision, the activatedrestraint should return to its normalposition.
For a head restraint system to workproperly:
Do not hang any items on the headrestraints, or from the restraintlegs.
Do not place any object betweenan occupant and the seat-back.
Install each restraint in its properlocation.
If the restraints do not return to theirnormal position, or in the event of asevere collision, have the vehicleinspected by a Honda dealer.
Only use genuine Hondareplacement head restraints.
Active Head Restraints
Seats
Instruments
andC
ontrols
141
08/12/27 11:44:51 31TM8600 0146
2010 Insight
The rear seat-backs can be foldeddown for more cargo room.
Each side folds down separately, soyou can still carry one or twopassengers in the rear seat.
Lower the rear head restraints totheir lowest positions. If you folddown the right side seat-back, alsoadjust the rear center headrestraint to its lowest position.
Unlock the seat-back by pulling upthe release lever on the outer sideof each rear seat-back.
Fold the seat-back forward.
Remove any items from the seatbefore folding down the seat-back,and make sure there are no items onthe floor before folding down theseats.
Reverse this procedure to return theseat-back to the upright position. Pullon the seat-back to make sure it islatched. If the seat-back is notlatched fully, the seat belt will notwork properly and you will see thered indicator behind the releaselever as shown.
Do not put any heavy items on theseat-back when it is folded down.
Make sure the seat-back and seatcushion are locked securely and allrear shoulder belts are positioned infront of the rear seat-backs.
1.2.
3.
Folding the Rear Seats Down
Seats
142
RED INDICATOR
LEVER
08/12/27 11:44:59 31TM8600 0147
2010 Insight
Make sure all items in the cargo areaare secured. Loose items can flyforward and cause injury if you haveto brake hard (Seeon page ).
The lid of the console compartmentcan be used as an armrest.
295
EX models only
Armrest
Carrying Cargo
SeatsInstrum
entsand
Controls
143
08/12/27 11:45:04 31TM8600 0148
2010 Insight
Keep the inside and outside mirrorsclean and adjusted for best visibility.Be sure to adjust the mirrors beforeyou start driving.
The inside mirror has day and nightpositions. The night position reducesglare from headlights behind you.Flip the tab on the bottom edge ofthe mirror to select the day or nightposition.
Move the selector switch to L(driver’s side) or R (passenger’sside).
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
Push the appropriate edge of theadjustment switch to move themirror right, left, up, or down.
When you finish, move theselector switch to the center (off)position. This turns theadjustment switch off to keep yoursettings.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Adjusting the Power Mirrors
Mirrors
144
SELECTORSWITCH
ADJUSTMENTSWITCH
TAB
08/12/27 11:45:11 31TM8600 0149
2010 Insight
The outside mirrors are heated toremove fog and frost. With theignition switch in the ON (II)position, turn on the heaters bypressing the rear window defoggerbutton. The indicator in the buttoncomes on as a reminder. Press thebutton again to turn the heaters andthe defogger off.
This heated mirror function has atimer (see page ).123
On U.S. EX models and all Canadianmodels
Power Mirror Heaters
MirrorsInstrum
entsand
Controls
145
HEATED MIRROR BUTTON
08/12/27 11:45:16 31TM8600 0150
2010 Insight
-
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position to raise or lower anywindow. To open a window, push theswitch down and hold it. Release theswitch when you want the window tostop. Pull back on the switch andhold it to close the window.
To open or close thedriver’s window, push or pull thewindow switch firmly down or up tothe second detent, and release it.The window will automatically godown or up all the way. To stop thewindow, pull or push the windowswitch briefly.
AUTO
Power Windows
146
DRIVER’SWINDOWSWITCH
FRONTPASSENGER’SWINDOW SWITCH
MAIN SWITCH
Closing a power window onsomeone’s hands or fingers cancause serious injury.
Make sure your passengers areaway from the windows beforeclosing them.
08/12/27 11:45:21 31TM8600 0151
2010 Insight
-
Auto reverse stops sensing when thewindow is almost closed. You shouldalways check that all passengers andobjects are away from the windowbefore closing it.
The driver’s window autoreverse function is disabled whenyou continuously pull up the switch.
If the driver’swindow senses any obstacle while itis closing automatically, it willreverse direction, and then stop. Toclose the window, remove theobstacle, then use the window switchagain.
The windows and the main switchfeature will operate for up to 10minutes after you turn off theignition switch. Opening either frontdoor cancels this function.
The indicators inside the windowswitches come on when the lightcontrol switch is in either or
position with the ignitionswitch in the ON (II) position(driver’s window switch only on LX).
When you push the main switch in,the indicator comes on and thepassengers’ windows cannot beraised or lowered. Use the mainswitch when you have children in thevehicle so they do not injurethemselves by operating thewindows unintentionally. To cancelthis feature, push on the switchagain. The switch will pop out.
AUTO REVERSE
Power WindowsInstrum
entsand
Controls
147
NOTE:
08/12/27 11:45:27 31TM8600 0152
2010 Insight
To apply the parking brake, pull thelever up fully. To release it, pull upslightly, push the button, and lowerthe lever. The parking brakeindicator on the instrument panelshould go out when the parkingbrake is fully released (see page ).
If you drive without releasing theparking brake, a beeper will sound,and you will also see a ‘‘RELEASEPARKING BRAKE’’ message on themulti-information display.
64
Parking Brake
148
PARKING BRAKE LEVER
Driving the vehicle with the parkingbrake applied can damage the rearbrakes and hubs. A beeper will sound ifthe vehicle is put into gear with theparking brake on.
08/12/27 11:45:31 31TM8600 0153
2010 Insight
*
*
*
*
*
*
CONTINUED
Interior Convenience ItemsInstrum
entsand
Controls
149
COAT HOOK SUN VISORVANITY MIRROR
FRONT DOORPOCKET
USB ADAPTERCABLE
BEVERAGE HOLDERSCENTER CONSOLECOMPARTMENT
CARGO AREA COVER
REAR DOOR BEVERAGEHOLDER
CENTER TRAY
GLOVE BOX
ACCESSORY POWERSOCKET
FLOOR STORAGECOMPARTMENT
AUXILIARYINPUT JACK
SEAT-BACK POCKETS
UNDER FLOOR STORAGES
EX model is shown.
CARGO AREA
: If equipped
08/12/27 11:45:37 31TM8600 0154
2010 Insight
You can use the cargo area cover toconceal your parcels and protectthem from direct sunlight.
To extend the cargo area cover, pullout the cover from the housing bypulling the handle on the cover’sleading edge, then clip the mountingrods in the slots at both sides of thehatch opening.
To retract the cover, slip the rodsout of the hooks and guide the coverso it rolls back fully into its housing.
Do not store parcels on the cargoarea cover. The cover may break ifweight is placed on it.
On Canadian EX model only
Cargo Area Cover
Interior Convenience Items
150
HANDLE MOUNTING ROD
08/12/27 11:45:43 31TM8600 0155
2010 Insight
The cargo area cover housing unitcan be removed to give you morecargo space.
Release each side of the housing unitby pushing one end of the unittoward the other end and lifting itupward.
To reinstall the cargo area coverhousing unit, place one end of theunit in the holder on the side panel,then push it into the side panelslightly and insert the other end intoits holder.
Make sure the housing unit issecurely placed so it will not comeloose while you are driving.
You can store the cargo area coverunder the cargo area floor.
Open the cargo floor lid.
Open the cargo area cover holderlids located on both sides of thecargo area floor.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Storing the Cargo Area Cover
Interior Convenience ItemsInstrum
entsand
Controls
151
HOUSING UNIT
Push
LID
CARGO AREACOVER
LID
08/12/27 11:45:51 31TM8600 0156
2010 Insight
Store the cover in its holders asshown in the illustration above.
Reinstall the cargo floor lid.
To open the cargo floor, fold thecargo floor forward.
To use the storage compartmentlocated on the left side of the cargoarea floor, hold the strap and raisethe lid.
Close the lid by pressing until itlatches.
3.
4.
Under Floor Storages Floor Storage Compartments
Interior Convenience Items
152
STRAP
LID
CARGO FLOORSTORAGESCARGO AREACOVER
08/12/27 11:46:00 31TM8600 0157
2010 Insight
Spilled liquids can damage theupholstery, carpeting, and electricalcomponents in the interior.
Your vehicle has an accessory powersocket in the front console panel.
To use an accessory power socket,the ignition switch must be in theACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position.
This socket is intended to supplypower for 12 volt DC accessoriesthat are rated 120 watts or less (10amps).
Be careful when you are using thebeverage holders. A spilled liquidthat is very hot can scald you or yourpassengers. Liquid can also spillfrom the front and rear door pocketbeverage holders when you open orclose the doors. Use only resealablecontainers in the door pockets.
CONTINUED
Beverage Holders Accessory Power Sockets
Interior Convenience Items
Instruments
andC
ontrols
153
FRONT REAR
BEVERAGE HOLDERS LX model only BEVERAGE HOLDERS LX model is shown.
08/12/27 11:46:08 31TM8600 0158
2010 Insight
It will not power an automotive typecigarette lighter element.
Make sure to put the socket coverback in place to prevent any smallforeign objects from getting into thesocket.
To open the console compartment,pull up on the lever and lift thearmrest.
To close, lower the armrest, andpush it down until it latches.
The glove box light comes on whenthe parking lights are on.
Open the glove box by pulling thehandle to the left. Close it with a firmpush.
On EX models only
On EX models only
Console Compartment Glove Box
Interior Convenience Items
154
LEVER
08/12/27 11:46:16 31TM8600 0159
2010 Insight
There is a tray in the front of thecenter console. You can also take thepartition out to extend the tray.
When you use the front beverageholders, you need to put the partitionback to the original position on thecenter console.
To open the center pocket, push onthe knob. To close it, push the lid upuntil it latches.
Center Tray Center Pockets
Interior Convenience ItemsInstrum
entsand
Controls
155
PARTITION KNOB
Push
LID
An open glove box can causeserious injury to your passengerin a crash, even if thepassenger is wearing the seatbelt.
Always keep the glove boxclosed while driving.
08/12/27 11:46:23 31TM8600 0160
2010 Insight
To use the vanity mirror on the backof the sun visor, pull up the cover.
To use the sun visor, pull it down.You can also use the sun visor at theside window. Remove the supportrod from the clip and swing the sunvisor toward the side window.
Make sure you put the sun visorback in place when you are gettinginto or out of the vehicle.
To use a coat hook, slide it outslightly, then pull it down.
Make sure the coat hook is pulled upwhen you are not using it. This hookis not designed for large or heavyitems.
On U.S. EX models and Canadianmodels
Vanity MirrorSun VisorsCoat Hook
Interior Convenience Items
156
COAT HOOK
EX model is shown.
08/12/27 11:46:31 31TM8600 0161
2010 Insight
The ceiling light has a three-positionswitch: ON, Door Activated, andOFF. In the Door Activated (center)position, the light comes on whenyou:
After all doors are closed tightly, thelight dims slightly, then fades out inabout 30 seconds.
The ceiling light (with the switch inthe center position) comes on whenyou remove the key from the ignitionswitch. If you do not open a door, thelight stays on, then fades out inabout 30 seconds.
Turn on a spotlight by pushing thelens. Push the lens again to turn itoff. You can use the spotlights at alltimes.
Unlock the driver’s door with thekey or remote transmitter.
Open any door.
To change the ‘‘INTERIOR LIGHTDIMMING TIME’’ setting, see page
.
If you leave any door open withoutthe key in the ignition switch, theceiling light will go off after about 15minutes.
105
CONTINUED
Ceiling Light Spotlights
Interior LightsInstrum
entsand
Controls
157
DOOR ACTIVATED POSITION
EX model with navigation system
Push
Push
SPOTLIGHTS
08/12/27 11:46:41 31TM8600 0162
2010 Insight
Your vehicle has a cargo area lighton the left side panel of the cargoarea. It comes on when you open thehatch.
Cargo Area Light
Interior Lights
158
U.S. EX model
Push
CARGO AREA LIGHT
Push
SPOTLIGHTS
08/12/27 11:46:46 31TM8600 0163
2010 Insight
The climate control system in yourvehicle provides a comfortabledriving environment in all weatherconditions.
The standard audio system hasmany features. This sectiondescribes those features and how touse them.
Your vehicle has an anti-theft audiosystem that requires a code numberto enable it.
The security system helps to dis-courage vandalism and theft of yourvehicle.
...............Climate Control System . 160Playing the FM/AM Radio
(Models without navigation..................................system) . 166
Playing a Disc (Models without...................navigation system) . 173
Disc Player Error Messages(Models without navigation
..................................system) . 180Playing an iPod (Models without
...................navigation system) . 181iPod Error Messages (Models
.....without navigation system) . 187Playing a USB Flash Memory
Device (Models without...............navigation system) . 188
USB Flash Memory Device ErrorMessages (Models without
...............navigation system) . 197Playing the AM/FM Radio
(Models with navigation..................................system) . 198
Playing a Disc (Models with...................navigation system) . 204
Disc Player Error Messages(Models with navigation
..................................system) . 214Playing a PC card (Models with
...............navigation system) . 215...PC Card Player Malfunction . 228
Playing an iPod (Models with...................navigation system) . 229
iPod Error Messages (Models...........with navigation system) . 236
Playing a USB Flash MemoryDevice (Models with
...............navigation system) . 237USB Flash Memory Device Error
Messages (Models with...............navigation system) . 245
............AM/FM Radio Reception . 246..................Protecting Your Discs . 248................Remote Audio Controls . 251
......................Auxiliary Input Jack . 252.................Radio Theft Protection . 253
..........................Setting the Clock . 254............................Security System . 255
...............................Cruise Control . 256.......Bluetooth HandsFreeLink . 259
FeaturesF
eatures
159
08/12/27 11:46:52 31TM8600 0164
2010 Insight
Climate Control System
160
TEMPERATURE CONTROL DIAL
AIR CONDITIONING BUTTON
RECIRCULATION BUTTON
U.S. EX models and all Canadian models
FRESH AIR BUTTON
WINDSHIELDDEFROST BUTTON
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER/HEATED MIRRORS BUTTON
REAR WINDOWDEFOGGER BUTTON
OFF BUTTON
MODE CONTROL BUTTON
FAN CONTROL BAR
08/12/27 11:46:56 31TM8600 0165
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
On models with navigation system The automatic climate controlsystem in your vehicle picks theproper combination of airconditioning, heating, and ventilationto maintain the interior temperatureyou select. The system also adjuststhe fan speed and airflow levels.
Press the AUTO button. You willsee AUTO in the display.
Set the desired temperature byturning the temperature controldial.
The system automatically selectsthe proper mix of conditionedand/or heated air that will, asquickly as possible, raise or lowerthe interior temperature to yourpreference.
Turning this dial clockwise increasesthe temperature of the airflow.The climate control system can also
be operated by voice control. See thenavigation system manual forcomplete details.
2.
1.
Voice Control System Using Automatic Climate Control
Climate Control System
Temperature Control
Features
161
08/12/27 11:47:05 31TM8600 0166
2010 Insight
▲
▼
When you set the temperature to itslower limit ( ) or its upper limit( ), the system runs at fullcooling or heating only. It does notregulate the interior temperature.
When you adjust a fan control, thefan is taken out of AUTO mode.
If you press the OFF button, theclimate control system shuts offcompletely.
Keep the system completely offfor short periods only.
To keep stale air and mustinessfrom collecting, you should havethe fan running at all times. Press the side of the bar to
increase the fan speed and airflow.Press the side of the bar todecrease them.
You can manually select variousfunctions of the climate controlsystem when it is in fully automaticmode. All other features remainautomatically controlled. Making anymanual selection causes the wordAUTO in the display to go out.
To Turn Everything Off Semi-automatic Operation
Fan Control
Climate Control System
162
08/12/27 11:47:13 31TM8600 0167
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
This button turns the airconditioning on and off. You will seeA/C ON or A/C OFF in the display.
When you turn the A/C off, thesystem cannot regulate the insidetemperature if you set thetemperature control below theoutside temperature.
This button turns the rear windowdefogger off and on (see page ).
Pushing this button also turns thepower mirror heaters on and off.
When the recirculation indicator ison, air from the vehicle’s interior issent throughout the system again.
Select recirculation mode whendriving through dusty or smokyconditions, then return to fresh airmode.
The outside air intakes for theclimate control system are at thebase of the windshield. Keep thisarea clear of leaves and other debris.
When the fresh air indicator is on,air is brought in from the outside ofthe vehicle.
The system should be left in freshair mode under almost all conditions.Keeping the system in recirculationmode, particularly with the A/C off,can cause the windows to fog up.
123
On U.S. EX models and all Canadianmodels
Climate Control System
Air Conditioning (A/C) Button Recirculation Button Rear Window Defogger Button
Fresh Air Button
Features
163
08/12/27 11:47:24 31TM8600 0168
2010 Insight
To remove fog from the inside of thewindows, set as follows:Use the mode control button to
select the vents the air flows from.Some air will flow from thedashboard vents in all modes.
Airflow is divided betweenthe floor and corner vents and thedefroster vents at the base of thewindshield.
This button directs the main airflowto the windshield for fasterdefrosting. It also overrides anymode selection you may have made.
Select . The systemautomatically switches to fresh airmode and turns on the A/C.Adjust the temperature so theairflow feels warm.Select to help clear therear window.To increase airflow to thewindshield, close the corner vents.For faster defogging, manually setthe fan speed to high.
For your safety, make sure you havea clear view through all the windowsbefore driving.
When you select , the systemautomatically switches to fresh airmode and turns on the A/C. Forfaster defrosting, manually set thefan speed to high. You can alsoincrease airflow to the windshield byclosing the corner vents on thedashboard.
When you turn off bypressing the button again, thesystem returns to its former settings.
Air flows from the floorvents.
Airflow is divided betweenthe vents in the dashboard and thefloor vents.
Air flows from the centerand corner vents in the dashboard.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Climate Control System
Mode Control Windshield Defroster Button
164
08/12/27 11:47:36 31TM8600 0169
2010 Insight
To regulate the interior temperatureand humidity, the climate controlsystem has two sensors. A sunlightsensor is located in the top of thedashboard and a temperature/humidity sensor is next to thesteering column. Do not cover thesensors or spill any liquid on them.
Climate Control System
Sunlight, Temperature, andHumidity Sensors
Features
165
TEMPERATURE/HUMIDITY SENSORSUNLIGHT SENSOR
08/12/27 11:47:41 31TM8600 0170
2010 Insight
Playing the FM/AM Radio (Models without navigation system)
166
BUTTON
SEEK BUTTON
BUTTON
BUTTON
A.SEL BUTTON
SCAN BUTTON
SEEK BUTTON
PRESET BUTTONS
VOL/SELECT KNOB
FM/AM BUTTON
08/12/27 11:47:47 31TM8600 0171
2010 Insight
- -
-
The ignition switch must be in theACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position.Turn the system on by pushing theFM/AM button. Adjust the volumeby turning the VOL/SELECT knob.
The band and frequency that theradio was last tuned to are displayed.To change bands, press the FM/AMbutton. On the FM band, ST will bedisplayed if the station isbroadcasting in stereo. Stereoreproduction in AM is not available.
You can use any of five methods tofind radio stations on the selectedband: tune, seek, scan, the presetbuttons, and auto select.
Use the SEEK button totune to a desired frequency. Pressthe button to tune to a higherfrequency, and the button totune to a lower frequency.
You can also operate the tunefunction by using the VOL/SELECTknob. Press the VOL/SELECT knoband you will see ‘‘SEL’’ in the display.Turn the knob right to tune to ahigher frequency, or left to tune to alower frequency. To turn it off, pressthe VOL/SELECT knob or
button, or button.The system will return to the normaldisplay about 10 seconds after youstop adjusting the tune mode.
The SEEK functionsearches up and down from thecurrent frequency to find a stationwith a strong signal. To activate it,press and hold the or sideof the SEEK button until you hear abeep, then release it.
The scan function samplesall stations with strong signals on theselected band. To activate it, pressthe SCAN button, then release it.You will see SCAN in the display.When the system finds a strongsignal, it will stop and play thatstation for about 10 seconds.
If you do nothing, the system willthen scan for the next strong stationand play it for 10 seconds. When itplays a station you want to listen to,press the SCAN button again.
CONTINUED
Playing the FM/AM Radio (Models without navigation system)
To Play the FM/AM Radio
To Select a Station
TUNE SEEK
SCAN
Features
167
08/12/27 11:47:58 31TM8600 0172
2010 Insight
--
-
If you aretraveling and can no longer receiveyour preset stations, you can use theauto select feature to find stations inthe local area.
Press the A. SEL button. ‘‘A. SEL’’flashes in the display, and the systemgoes into scan mode for severalseconds. It stores the frequencies ofsix AM and twelve FM stations inthe preset buttons.
You will see a ‘‘0’’ displayed afterpressing a preset button if autoselect cannot find a strong station forthat preset button.
If you do not like the stations autoselect has stored, you can storeother frequencies on the presetbuttons as previously described.
press theA. SEL button. This restores thepresets you originally set.
For information on FM/AM radiofrequencies and reception, see page
.
Each preset button canstore one frequency on AM and twofrequencies on FM.
Select the desired band, AM orFM.
Use the tune, seek, or scanfunction to tune the radio to adesired station.
Pick a preset number (1 6), andhold it until you hear a beep.
Repeat steps 1 through 3 to store atotal of six stations on AM andtwelve stations on FM.
1.
2.
3.
4.
246
To turn off auto select,
Playing the FM/AM Radio (Models without navigation system)
AUTO SELECTPreset
168
08/12/27 11:48:07 31TM8600 0173
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
On the FM band, you can select afavorite station and display theprogram service name provided bythe radio data system (RDS).
The program service name displayfunction shows the name of thestation you are listening to. You canturn this function on or off.
To switch the function between onand off, press and release the TITLEbutton. With the system on, you willsee the ‘‘RDS INFO ON’’ message onthe display. If the station you arelistening to is an RDS station, thedisplayed frequency switches to thestation name.
If the station you are listening to isnot an RDS station, the displaycontinues to show the frequencywith the PS name display function on.
When you turn off this function bypressing the TITLE button, thedisplay shows ‘‘RDS INFO OFF.’’
Playing the FM/AM Radio (Models without navigation system)
Radio Data System (RDS)
Program Service (PS) Name Display
Features
169
PROGRAM SERVICENAME DISPLAY ON
08/12/27 11:48:14 31TM8600 0174
2010 Insight
With the FM band selected, you canselect the program categoryprovided by the RDS. Press
or button to displayand select an RDS category. Theprincipal RDS categories are shownas follows;
ALL PTY: All RDS category stationsROCK: Rock, classic rock and softrock musicCOUNTRY: Country musicSOFT: Adult hits and soft musicTOP 40: Top 40 hitsOLDIES: Nostalgia music and oldiesR & B: Rhythm and blues, and softrhythm and bluesRELIGION: Programs concernedwith religion.CLASSIC: Classical musicJAZZ: JazzINFO: News, information, sports,talk shows, foreign language,personality, public, college, andweatherTRAFFIC: Traffic information
Press or button toselect an RDS category. The displayshows the selected RDS categoryname for about 10 seconds. You canuse the search or scan function tofind radio stations in the selectedRDS category. If you do nothingwhile the RDS category name isdisplayed, the selected category iscanceled.
Playing the FM/AM Radio (Models without navigation system)
Radio Data System (RDS) Category
170
RDS CATEGORY
08/12/27 11:48:27 31TM8600 0175
2010 Insight
The scan function samples allstations with strong signals on theselected RDS category. To activate it,press and release the SCAN button.You will see SCAN in the display.The system will scan for a stationwith a strong signal in the selectedRDS category. You will also see theselected RDS category nameblinking while searching it. When itfinds one, it will stop and play thatstation for about 10 seconds.
If you do nothing, the system willscan for the next strong station andplay it for 10 seconds. When it playsa station that you want to listen to,press the SCAN button again.
This function searches a frequencyfor a strong signal from thefrequency that carry the selectedRDS category information. This canhelp you to find a station in yourfavorite category. To activate it,press the or side of theSEEK button. You will see theselected RDS category nameblinking while searching it. Whenthe system finds a station, theselected RDS category name will bedisplayed again for about 5 seconds.
If the system does not find a station,‘‘NOTHING’’ will be blinking forabout 5 seconds, then the systemgoes back to the last selected station.
If the system does not find a station,‘‘NOTHING’’ will be blinking forabout 5 seconds, then the systemgoes back to the last selected station.
You can use the RDS programsearch or scan function even if thePS name display function is off. Inthis case, the display shows afrequency in place of a PS name.
Playing the FM/AM Radio (Models without navigation system)
RDS Program SCANRDS Program Search
Features
171
08/12/27 11:48:35 31TM8600 0176
2010 Insight
-
-
-
-
-Press the sound ( ) button toselect an appropriate setting: bass,treble, fader, balance, and SVC(speed-sensitive volumecompensation). Turn the VOL/SELECT knob to adjust the setting.
Adjusts the bass.
Adjusts the treble.
Adjusts the front-to-backstrength of the sound.
Adjusts the side-to-side strength of the sound.
Each mode is shown in the display asit changes. Turn the VOL/SELECTknob to adjust the setting to yourliking. When the level reaches thecenter, you will see ‘‘C’’ in the display.
Adjusts the volume levelbased on the vehicle speed.
The system will return to the audiodisplay about 10 seconds after youstop adjusting a mode.
The SVC mode controls the volumebased on vehicle speed. The fasteryou go, the louder the audio volumebecomes. As you slow down, theaudio volume decreases.
The SVC has four modes; SVC OFF,SVC LOW, SVC MID, and SVCHIGH. Turn the VOL/SELECT knobto adjust the setting to your liking. Ifyou feel the sound is too loud,choose low. If you feel the sound istoo quiet, choose high.
This function is set to MID as thedefault setting when the vehicleleaves the factory.
You can use the instrument panelbrightness control knob to adjust theillumination of the audio system (seepage ). The audio systemilluminates when the parking lightsare on, even if the system is turnedoff.
121
Playing the FM/AM Radio (Models without navigation system)
Adjusting the Sound
BAS
TREBLE
FADER
BALANCE
SVC Audio System Lighting
Speed-sensitive VolumeCompensation (SVC)
172
08/12/27 11:48:46 31TM8600 0177
2010 Insight
Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system)F
eatures
173
BUTTON
TITLE BUTTON
CD BUTTON DISC SLOT
BUTTON EJECT BUTTON
SEEK BUTTON
SCAN BUTTON
SEEK BUTTON
BUTTON
RDM BUTTON
RPT BUTTON
08/12/27 11:48:52 31TM8600 0178
2010 Insight
You operate the in-dash disc playerwith the same controls used for theradio. To select the disc player, pressthe CD button. You will see ‘‘CD’’ inthe display. The folder or tracknumbers are shown in the display.You can also select the displayedinformation with the TITLE button(see page ). The system willcontinuously play a disc until youchange modes.
This audio system can also playCD-Rs and CD-RWs compressed inMP3 or WMA formats. The numbersof the folder and track playing areshown in the display on the discplayer. A disc can support more than99 folders, and each folder can holdmore than 255 playable files. A disccan hold up to 999 files in total.
When there are more than 99 foldersin a disc, the audio display onlyshows two digits.
If a file on a WMA disc is protectedby digital rights management(DRM), the audio unit displaysUNSUPPORTED, and then skips tothe next file.
If you have a disc that is acombination of CD-DA tracks andMP3/WMA files, you can choose theformat to listen by pressing the CDbutton.
Video CDs and DVDs will not workin this unit.
A disc compressed in AAC formatcannot be played in this audiosystem.
176
Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system)
To Play a Disc
174
NOTE:
Do not use discs with adhesive labels.The label can curl up and cause thedisc to jam in the unit.
08/12/27 11:48:59 31TM8600 0179
2010 Insight
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
CONTINUED
The specifications for compatibleMP3 files are:
Sampling frequency:32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1)16/22.05/24 kHz (MPEG2)Bitrate:32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/160/192/224/256/320 kbps(MPEG1)8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/160 kbps (MPEG2)Compatible with variable bitrateand multi-sessionNumber of layers(including ROOT): Over 8 layers
Insert a disc about halfway into thedisc slot. The drive will pull the discin the rest of the way to play it. Youoperate the disc player with thesame controls used for the radio.The number of the current track isshown in the display. When playing adisc in MP3 or WMA, the numbersof the current folder and file areshown. The system will continuouslyplay a disc until you change modes.
You cannot load and play 3-inch(8-cm) discs in this system.
For information on how to handleand protect compact discs, see page
.
The specifications for compatibleWMA files are:
Compatible with variable bitrateand multi-session
Sampling frequency:32/44.1/48 kHzBitrate:48/64/80/96/128/160/192 kbps
Number of layers(including ROOT): Over 8 layers
248
Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system)
To Load a Disc
Features
175
08/12/27 11:49:10 31TM8600 0180
2010 Insight
>
You can see the album, artist, andtrack name in the display. If a disc isrecorded in MP3 or WMA, you cansee the folder and file name, and thealbum, artist, and track tag.
With the folder name, you will seethe FOLDER indicator in the display.The TRACK indicator is shown withthe file or track name.
When you press and release theTITLE button while a disc withouttext data is playing, you will see ‘‘NOINFO’’ on the display.
The display shows up to 16characters of selected text data (thefolder name, file name, etc.).
If the text data has more than 16characters, you will see the first 15characters and the indicator onthe display. Press and hold theTITLE button until the next 16characters are shown. You can seeup to 31 characters of text data.
Each time you press the TITLEbutton, the display shows you thetext, if the disc was recorded withtext data.
Text Data Display Function
Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system)
176
08/12/27 11:49:17 31TM8600 0181
2010 Insight
-If you press and hold the TITLEbutton again, the display shows thefirst 15 characters again.
If any letter is not available, it isreplaced with ‘‘ . ’’ (dot) in the display.When the disc has no text data, youwill see ‘‘NO INFO’’ on the display.
You will also see some text dataunder these conditions:
When you turn on the audio systemnext time, the system keeps yourselection with the TITLE button.
When a new folder, file, or track isselected.
When you change the audio modeto play a disc with text data or inMP3 or WMA.
When you insert a disc, and thesystem begins to play.
When playing a CD-DA with textdata, the album and track name areshown in the display. With a disc inMP3 or WMA, the display shows thefolder and file name.
In MP3/WMA mode, use theor button to select
folders in the disc, and use the SEEKbutton to change files.
Each time youpress and release the side, theplayer skips forward to thebeginning of the next track (files inMP3/WMA mode). Press andrelease the side to skipbackward to the beginning of thecurrent track. Press it again to skipto the beginning of the previoustrack.
To move rapidly within a track, pressand hold the , or the
button.
You can also operate the trackselection by using the VOL/SELECTknob. Press the VOL/SELECT knoband you will see ‘‘SEL’’ in the display.Turn the knob to switch the tracknumber. Press the VOL/SELECTknob or button to set yourselection. To turn it off, press the
button.
You can use the SEEK button whilea disc is playing to change tracks(files in MP3/WMA mode).
CONTINUED
To Change or Select Tracks/Files
SEEK/SKIP
Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system)F
eatures
177
08/12/27 11:49:31 31TM8600 0182
2010 Insight
-
--
--Toselect a different folder, press the
or button. Press thebutton to skip to the next
folder, and the button to skipto the previous folder.
You can also operate the folder andfile selection by using the VOL/SELECT knob. Press the VOL/SELECT knob and you will see SELin the display, Turn the knob toswitch the folder number and pressthe knob to set your selection. Toturn it off, press the buttonrepeatedly.
To continuously replaya track (file in MP3/WMA mode),press and release the RPT button.You will see RPT in the display.Press and hold the RPT button toturn it off.
Each time you press and release theRPT button, the mode changes fromfile repeat to folder repeat, then tonormal play.
This feature plays thetracks within a disc in random order.In MP3/WMA mode, all files in allfolders are played in random order.To activate random mode, press theRDM button repeatedly until you seeRDM in the display. Press and holdthe RDM button to turn it off.
Thisfeature, when activated, plays thefiles in the current folder in randomorder, rather than in the order theyare compressed in MP3/WMA. Toactivate folder random play, pressthe RDM button. You will seeF-RDM in the display. The systemwill then select and play filesrandomly. This continues until youdeactivate folder random play bypressing and holding the RDMbutton.
Each time you press and release theRDM button, the mode changesfrom folder random play, to within adisc random play, then to normalplay.
This feature,when activated, replays all the filesin the selected folder in the orderthey are compressed in MP3/WMA.To activate folder repeat mode, pressthe RPT button repeatedly until yousee F-RPT in the display. The systemcontinuously replays the currentfolder. Press and hold the RPTbutton to turn it off.
In MP3/WMA mode In MP3/WMA mode In MP3/WMA modeFOLDER SELECTION
REPEAT (TRACK/FILEREPEAT)
RANDOM (Random within adisc)
FOLDER-RANDOMFOLDER-REPEAT
Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system)
178
08/12/27 11:49:40 31TM8600 0183
2010 Insight
--
This feature,when activated, samples the first filein each folder on the disc in theorder they are recorded. To activatethe folder scan feature, press theSCAN button repeatedly. You willsee ‘‘F-SCAN’’ in the display. Thesystem will then play the first file inthe main folders for about 10seconds. When it plays a file that youwant to continue listening to, pressand hold the SCAN button. Whenthe system samples the first file ofall folders, F-SCAN is canceled, andthe system plays normally.
Each time you press and release theSCAN button, the mode changesfrom file scan to folder scan, then tonormal play.
Press the eject button ( ) toremove the disc. If you eject the disc,but do not remove it from the slot,the system will automatically reloadthe disc after 10 seconds and beginplaying.
Press the FM/AM button to switchto the radio while a disc is playing.To play the disc, press the CD button.
If you turn the system off while adisc is playing, either with the( ) button or by turning off theignition switch, the disc will stay inthe drive. When you turn the systemback on, the disc will begin playingwhere it left off.
For information on how to handleand protect compact discs, see page
.
The SCAN functionsamples all the tracks on the disc inthe order they are recorded on thedisc (all files in the selected folder inMP3 or WMA mode). To activate thescan feature, press and release theSCAN button. You will see ‘‘SCAN’’in the display. You will get a 10second sampling of each track/file inthe disc/folder. Press and hold theSCAN button to get out of scanmode and play the last track sampled.
248
In MP3/WMA modeFOLDER-SCAN
To Stop Playing a Disc
Protecting Discs
SCAN
Playing a Disc (Models without navigation system)F
eatures
179
08/12/27 11:49:48 31TM8600 0184
2010 Insight
The chart on the right explains theerror messages you may see in thedisplay while playing a disc.
If you see an error message in thedisplay while playing a disc, pressthe eject button. After ejecting thedisc, check it for damage ordeformation. If there is no damage,insert the disc again.
The audio system will try to play thedisc. If there is still a problem, theerror message will reappear. Pressthe eject button, and pull out the disc.
For the additional information ondamaged discs, see page .
Insert a different disc. If the newdisc plays, there is a problem withthe first disc. If the error messagecycle repeats and you cannot clear it,take your vehicle to a dealer.
Cause SolutionErrorMessage
249
Track/File format notsupported
Mechanical Error
FOCUS Error
TOC Error
Current track will be skipped. The nextsupported track or file plays automatically.Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc.Check the disc for serious damage, signs ofdeformation, excessive scratches, and/or dirt(see page 249). Insert the disc again. If the codedoes not disappear, or the disc cannot beremoved, consult your dealer. Do not try toforce the disc out of the player.Press the EJECT button and pull out the disc.Check if it is inserted correctly in the discplayer.Make sure the disc is not scratched or damaged.For more information, see page 249.
Disc Player Error Messages (Models without navigation system)
180
UNSUPPORTED
BAD DISCPLEASE CHECK
OWNERSMANUAL
PUSH EJECT
CHECK DISC
08/12/27 11:49:55 31TM8600 0185
2010 Insight
- +
Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system)F
eatures
181
BUTTON
BUTTON
TITLE BUTTON
AUX BUTTON
iPod INDICATOR
SEEK (SKIP )BUTTON
USB INDICATOR
BUTTON
RPT BUTTON
SEEK (SKIP )BUTTON
RDM BUTTON
EX model
09/01/07 16:00:52 31TM8600 0186
2010 Insight
Do not connect your iPod using ahub.
Do not keep the iPod in thevehicle. Direct sunlight and highheat will damage it.
Do not use an extension cablebetween the USB adapter cableequipped with your vehicle andyour dock connector.
We recommend backing up yourdata before playing it.
iPods compatible with your audiosystem using the USB adapter cableare:
Use only compatible iPods with thelatest software. iPods that are notcompatible will not work in this audiounit.
iPod and iTunes are registeredtrademarks owned by Apple Inc.
The system will only play songsstored on the iPod with iTunes.
This audio system can play the audiofiles on the iPod with the samecontrols used for the in-dash discplayer. To play an iPod, connect it tothe USB adapter cable in the consolecompartment by using your dockconnector, then press the AUXbutton. The ignition switch must bein the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II)position. The iPod will also berecharged with the ignition switch inthese positions.
Software
Ver. 1.2 or more
Ver. 1.0 or more
Ver. 1.2 or moreVer. 1.1.2 or more
Ver. 1.0 or more
Ver. 1.1.1 or moreVer. 1.1.1 or more
ModeliPod Classic5 Gen.(2005 or later)iPod Classic(2007 or later)iPod nanoiPod nano 2generationiPod nano 3generationiPod touchiPhone
th
nd
rd
EX modelTo Play an iPod
Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system)
182
NOTE:
09/01/07 16:01:01 31TM8600 0187
2010 Insight
Unclip the USB connector bypivoting it, and pull out the USBadapter cable in the consolecompartment.
Connect your dock connector tothe iPod correctly and securely.
Install the dock connector to theUSB adapter cable securely.
If the iPod indicator does not appearin the audio display, check theconnections, and try to reconnect theiPod a few times.
If the audio system still does notrecognize the iPod, the iPod mayneed to be reset. Follow theinstructions that came with youriPod, or you can find resetinstructions online at
1. 2.
3.
www.apple.com/ipod.
CONTINUED
Connecting an iPod
Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system)F
eatures
183
DOCK CONNECTOR
USB ADAPTERCABLE
USB CONNECTOR
USB ADAPTER CABLE
08/12/27 11:50:18 31TM8600 0188
2010 Insight
-+
-
>
Use the SKIP button while an iPod isplaying to change files.
Each time you press the(SKIP ) button, the system
skips forward to the beginning of thenext file. Press the (SKIP )button, to skip backward to thebeginning of the current file. Press itagain to skip to the beginning of theprevious file.
To move rapidly within a file, pressand hold either side ( or )of the SKIP button.
Each time you press the TITLEbutton the display mode switchesbetween the album name, the songname, the artist name, or name off(which turns off the text display).
The display shows up to 16characters of the selected data. If thetext data has more than 16characters, you will see the first 15characters and the indicator inthe display. Press and hold theTITLE button until the next 16characters are shown.
To Change or Select FilesText Data Display Function
SKIP
Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system)
184
08/12/27 11:50:26 31TM8600 0189
2010 Insight
-
-You can also select a file from anylist on the iPod menu: playlists,artists, albums and songs, by usingthe VOL/SELECT knob. Push theVOL/SELECT knob to switch thedisplay to an iPod menu, then turnthe VOL/SELECT knob to select adesired list. Press the VOL/SELECTknob to set your selection.
The display shows items on theselected list. Turn the VOL/SELECT knob to select an item, thenpress the VOL/SELECT knob to setyour selection.
If you select ‘‘ALL,’’ all available fileson the selected list are played.
Pressing the button goes backto the previous display and pressingthe TITLE button cancels thissetting mode.
You can select any type of repeat andshuffle mode by using the RPTbutton or the RDM button.
This featurecontinuously plays a file. To activatethe repeat feature, press the RPTbutton. You will see ‘‘RPT’’ in thedisplay. To turn it off, press the RPTbutton again.
This featureplays all available files in a selectedlist (playlists, artists, albums orsongs) in random order. To activatethe shuffle all feature, press theRDM button. You will see ‘‘RDM’’ inthe display. To turn it off, press andhold the RDM button.
CONTINUED
To Select Repeat or Shuffle Mode:
REPEAT
SHUFFLE ALL
Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system)F
eatures
185
Press the VOL/SELECT knob.
08/12/27 11:50:35 31TM8600 0190
2010 Insight
-
*
*
This featureplays all available albums in aselected list (playlists, artists, albumsor songs) in random order. The filesin each album are played in therecorded order. To activate theshuffle album feature, press theRDM button repeatedly. You will see‘‘F-RDM’’ in the display. To turn itoff, press and hold the RDM button.
Each time you press the RDMbutton, the mode changes fromshuffle all play to shuffle album play,then to normal play.
To play the radio when an iPod isplaying, press the FM/AM button. Ifa disc is in the audio unit, press theCD button to play the disc.
You can disconnect the iPod at anytime when you see the ‘‘OK todisconnect’’ message in the iPoddisplay. Always make sure you seethe ‘‘OK to disconnect’’ message inthe iPod display before youdisconnect it. Make sure to followthe iPod’s instructions on how todisconnect the dock connector fromthe USB adapter cable.
The displayed message mayvary on models or versions. Onsome models, there is nomessage to disconnect.
If you reconnect the same iPod, thesystem may begin playing where itleft off, depending on what mode theiPod is in when it is reconnected.
When you disconnect the iPod whileit is playing, the display shows ‘‘USBNO DATA.’’
If you see an error message in thedisplay, see page .
:
187
SHUFFLE ALBUM To Stop Playing Your iPod
iPod Error Messages
Disconnecting an iPod
Playing an iPod (Models without navigation system)
186
08/12/27 11:50:43 31TM8600 0191
2010 Insight
If you see an error message on theaudio display while playing an iPod,find the solution in the chart to theright. If you cannot clear the errormessage, take your vehicle to yourdealer.
CauseErrorMessage
Solution
USB ROM Error
Abnormal power source
No files in iPod
Use of unsupporteddevice
Use of unsupported iPod
Recognition failure ofiPod
There is problem with the USB adapter unit.Appears when the overcurrent protectionfeature of the system stops supplying power toUSB because an incompatible device isconnected. Disconnect the device. Then, turnthe audio system off, and turn it on again. Donot reconnect the device that caused the error.Appears when the iPod is empty. Store somefiles in the iPod.Appears when an unsupported device isconnected. Disconnect the device.Appears when an unsupported iPod isconnected. See page 182 for the specificationinformation for iPods. If it appears when asupported iPod is connected, update the iPodsoftware to the newer version.Appears when the system dose notacknowledge the iPod. Reconnect the iPod.
iPod Error Messages (Models without navigation system)F
eatures
187
USB ERRORBAD USBDEVICE
PLEASE CHECKOWNERSMANUAL
NO SONG
UNSUPPORTED
UNSUPPORTEDVER.
CONNECTRETRY
08/12/27 11:50:48 31TM8600 0192
2010 Insight
+-
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system)
188
BUTTON
BUTTON
TITLE BUTTON
SEEK (SKIP )BUTTON
USB INDICATOR AUX BUTTON
BUTTON
SEEK (SKIP )BUTTON
RDM BUTTON
RPT BUTTON
VOL/SELECT BUTTON
EX model
09/01/07 16:01:07 31TM8600 0193
2010 Insight
*
*
Some USB flash memory devices(such as devices with security lock-out features, etc.) will not work inthis audio unit.
Do not use a device such as a cardreader or hard drive as the deviceor your files may be damaged.
Do not connect your USB flashmemory device using a hub.
Do not use an extension cable tothe USB adapter cable equippedwith your vehicle.
Do not keep a USB flash memorydevice in the vehicle. Directsunlight and high heat will damageit.
We recommend backing up yourdata before playing a USB flashmemory device.
Depending on the type andnumber of files, it may take sometime before they begin to play.
Depending on the software thefiles were made with, it may not bepossible to play some files, ordisplay some text data.
The recommended USB flashmemory devices are 256 MB orhigher. Some digital audio playersmay be compatible as well.
Only AAC format files recordedwith iTunes are playable on thisaudio unit.
The audio system reads and playsthe audio files on the USB flashmemory device in MP3, WMA orAAC formats. Depending on theformat, the display shows MP3,WMA or AAC when a USB flashmemory device is playing. The USBflash memory device limit is up to700 folders or up to 65535 files.
This audio system can operate theaudio files on a USB flash memorydevice with the same controls usedfor the in-dash disc player. To play aUSB flash memory device, connect itto the USB adapter cable in theconsole compartment, then press theAUX button.
:
CONTINUED
EX model
To Play a USB Flash MemoryDevice
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system)F
eatures
189
NOTE:
09/01/07 16:01:18 31TM8600 0194
2010 Insight
--
-
-
-
-
-
--
-
-
-
--
-
--
The specifications for compatibleAAC files are:
Bitrate:8 320 kbpsSupported standards:MPEG4/AAC LCMPEG2/AAC LCPartition: Top partition onlyMaximum layers: 8
The specifications for compatibleWMA files are:
Bitrate:48 320/VBR kbps (Max 384)
Maximum layers: 8Partition: Top partition only
Sampling frequency:32/44.1/48 kHz
Supported standards:WMA version 7/8/9
Sampling frequency:8/11.025/12/16/22.05/24/32/44.1/48 kHz
The specifications for compatibleMP3 files are:
Bitrate:32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/160/192/224/256/320/VBR kbps(MPEG1)8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/144/160/VBR kbps(MPEG2)
Sampling frequency:32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1)16/22.05/24 kHz (MPEG2)
Supported standards:MPEG1 Audio Layer3MPEG2 Audio LSF Layer3Partition: Top partition onlyMaximum layers: 8
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system)
190
08/12/27 11:51:17 31TM8600 0195
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
Unclip the USB connector bypivoting it, and pull out the USBadapter cable in the consolecompartment.
When the USB flash memory deviceis connected, the USB indicator isshown in the display.
Connect the USB flash memorydevice to the USB connectorcorrectly and securely.
1. 2.
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system)
Connecting a USB Flash MemoryDevice
Features
191
USB CONNECTOR
USB ADAPTER CABLE USB ADAPTER CABLE
08/12/27 11:51:24 31TM8600 0196
2010 Insight
-+
-
-
>
Use the SKIP button while a USBflash memory device is playing tochange files.
Each time you press the(SKIP ) button, the system
skips forward to the beginning of thenext file. Press the (SKIP )button, to skip backward to thebeginning of the current file. Press itagain to skip to the beginning of theprevious file.
To move rapidly within a file, pressand hold either side ( or )of the SKIP button.
Each time you press the TITLEbutton, the display mode shows youin sequence, the folder name, the filename, the artist name, the albumname, the song name, or name off(which turns off the text display).
The display shows up to 16characters of the selected data. If thetext data has more than 16characters, you will see the first 15characters and the indicator inthe display. Press and hold theTITLE button until the next 16characters are shown.
Toselect a different folder, press the
button or button.Press the button to skip tothe next folder, and press the
button to skip to thebeginning of the previous folder.
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system)
To Change or Select FilesText Data Display Function
SKIP
FOLDER SELECTION
192
08/12/27 11:51:34 31TM8600 0197
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
You can also select a folder or file byusing the VOL/SELECT knob. Pushthe VOL/SELECT knob to switchthe display to the folder or file list,then turn the VOL/SELECT knob toselect a folder or file. Press theVOL/SELECT knob to set yourselection.
You can select any type of repeat,random and scan modes by using theRPT button, RDM button, or SCANbutton.
Pressing the button goes backto the previous display and pressingthe TITLE button cancels thissetting mode.
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system)
To Select a File from Folder and FileLists
To Select Repeat, Random or ScanMode:
Features
193
Press the VOL/SELECT knob.
Folder Selection
Track Selection
08/12/27 11:51:41 31TM8600 0198
2010 Insight
- - -This featurecontinuously plays a file. To activatethe repeat feature, press the RPTbutton. You will see ‘‘RPT’’ in thedisplay. To turn it off, press and holdthe RPT button.
This featurereplays all the files in the selectedfolder in the order they are stored.To activate the folder repeat feature,press the RPT button repeatedly.You will see ‘‘F-RPT’’ in the display.To turn it off, press and hold theRPT button.
Each time you press and release theRPT button, the mode changes fromfile repeat to folder repeat, then tonormal play.
This feature plays allthe files in random order. To activatethe track random feature, press theRDM button. You will see ‘‘RDM’’ inthe display. To turn it off, press andhold the RDM button.
REPEAT FOLDER REPEAT RANDOM
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system)
194
08/12/27 11:51:46 31TM8600 0199
2010 Insight
---
Each time you press and release theSCAN button, the mode changesfrom file scan to folder scan, then tonormal play.
This featuresamples the first file in each folder inthe order they are stored. Toactivate the folder scan feature,press the SCAN button repeatedly.You will see ‘‘F-SCAN’’ in the display.You will get a 10 second sampling ofthe first file in each folder. Press andhold the SCAN button to get out ofthe folder scan mode and play thelast file sampled.
This feature samples allfiles in the selected folder in theorder they are stored. To activatethe scan feature, press the SCANbutton. You will see ‘‘SCAN’’ in thedisplay. You will get a 10 secondsampling of each file in the folder.Press and hold the SCAN button toget out of the scan mode and playthe last file sampled.
Thisfeature plays the files in the selectedfolder in random order. To activatethe folder random feature, press theRDM button repeatedly. You will see‘‘F-RDM’’ in the display. To turn itoff, press and hold the RDM button.
Each time you press the RDMbutton, the mode changes from trackrandom, play to folder random play,then to normal play.
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system)
FOLDER SCANSCANFOLDER RANDOM
Features
195
08/12/27 11:51:51 31TM8600 0200
2010 Insight
If you see an error message in thedisplay, see page .
To play the radio when a USB flashmemory device is playing, press theFM/AM button. If a disc is in theaudio unit, press the CD button toplay the disc.
You can disconnect the USB flashmemory device at any time even ifthe USB mode is selected on theaudio system. Always follow the USBflash memory device’s instructionswhen you remove it.
When you disconnect the USB flashmemory device while it is playing,the display shows ‘‘USB NO DATA.’’
If you reconnect the same USB flashmemory device, the system willbegin playing where it left off.
197
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models without navigation system)
USB Flash Memory Device ErrorMessages
To Stop Playing a USB FlashMemory Device
Disconnecting a USB Flash MemoryDevice
196
08/12/27 11:51:58 31TM8600 0201
2010 Insight
If you see an error message on theaudio display while playing a USBflash memory device, find thesolution in the chart to the right. Ifyou cannot clear the error message,take your vehicle to your dealer.
ErrorMessage
Cause Solution
USB ROM Error
Abnormal power source
Use of unsupported files
No files in USB flashmemory device
Use of unsupported USBflash memory device
There is problem with the USB adapter unit.Appears when the overcurrent protectionfeature of the system stops supplying power toUSB because an incompatible device isconnected. Disconnect the device. Then, turnthe audio system off, and turn it on again. Donot reconnect the device that caused the error.Appears when the files in the USB flashmemory device are DRM or an unsupportedformat. This error message appears for about 3seconds, then plays the next song.Appears when the USB flash memory device isempty or there are no MP3, WMA, or AAC filesin the USB flash memory device. Save someMP3, WMA, or AAC files in the USB flashmemory device.Appears when an unsupported device isconnected. See page 190 for the specificationinformation for the USB flash memory device.If it appears when the supported device isconnected, reconnect the device.
USB Flash Memory Device Error Messages (Models without navigation system)F
eatures
197
USB ERRORBAD USBDEVICE
PLEASE CHECKOWNERSMANUAL
UNPLAYABLEFILE
NO SONG
UNSUPPORTED
08/12/27 11:52:03 31TM8600 0202
2010 Insight
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system)
198
TUNE BAR
SCAN BUTTON
AUDIO BUTTON
PRESET BUTTONS
AM/FM BUTTON
POWER/VOLUME KNOB FM1 ICON SOUND ICONAM ICON
BACK GROUND ICONAUTO SELECT ICONFM2 ICON
08/12/27 11:52:08 31TM8600 0203
2010 Insight
-
▲ ▼
▼
▲
You can also operate the audiosystem without using the controlicons on the audio screen. Use thecontrol buttons on the left side of thescreen. The status bar appears onthe bottom of the screen each timeyou operate any of the controlbuttons. On the navigation screen,you can also see audio informationby touching the AUDIO INFO iconon the lower half of the screen.
The band and frequency that theradio was last tuned to are displayed.To change bands, press the AM/FMbutton, or touch the desired bandicon (FM1, FM2, or AM). On the FMband, STEREO will be displayed ifthe station is broadcasting in stereo.Stereo reproduction on AM is notavailable.
You can use any of five methods tofind radio stations on the selectedband: tune, seek, scan, the presetbuttons, and auto select.
Use the TUNE bar to tunethe radio to a desired frequency.Press the side of the bar to tuneto a higher frequency, and press the
side to tune to a lowerfrequency.
Press and hold the or side ofthe TUNE bar until you hear twobeeps to change the frequencyrapidly. Release the bar when thedisplay reaches the desiredfrequency.
In addition to the standard audiocontrols, the audio system in yourvehicle can be operated using thevoice control system. See theNavigation System Manual forcomplete details.
Turn the system on by pushing thepower/volume knob or the AM/FMbutton. Adjust the volume by turningthe power/volume knob.
Pushing the AUDIO button will alsoturn on the system.
CONTINUED
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system)
Voice Control System To Select a Station
TUNE
To Play the AM/FM Radio
Features
199
08/12/27 11:52:16 31TM8600 0204
2010 Insight
-
▲ ▼
-
-The seek functionsearches up and down from thecurrent frequency to find a stationwith a strong signal. To activate it,press and hold the or side ofthe TUNE bar until you hear a beep,then release it.
The scan function samplesall stations with strong signals on theselected band. To activate it, pressthe SCAN button, then release it.You will see SCAN in the display.When the system finds a strongsignal, it will stop and play thatstation for about 10 seconds.
Each preset button’s frequency isshown on the bottom of the audiodisplay.
If you do nothing, the system willthen scan for the next strong stationand play it for 10 seconds. When itplays a station you want to listen to,press the SCAN button again.
Each preset button canstore one frequency on AM and twofrequencies on FM.
Select the desired band, AM orFM.
Use the tune, seek, or scanfunction to tune the radio to adesired station.
Pick a preset button, and hold ituntil you hear a beep.
Repeat steps 1 through 3 to store atotal of six stations on AM andtwelve stations on FM.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system)
SEEK
SCAN
Preset
200
08/12/27 11:52:25 31TM8600 0205
2010 Insight
- If you aretraveling and can no longer receiveyour preset stations, you can use theauto select feature to find stations inthe local area.
Press the AUDIO button to view theaudio control icons, then touch theAUTO SEL icon. You will see AUTOSEL flashes in the display, and thesystem goes into scan mode forseveral seconds. It stores thefrequencies of six AM, and twelveFM stations in the preset buttons.
You will see ‘‘0’’ displayed afterpressing a preset button if autoselect cannot find a strong station forevery preset button.
If you do not like the stations autoselect has stored, you can storeother frequencies on the presetbuttons as previously described.
touch theAUTO SEL icon. This restores thepresets you originally set.
For information on FM/AM radiofrequencies and reception, see page
.
You can adjust the sound on thenavigation screen. To adjust thesound, push the AUDIO button, thenenter the sound grid by touching theSOUND icon on the display.
246
To turn off Auto Select,
CONTINUED
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system)
AUTO SELECT Adjusting the Sound
Features
201
SOUND ICON
08/12/27 11:52:33 31TM8600 0206
2010 Insight
-
-
-
--
Adjusts the bass.
Adjusts the front-to-backstrength of the sound. To adjust thefront/rear fader, touch the FR or RRicon.
Adjusts the side-to-side strength of the sound. To adjustthe left/right balance, touch the L orR icon.
The right upper display shows youthe current setting of the soundstrength coming from each speaker.
The SVC modecontrols the volume based on vehiclespeed. The faster you go, the louderthe audio volume becomes. As youslow down, the audio volumedecreases. Touch the appropriateicon (Low, Mid, Hi, Off) to select themode.
This function is set to MID as thedefault setting when the vehicleleaves the factory. If you feel thesound is too loud, choose low. If youfeel the sound is too quiet, choose Hi.
You can also select the icon with thejoystick. Move it up and down tomove the highlighting and scrollthrough lists. Select the icon, thenenter the joystick.
The system will return to the audiodisplay about 10 seconds after youstop adjusting a mode.
Adjusts the treble. Toadjust the treble and bass, toucheither or on the treble orbass adjustment bar. The adjustmentbar on the lower right display showsyou the current setting.
BASS
FADER
BALANCE
SVC (speed-sensitive volumecompensation)
TREBLE
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system)
202
SPEAKER SETTING
BASS/TREBLE SETTING
08/12/27 11:52:42 31TM8600 0207
2010 Insight
You can use the instrument panelbrightness control knob to adjust theillumination of the control panel (seepage ). The audio systemilluminates when the parking lightsare on, even if the radio is turned off.
You can select the backgroundscreen to display the sound level.There are three screen modes: level(the sound level is shown with thevertical bars), spectrum analysis (thesound level appears as ripples ofwater), and off. Each time you touchthe background icon, the displaychanges.
121
Playing the AM/FM Radio (Models with navigation system)
Audio System LightingScreen Mode
Features
203
08/12/27 11:52:46 31TM8600 0208
2010 Insight
-
+
Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system)
204
SCAN BUTTON
JOYSTICK
AUDIO BUTTON
POWER/VOLUMEKNOB
OPEN BUTTON
RANDOMBUTTON
REPEAT BUTTON REWIND BUTTON
FAST FORWARDBUTTON
TUNE BAR
CD ICON
CD/AUX BUTTON
SKIP BUTTON
SKIP BUTTON
08/12/27 11:52:51 31TM8600 0209
2010 Insight
You operate the in-dash disc playerwith the same controls used for theradio.
This audio system can also play CD-Rs and CD-RWs compressed in MP3or WMA formats. When playing adisc in MP3, you will see ‘‘MP3’’ onthe screen. In WMA format, ‘‘WMA’’will appear on the screen. You canselect up to 255 folders and play upto 999 tracks. If the disc has acomplex structure, it takes a while toread the disc before the systembegins to play it.
If you have a disc that is acombination of CD-DA tracks andMP3/WMA files, you can choose theformat to listen to by pressing andholding the CD/AUX button.
Video CDs and DVD discs will notwork in this unit.
A disc compressed in AAC formatcannot be played in this audiosystem.
CONTINUED
Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system)
To Play a Disc(In-dash single player)
Features
205
Do not use discs with adhesive labels.The label can curl up and cause thedisc to jam in the unit.
08/12/27 11:52:58 31TM8600 0210
2010 Insight
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
The specifications for compatibleMP3 files are:
The specifications for compatibleWMA files are:
If an MP3 or WMA file isprotected by digital rightsmanagement (DRM), the audio unitdisplays FILE ERROR, and thenskips to the next file.
Sampling frequency:32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1)16/22.05/24 kHz (MPEG2)Bitrate:32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/160/192/224/256/320 kbps(MPEG1)8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/160 kbps (MPEG2)Compatible with variable bitrateand multi-sessionMaximum layers(including ROOT): 8 layers
Sampling frequency:32/44.1/48 kHzBitrate:48/64/80/96/128/160/192 kbps
Maximum layers(including ROOT): 8 layers
Compatible with variable bitrateand multi-session
Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system)
206
NOTE:
08/12/27 11:53:07 31TM8600 0211
2010 Insight
The in-dash disc player is behind thenavigation screen. To use the discplayer, press the OPEN buttonbeside the screen. The screen foldsback, and the disc slot appears.
Insert a disc about halfway into thedisc slot. The drive will pull the discin the rest of the way and begin toplay it.
You cannot load and play 3-inch(8-cm) discs in this system.
To return the screen to the uprightposition, press the CLOSE button onthe edge of the screen panel. Do notuse the folded screen as a tray. Ifyou put a cup, for example, on thescreen, the liquid inside the cup mayspill on the screen when you go overa bump.
CONTINUED
To Load a Disc
Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system)
Features
207
DISC SLOT CLOSE BUTTON
OPEN BUTTON
08/12/27 11:53:15 31TM8600 0212
2010 Insight
-
-
Press the AUDIO button beside thescreen to show the audio display andoperate the in-dash disc player.
You can also operate the audiosystem without using the controlicons on the audio screen. Press theCD/AUX button. The status barappears on the bottom of the screen.On the navigation screen, you cansee the audio information wheneveryou touch the AUDIO INFO orTRACK LIST icons on the lower halfof the screen.
When playing a CD recorded withtext data, the track, album, and artistname are shown on the audio display.When playing a disc in MP3 or WMA,the folder number and name, the filenumber and name, the artist name,and the elapsed time are shown. Thesystem will continuously play a discuntil you change modes. If the discwas not recorded with text data, itwill not be displayed.
You can use the preset buttons whilea disc is playing to select passagesand change tracks (files in MP3 orWMA mode). Each preset button’sfunction is shown on the bottom ofthe screen.
You can also select an icon with thejoystick. Move it to left, right, up, ordown to change the highlighting andscroll through lists. Then press ENTon the top of the joystick to selectthe icon.
Each time you press andrelease (preset 6), the playerskips forward to the beginning of thenext track (file in MP3 or WMAmode). Press and release
(preset 5), to skip backward tothe beginning of the current track.Press it again to skip to thebeginning of the previous track.
To move rapidly withina track/file, press and hold
(preset 4) or (preset 3).
To Change or Select Tracks/Files
SKIP
FF/REW
Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system)
208
PRESET BUTTONS
PRESET BUTTON’S FUNCTION
08/12/27 11:53:24 31TM8600 0213
2010 Insight
---
▲▼
In MP3 or WMA mode In MP3 or WMA modeThis feature,
when activated, replays all files onthe selected folder in the order theyare compressed. To activate folderrepeat, press and hold the RPTbutton (preset 1) for 2 seconds. Youwill see FOLDER REPEAT in thedisplay. The system continuouslyreplays the current folder. Press theRPT button again to turn it off.Selecting a different folder with theTUNE bar also turns off folderrepeat.
To continuously replaya track (file in MP3 or WMA mode),press and release the RPT button(preset 1). You will see TRACKREPEAT in the display. Press theRPT button again to turn it off.
Toselect a different folder, press eitherside of the TUNE bar to move to thebeginning of the next folder. Pressthe side of the TUNE bar to skipto the next folder, and the side tomove to the beginning of the currentfolder. Press it again to skip to thebeginning of the previous folder.
CONTINUED
Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system)
FOLDER REPEATTRACK REPEAT (FILEREPEAT)FOLDER SELECTION
Features
209
08/12/27 11:53:30 31TM8600 0214
2010 Insight
- --
Thisfeature plays the tracks/files withina disc in random order. To activatetrack random, press and release theRDM button (preset 2). You will seeTRACK RANDOM in the display.Press the RDM button again toreturn to normal play.
Thisfeature, when activated, plays allfiles in the selected folder in randomorder, rather than in the order theyare compressed. To activate folderrandom, press and hold the RDMbutton. You will see FOLDERRANDOM in the display. Thesystem then selects and plays filesrandomly. This continues until youdeactivate folder random by pressingthe RDM button again, or if youselect a different folder with theTUNE bar.
The scan function samples all tracks(files in MP3 or WMA) in the orderthey were recorded. To activate scan,press and release the SCAN button.You will see TRACK SCAN in thedisplay. You will get a 10 secondsampling of each track/file on thedisc. Press the SCAN button to getout of scan mode and play the lasttrack/file sampled.
Pressing either SKIP button (preset5 or 6) also turns off scan.
In MP3 or WMA mode
Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system)
TRACK RANDOM (Randomwithin a disc/folder) FOLDER RANDOM
SCAN (TRACK/FILE SCAN)
210
08/12/27 11:53:35 31TM8600 0215
2010 Insight
-
CONTINUED
You can also select a track/filedirectly from a track list on the audiodisplay. Press the AUDIO button toshow the audio display, then touchthe Track List icon. The track listmenu appears on the display.
This feature,when activated, samples all the firstfiles in each folder on the disc inorder. To activate folder scan, pressand hold the SCAN button for 2seconds. You will see ‘‘FOLDERSCAN’’ in the display.
The system plays the first file ineach folder for about 10 seconds. Ifyou do nothing, the system thenplays the first file in each folder for10 seconds each. After playing thefirst file of the last folder, the systemgoes to normal play.
Pressing either SKIP button (preset5 or 6), selecting a different folderwith the TUNE bar, or pressing theSCAN button, also turns off folderscan.
In MP3 or WMA mode
Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system)
Using a Track ListFOLDER SCAN
Features
211
TRACK/FILE ICON
FOLDER NUMBER RETURN ICON
FOLDER ICON
08/12/27 11:53:42 31TM8600 0216
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
When playing a CD recorded withtext data, each track name is shownon the audio display. With a discrecorded in MP3 or WMA, the foldernumber and the location are alsodisplayed.
If the disc was not recorded with textdata, only the track number is shown.
To scroll through the display, touchthe or icon on the side of thescreen. To go back to the previousdisplay, touch the Return icon on thescreen.
Select the desired track/file bytouching the icon on the display. Theselected icon will be highlighted inblue. The system begins to play theselected track/file. With a disc inMP3 or WMA, touch the folder iconon the upper left of the screen tomove to the parent folder. Thecurrent folder is highlighted in blue.
To play the radio when a disc isplaying, press the AM/FM button ortouch the FM1, FM2, or AM icon. Ifa PC card is in the audio unit, touchthe CARD icon to play the PC card.Press the CD/AUX button again ortouch the CD icon to switch back tothe in-dash disc player.
If you turn the system off while adisc is playing, either with thepower/volume knob or by turningoff the ignition switch, the disc willstay in the drive. When you turn thesystem back on, the disc will beginplaying where it left off.
Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system)
To Stop Playing a Disc
212
08/12/27 11:53:48 31TM8600 0217
2010 Insight
To return the screen to the uprightposition, press the CLOSE button.
You cannot close the screen if a discis partially inserted into its slot.
You can also eject the disc when theignition switch is off.
For information on how to handleand protect discs, see page .
To remove a disc from the audio unit,fold back the screen by pressing theOPEN button (see page ). Pressthe disc eject button ( ) toremove the disc. If you eject the disc,but do not remove it from the slot,the system will automatically reloadit after 10 seconds and put it in pausemode. To begin playing, press theCD/AUX button.
248207
Playing a Disc (Models with navigation system)
Removing a Disc Protecting Discs
Features
213
08/12/27 11:53:54 31TM8600 0218
2010 Insight
The chart on the right explains theerror messages you may see in thedisplay while playing a disc.
If you see an error message in thedisplay while playing a disc, pressthe eject button. After ejecting thedisc, check it for damage ordeformation. If there is no damage,insert the disc again.
SolutionCauseErrorMessage
The audio system will try to play thedisc. If there is still a problem, theerror message will reappear. Pressthe eject button, and pull out the disc.
Insert a different disc. If the newdisc plays, there is a problem withthe first disc. If the error messagecycle repeats and you cannot clear it,take your vehicle to a dealer.
Press the eject button, and pull out the disc.Check if it is inserted correctly in the discplayer. Make sure the disc is not scratched ordamaged.Press the eject button, and pull out the disc.Check the disc for damage or deformation. Ifthe disc cannot be pulled out, or the errormessage does not disappear after the disc isejected, see your dealer.Press the eject button, and pull out the disc.Check the disc for damage or deformation.Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.
FOCUS Error
Mechanical Error
Disc Format Error
High Temperature
Disc Player Error Messages (Models with navigation system)
214
CHECK DISC
MECH ERROR
CHECK DISC
HEAT ERROR
08/12/27 11:54:00 31TM8600 0219
2010 Insight
+
-
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)F
eatures
215
OPEN BUTTON
AUDIO BUTTON
SCAN BUTTON
REPEAT BUTTON
SKIP BUTTONFAST FORWARDBUTTON
REWIND BUTTON
JOYSTICK
TUNE BAR
PLAY MODEICON
TRACK LIST ICON
POWER/VOLUME KNOB
CD/AUX BUTTON
RANDOM BUTTON
SKIP BUTTON
PC CARD ICON
08/12/27 11:54:05 31TM8600 0220
2010 Insight
You operate the PC card player withthe same controls used for the radioand the in-dash disc player. To loador play a card, the ignition switchmust be in the ACCESSORY (I) orON (II) position.
The PC card player reads and playscards in MP3 or WMA formats.Depending on the format, the screenwill indicate ‘‘MP3’’ or ‘‘WMA’’ whena card is playing. The card limit ofthe player is 255 folders and 999tracks. If the card has a complexstructure, it takes some time for thesystem to begin playing it.
When you insert a PC card intothe slot, make sure you put it instraight. If you cannot insert it,remove it, and insert again.
Do not keep PC cards in thevehicle. Direct sunlight and highheat will damage them.
To avoid damaging the cardreader, do not insert hard discdrive cards into the PC card slot.
You cannot close the screen(move it to the upright position)until the PC card is inserted all theway into its slot or removed.
Never insert foreign objects intothe PC card slot.
Based on PCMCIA 2.1/JEIDA 4.2,the recommended PC cards for thePC card reader are:
CompactFlashFlash ATA
SD memory card
Always use the recommendedmemory card with the appropriateadapter (if an adapter is needed).Some memory cards will not work inthis unit.
To Play a PC Card
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)
216
NOTE:
08/12/27 11:54:14 31TM8600 0221
2010 Insight
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
The specifications for compatibleMP3 files are:
The specifications for compatibleWMA files are:
In WMA format, DRM (digital rightsmanagement) files cannot be played.If the system finds a DRM file, itskips that file and plays the nextavailable folder or file.
Sampling frequency:32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1),16/22.05/24 kHz (MPEG2)Bitrate:32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/160/192/224/256/320 kbps(MPEG1),8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/160 kbps (MPEG2)Compatible with variable bitrateand multi-session.Maximum layers(including ROOT): 8 layers
Sampling frequency:32/44.1/48 kHzBitrate:48/64/80/96/128/160/192 kbpsCompatible with variable bitrateand multi-session.Maximum layers(including ROOT): 8 layers
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)F
eatures
217
08/12/27 11:54:20 31TM8600 0222
2010 Insight
The PC card slot is behind thenavigation screen. To use the PCcard player, press the OPEN buttonbeside the screen. The screen foldsback, and the PC card slot appears.
Insert a PC card straight into the slot.The drive will read the PC card andbegin to play it.
Return the screen to the uprightposition by pressing the CLOSEbutton on the edge of the screenpanel.
Press the AUDIO button beside thescreen to show the audio display andoperate the PC card player.
You can also operate the audiosystem without using the controlicons on the audio screen. Press anyof the appropriate control buttons.The status bar appears on thebottom of the screen. On thenavigation screen, you can see theaudio information whenever youtouch the AUDIO INFO icon on thescreen.
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)
Loading a PC Card
218
PC CARD SLOT
08/12/27 11:54:26 31TM8600 0223
2010 Insight
Artist mode plays tracks inalphabetical order, by artist andsong title.
There are three play modes: Folder,Artist, and Album. Touch the PLAYMODE icon, then choose one of themodes by touching its icon. When amode is selected, it is highlighted inblue.
Folder mode plays tracks in theorder they were added to the card.
Album mode plays albums(folders) in alphabetical order.
If play mode information was notincluded in the tracks/files whenthey were added to the card, it willnot be displayed on the screen.
CONTINUED
To select a play mode
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)F
eatures
219
MODE INDICATOR
PLAY MODE ICON
PLAY MODE ICON PLAY MODE ICON
MODE INDICATOR MODE INDICATOR
FOLDER MODE
ARTIST MODE ALBUM MODE
08/12/27 11:54:36 31TM8600 0224
2010 Insight
To select a play mode, push theAUDIO button to show the audiodisplay, then touch the PLAY MODEicon on the display.
Select the desired mode by touchingthe appropriate icon, or move thejoystick, then press ENT.
After you select the play mode, thedisplay changes to the selectableplaying menu. If you select‘‘Continue playing the current song,’’the system goes into the selectedplay mode after playing the currentfile.
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)
220
PLAY MODE ICON
08/12/27 11:54:43 31TM8600 0225
2010 Insight
-
-
You can use the preset buttons whilea card is playing to select or changefiles. Each preset button’s function isshown on the bottom of the screen.
To go back to the previous screen,press the CANCEL button on theright side of the screen. To exit theplay mode screens, press the AUDIObutton.
If you select ‘‘Play a new track list,’’the system goes into the selectedplay mode immediately and begins toplay the new track list.
Icons on the screen can also beselected with the joystick. Move thejoystick left or right and up or downuntil the icon is highlighted, thenpress ENT on the top of the joystickto select the icon.
Each time you press andrelease (preset 6), the playerskips forward to the beginning of thenext file. Press and release
(preset 5), to skip backward tothe beginning of the current file.Press it again to skip to thebeginning of the previous file.
To move rapidly withina file, press and hold (preset 4)or (preset 3).
CONTINUED
To Change or Select Tracks/Files
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)
SKIP
FF/REW
Features
221
PRESET BUTTONS
PRESET BUTTON’S FUNCTION
08/12/27 11:54:51 31TM8600 0226
2010 Insight
-
▲▼
-
- -To
select a different folder, press eitherside of the TUNE bar to move to thebeginning of the next folder. Pressthe side of the TUNE bar to skipto the next folder, and the side tomove to the beginning of the currentfolder. Press it again to skip to thebeginning of the previous folder.
To continuously replaya file, press the RPT button (preset1). You will see ‘‘TRACK REPEAT’’in the display. Press the RPT buttonagain to turn it off.
This feature, whenactivated, replays all the files on theselected folder/artist/album in theorder they are recorded or listed. Toactivate each repeat mode, press andhold the RPT button (preset 1) for 2seconds. You will see FOLDERREPEAT, ARTIST REPEAT orALBUM REPEAT in the display.The system continuously replays thecurrent folder/artist/album. Pressand hold the RPT button again toturn it off. Pressing the RDM button,or selecting a different folder/artist/album with the TUNE bar also turnsoff the repeat feature.
This featureplays the files within a folder inrandom order. To activate randomplay, press and release the RDMbutton (preset 2). You will seeTRACK RANDOM in the display.Press the RDM button again toreturn to normal play.
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)
FOLDER SELECTION
TRACK REPEAT (FILEREPEAT)
FOLDER/ARTIST/ALBUMREPEAT
TRACK RANDOM (Randomwithin a folder)
222
08/12/27 11:54:56 31TM8600 0227
2010 Insight
-- -
The SCAN functionsamples all the files on the PC cardin the order they are recorded. Toactivate the scan feature, press andrelease the SCAN button. You willsee TRACK SCAN in the display.You will get a 10 second sampling ofeach file on the PC card. Press theSCAN button again to get out of scanmode and play the last file sampled.
Pressing either of the SKIP buttons(preset 5 or 6) also turns off the scanfeature.
This feature, whenactivated, plays all files in eachfolder/artist/album in random order,rather than in the order they arerecorded or listed. To activate eachrandom play, push and hold theRDM button (preset 2) for 2 seconds.You will see ‘‘FOLDER RANDOM,ARTIST RANDOM or ALBUMRANDOM’’ in the display.
The system then selects and playsfiles randomly. This continues untilyou deactivate each random play bypressing the RDM button again.
This feature, whenactivated, samples the first file ineach folder/artist/album on the PCcard in order. To activate each scanfeature, press and hold the SCANbutton. You will see ‘‘FOLDERSCAN, ARTIST SCAN or ALBUMSCAN’’ in the display.
The system plays the first file in thefolder for about 10 seconds. If you donothing, the system plays the firstfile in each folder, in order, for 10seconds each. After playing the firstfile of the last folder/artist/album,the system returns to normal play.
Pressing either of the SKIP buttons(preset 5 or 6), selecting a differentfolder/artist/album with the TUNEbar, or pressing the SCAN button,also turns off the scan feature.
CONTINUED
SCANFOLDER/ARTIST/ALBUMRANDOM
FOLDER/ARTIST/ALBUMSCAN
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)F
eatures
223
08/12/27 11:55:03 31TM8600 0228
2010 Insight
▲ ▼To scroll through the display, touchthe or icon on the side of thescreen. To go back to the previousdisplay, touch the Return icon.
You can also select a file directlyfrom a track list on the audio display.Press the AUDIO button to show theaudio display, then touch the TrackList icon. The track list menuappears on the display. To play a file, touch its icon on the
screen. In folder mode, touch thefolder icon on the upper left of thescreen to move to the parent folder.The current folder is highlighted inblue.
In artist mode, the artist name is alsodisplayed on the right side of eachselectable icon. Select the desiredfile.
Using a Track List
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)
224
RETURN ICON
FOLDER ICON
TRACK LIST ICON
ARTIST NAME
08/12/27 11:55:12 31TM8600 0229
2010 Insight
In album mode, the album name isalso displayed on the right side ofeach selectable icon. Select thedesired file.
When you select ‘‘Song Search’’ fromthe track list display, the song searchmenu appears.
You can then select any of threemodes to search a file: Title byKeyword, Artist, and Album.
CONTINUED
Song Search Function
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)F
eatures
225
RETURN ICON
ALBUM NAME
Folder mode is shown.
SONG SEARCH ICON TITLE BY KEYWORD ICON
ARTIST ICON ALBUM ICON
08/12/27 11:55:21 31TM8600 0230
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
Searching for a Song Title by Keyword
In Title by Keyword mode, enter thetitle name, or any keyword, bytouching the letter icons on thescreen. Press the List icon to beginthe song search. If you press theCANCEL button on the control panel,the display returns to the modemenu without doing a search.
To cancel the selected letter, touchthe Delete icon. To select morecharacters, touch the More icon.The other character list will beshown.
After the system searches for a song,a file list is displayed. To scrollthrough the list, touch the oricon on the side of the screen. Selectthe desired file by touching theappropriate icon, or moving thejoystick and pressing ENT.
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)
226
DELETE ICON LIST ICON
FILE LIST
MORE ICON
08/12/27 11:55:27 31TM8600 0231
2010 Insight
Searching for a Song by Artist Name Searching for a Song by Album Name
Select the Artist icon, and the artistlist appears. Select the desired artist,and the artist’s file list is displayed.
Select the Album icon, and thealbum list appears. Select the desiredalbum, and its song list is displayed.You can then select the desired songfrom the list.
To play the radio when a PC card isplaying, press the AM/FM button ortouch the FM1, FM2, or AM icon. Ifa disc is in the audio unit, press theCD/AUX button or touch the CDicon to play the disc. Touch theCARD icon to switch back to the PCcard player.
If you turn the system off while a PCcard is playing, either with thepower/volume knob or by turningoff the ignition switch, the card willstay in the drive. When you turn thesystem back on, the card will beginplaying where it left off.
When you leave the vehicle, alwaysremove the PC card from the audiounit.
CONTINUED
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)
To Stop Playing a PC Card
Features
227
ARTIST LIST ALBUM LIST
08/12/27 11:55:36 31TM8600 0232
2010 Insight
To remove a PC card from the audiounit, fold back the screen bypressing the OPEN button (see page
). Press the eject button ( )to remove the card. If you do notremove it from the slot, you cannotreturn the screen to the uprightposition.
To return the screen to the uprightposition, press the CLOSE button.
You can also eject a card when theignition switch is off.
If there is a problem with the PCcard player, see your dealer.
207
Playing a PC Card (Models with navigation system)
Removing a PC Card PC Card Player Malfunction
228
08/12/27 11:55:42 31TM8600 0233
2010 Insight
-
+
Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system)F
eatures
229
iPod INDICATOR
AUDIO BUTTON
USB ICON
SKIP BUTTON
SKIP BUTTON
JOYSTICK
POWER/VOLUME KNOB
CD/AUX BUTTON
SCAN BUTTON
REPEAT BUTTON
RANDOM BUTTON
08/12/27 11:55:47 31TM8600 0234
2010 Insight
This audio system can play the audiofiles on the iPod with the samecontrols used for the in-dash discplayer. To play an iPod, connect it tothe USB adapter cable in the consolecompartment by using your dockconnector, then press the CD/AUXbutton. The ignition switch must bein the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II)position. The iPod will also berecharged with the ignition switch inthese positions.
The system will only play songsstored on the iPod with iTunes.
iPod and iTunes are registeredtrademarks owned by Apple Inc.
Do not connect your iPod using ahub.
Do not keep the iPod in thevehicle. Direct sunlight and highheat will damage it.
Do not use an extension cablebetween the USB adapter cableequipped with your vehicle andyour dock connector.
We recommend backing up yourdata before playing it.
iPods compatible with your audiosystem using the USB adapter cableare:
Use only compatible iPods with thelatest software. iPods that are notcompatible will not work in this audiounit.
Software
Ver. 1.2 or more
Ver. 1.0 or more
Ver. 1.2 or moreVer. 1.1.2 or more
Ver. 1.0 or more
Ver. 1.1.1 or moreVer. 1.1.1 or more
ModeliPod Classic5 Gen.(2005 or later)iPod Classic(2007 or later)iPod nanoiPod nano 2generationiPod nano 3generationiPod touchiPhone
th
nd
rd
To Play an iPod
Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system)
230
NOTE:
08/12/27 11:55:56 31TM8600 0235
2010 Insight
Unclip the USB connector bypivoting it, and pull out the USBadapter cable in the consolecompartment.
Connect your dock connector tothe iPod correctly and securely.
Install the dock connector to theUSB adapter cable securely.
If the audio system still does notrecognize the iPod, the iPod mayneed to be reset. Follow theinstructions that came with youriPod, or you can find resetinstructions online at
The current file number and total ofthe selected playable files aredisplayed on the screen. It alsoshows the artist, album and track(file) names on the screen.
1. 2.
3.
www.apple.com/ipod.
CONTINUED
Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system)
Connecting an iPod
Features
231
DOCK CONNECTOR
USB CONNECTOR
USB ADAPTER CABLE
USB CONNECTOR
08/12/27 11:56:04 31TM8600 0236
2010 Insight
-+
-
You can also select a file from anylist on the iPod menu: playlists,artists, albums and songs. Press theAUDIO button to display the screen,then touch the iPod MENU icon.
Select the desired mode by touchingthe appropriate icon, or move thejoystick, then press ENT.
Use the SKIP button while an iPod isplaying to change files.
Each time you press theSKIP button (Preset 6), thesystem skips forward to thebeginning of the next file. Press theSKIP button (Preset 5), to skipbackward to the beginning of thecurrent file. Press it again to skip tothe beginning of the previous file.
If you select ‘‘ALL’’ on either theartists or albums list, all availablefiles on the selected list are played.
Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system)
To Select a File from iPod MenuTo Change or Select Files
SKIP
232
08/12/27 11:56:12 31TM8600 0237
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
Press the AUDIO button to go backto the normal audio playing display.Pressing the CANCEL button goesback to the previous screen, andpressing the MAP button cancels theaudio control display on the screen.
You can also select a file directlyfrom a track list on the audio display.Press the AUDIO button to show theaudio display, then touch the TrackList icon. The track list menuappears on the display.
To scroll through the display, touchthe or icon on the side of thescreen. To go back to the previousdisplay, touch the Return icon.
To play a file, touch its icon on thescreen. The current folder ishighlighted in blue.
CONTINUED
Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system)
Using a Track List
Features
233
RETURN ICONTRACK LIST ICON
08/12/27 11:56:20 31TM8600 0238
2010 Insight
- -You can select any type of repeat andrandom mode by using the RPTbutton or RDM button.
This featurecontinuously plays a file. To activatethe repeat feature, press the RPTbutton (Preset 1). You will see‘‘REPEAT’’ in the display. To turn itoff, press the RPT button (Preset 1)again.
This featureplays all available files from theselected items in the iPod menu list(playlists, artists, albums or songs)in random order. To activate thetrack random feature, press theRDM button (Preset 2). You will see‘‘TRACK RANDOM’’ in the display.To turn it off, press the RDM button(Preset 2).
Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system)
To Select Repeat or Random Mode: REPEAT TRACK RANDOM
234
08/12/27 11:56:25 31TM8600 0239
2010 Insight
- *
*
This featureplays all available albums from theselected items in the iPod menu list(playlists, artists, albums or songs)in random order. The files in eachalbum are played in the recordedorder. To activate the album randomfeature, press and hold the RDMbutton (Preset 2). You will see‘‘ALBUM RANDOM’’ in the display.To turn it off, press and hold theRDM button (Preset 2).
You can also select another list fromthe iPod menu while keeping therandom function.
Available operating functions varieson models or versions. Somefunctions may not be available on thevehicle’s audio system.
Press the CD/AUX button again ortouch the AUX icon to switch back tothe iPod.
You can disconnect the iPod at anytime when you see the ‘‘OK todisconnect’’ message in the iPoddisplay. Always make sure you seethe ‘‘OK to disconnect’’ message inthe iPod display before youdisconnect it. Make sure to followthe iPod’s instructions on how todisconnect the dock connector fromthe USB adapter cable.
The displayed message mayvary on models or versions. Onsome models, there is nomessage to disconnect.
When you disconnect the iPod whileit is playing, the navigation screenshows ‘‘NO DATA.’’
If you reconnect the same iPod, thesystem may begin playing where itleft off, depending on what mode theiPod is in when it is reconnected.
If you see an error message on thescreen, see page .
To play the radio when an iPod isplaying, press the FM/AM button ortouch the FM1, FM2, or AM icon. Ifa disc is in the audio unit, press theCD/AUX button or touch the CDicon to play the disc. If a PC card isin the audio unit, press the CD/AUXbutton or touch the CARD icon toplay a PC card.
:
236
ALBUM RANDOM To Stop Playing Your iPod
iPod Error MessagesDisconnecting an iPod
Playing an iPod (Models with navigation system)F
eatures
235
NOTE:
08/12/27 11:56:34 31TM8600 0240
2010 Insight
If you see an error message on thescreen while playing an iPod, findthe solution in the chart to the right.If you cannot clear the errormessage, take your vehicle to yourdealer.
Error Message Solution
Appears when an unsupported iPod is connected.There is no music information.
iPod Error Messages (Models with navigation system)
236
UNSUPPORTEDNO SONG
08/12/27 11:56:39 31TM8600 0241
2010 Insight
-
+
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system)F
eatures
237
AUDIO BUTTON
USB ICON
SKIP BUTTON
SKIP BUTTON
JOYSTICK
POWER/VOLUME KNOB
CD/AUX BUTTON
SCAN BUTTON
REPEAT BUTTON
RANDOM BUTTON
TUNE FOLDERBAR
WMA/MP3 INDICATOR
08/12/27 11:56:43 31TM8600 0242
2010 Insight
*
*
This audio system can operate theaudio files on a USB flash memorydevice with the same controls usedfor the in-dash disc player. To play aUSB flash memory device, connect itto the USB adapter cable in theconsole compartment, then press theCD/AUX button.
The audio system reads and playsthe audio files on the USB flashmemory device in MP3, WMA orAAC formats. Depending on theformat, the display shows MP3,WMA or AAC when a USB flashmemory device is playing. The USBflash memory device limit is up to700 folders or up to 65535 files.
Only AAC format files recordedwith iTunes are playable on thisaudio unit.
The recommended USB flashmemory devices are 256 MB orhigher. Some digital audio playersmay be compatible as well.
Some USB flash memory devices(such as devices with security lock-out features, etc.) will not work inthis audio unit.
Do not use a device such as a cardreader or hard drive as the deviceor your files may be damaged.
Do not connect your USB flashmemory device using a hub.
Do not use an extension cable tothe USB adapter cable equippedwith your vehicle.
Do not keep a USB flash memorydevice in the vehicle. Directsunlight and high heat will damageit.
We recommend backing up yourdata before playing a USB flashmemory device.
Depending on the type andnumber of files, it may take sometime before they begin to play.
Depending on the software thefiles were made with, it may not bepossible to play some files, ordisplay some text data.
:
To Play a USB Flash MemoryDevice
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system)
238
NOTE:
08/12/27 11:56:53 31TM8600 0243
2010 Insight
--
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
CONTINUED
The specifications for compatibleMP3 files are:
Sampling frequency:32/44.1/48 kHz (MPEG1)16/22.05/24 kHz (MPEG2)
The specifications for compatibleWMA files are:
Bitrate:32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/160/192/224/256/320/VBR kbps(MPEG1)8/16/24/32/40/48/56/64/80/96/112/128/144/160/VBR kbps(MPEG2)
Maximum layers: 8
Partition:Top partition only
Bitrate:48 320/VBR kbps (Max 384)
Maximum layers: 8
Sampling frequency:32/44.1/48 kHz
Supported standards:WMA version 7/8/9Partition:Top partition only
The specifications for compatibleAAC files are:
Bitrate:8 320 kbpsSupported standards:MPEG4/AAC LCMPEG2/AAC LC
Maximum layers: 8
Sampling frequency:8/11.025/12/16/22.05/24/32/44.1/48 kHz
Partition:Top partition only
Supported standards:MPEG1 Audio Layer3MPEG2 Audio LSF Layer3
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system)F
eatures
239
08/12/27 11:57:07 31TM8600 0244
2010 Insight
Some versions of MP3, WMA, orAAC format may not be supported. Ifan unsupported file is found, theaudio unit displays UNSUPPORTED,then skips to the next file.
Unclip the USB connector bypivoting it, and pull out the USBadapter cable in the consolecompartment.
In WMA or AAC format, DRM(digital rights management) filescannot be played. If the system findsa DRM file, the audio unit displaysUNPLAYABLE FILE, and then skipsto the next file.
Connect the USB flash memorydevice to the USB connectorcorrectly and securely.
When the USB flash memory deviceis connected and the USB mode isselected on the audio system, theWMA or MP3 indicator is shown onthe navigation screen. It also showsthe folder and file numbers, and theelapsed time on the screen.
1. 2.
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system)
Connecting a USB Flash MemoryDevice
240
USB CONNECTOR
USB ADAPTER CABLE
USB CONNECTOR
08/12/27 11:57:14 31TM8600 0245
2010 Insight
-+
-
-
▲▼
▲ ▼
CONTINUED
Use the SKIP button while a USBflash memory device is playing tochange files.
Each time you press theSKIP button (Preset 6), thesystem skips forward to thebeginning of the next file. Press theSKIP button (Preset 5), to skipbackward to the beginning of thecurrent file. Press it again to skip tothe beginning of the previous file.
Toselect a different folder, press eitherside of the TUNE FOLDER bar.Press the side to skip to the nextfolder, and press the side to skipto the beginning of the previousfolder.
You can also select a file directlyfrom a track list on the audio display.Press the AUDIO button to show theaudio display, then touch the TrackList icon. The track list menuappears on the display.
To scroll through the display, touchthe or icon on the side of thescreen. To go back to the previousdisplay, touch the Return icon.
To play a file, touch its icon on thescreen. The current folder ishighlighted in blue.
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system)
To Change or Select Files Using a Track List
SKIP
FOLDER SELECTION
Features
241
TRACK LIST ICON
FOLDER ICON
RETURN ICON
08/12/27 11:57:24 31TM8600 0246
2010 Insight
- -
You can select any type of repeat,random and scan modes by using theRPT button or RDM button, orSCAN button.
This featurecontinuously plays a file. To activatethe track repeat feature, press theRPT button (Preset 1). You will see‘‘TRACK REPEAT’’ in the display.To turn it off, press the RPT button(Preset 1).
This featurereplays all the files in the selectedfolder in the order they are stored.To activate the folder repeat feature,press and hold the RPT button(Preset 1). You will see ‘‘FOLDERREPEAT’’ in the display. To turn itoff, press and hold the RPT button(Preset 1).
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system)
To Select Repeat, Random or ScanMode:
TRACK REPEAT FOLDER REPEAT
242
08/12/27 11:57:29 31TM8600 0247
2010 Insight
- - -This featureplays all the files in random order.To activate the track random feature,press the RDM button (Preset 2).You will see ‘‘TRACK RANDOM’’ inthe display. To turn it off, press theRDM button (Preset 2).
Thisfeature plays the files in the selectedfolder in random order. To activatethe folder random feature, press andhold the RDM button (Preset 2). Youwill see ‘‘FOLDER RANDOM’’ in thedisplay. To turn it off, press and holdthe RDM button (Preset 2).
This featuresamples all files in the selectedfolder in the order they are stored.To activate the scan feature, pressthe SCAN button. You will see‘‘TRACK SCAN’’ in the display. Youwill also see the file number blinking.You will get a 10 second sampling ofeach file in the folder. Press theSCAN button to get out of the scanmode. The system plays the last filesampled.
CONTINUED
TRACK RANDOM FOLDER RANDOM TRACK SCAN
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system)F
eatures
243
08/12/27 11:57:33 31TM8600 0248
2010 Insight
-
To play the radio when a USB flashmemory device is playing, press theFM/AM button or touch the FM1,FM2, or AM icon. If a disc is in theaudio unit, press the CD/AUXbutton or touch the CD icon to playthe disc. If a PC card is in the audiounit, Press the CD/AUX button ortouch the CARD icon to play a PCcard.
Press the CD/AUX button again ortouch the AUX icon to switch back tothe USB flash memory device.
You can disconnect the USB flashmemory device at any time even ifthe USB mode is selected on theaudio system. Always follow the USBflash memory device’s instructionswhen you remove it.
When you disconnect the USB flashmemory device while it is playing,the navigation screen shows ‘‘NODATA.’’
If you reconnect the same USB flashmemory device, the system willbegin playing where it left off.
If you see an error message on thescreen, see page .
This featuresamples the first file in each folder inthe order they are stored. Toactivate the folder scan feature,press and hold the SCAN button.You will see ‘‘FOLDER SCAN’’ in thedisplay. You will also see the foldernumber blinking. You will get a 10second sampling of the first file ineach folder. Press the SCAN buttonto get out of the scan mode. Thesystem plays the last file sampled.
245
To Stop Playing a USB FlashMemory Device
USB Flash Memory Device ErrorMessages
FOLDER SCAN Disconnecting a USB Flash MemoryDevice
Playing a USB Flash Memory Device (Models with navigation system)
244
08/12/27 11:57:42 31TM8600 0249
2010 Insight
If you see an error message on thescreen while playing a USB flashmemory device, find the solution inthe chart to the right. If you cannotclear the error message, take yourvehicle to your dealer.
Error Message Solution
The system cannot read the file(s). Check the files in the USB flashmemory device. There is a possibility that the files have been damaged.Appears when an unsupported USB flash memory device is connected.There is no music information.
USB Flash Memory Device Error Messages (Models with navigation system)F
eatures
245
UNPLAYABLE FILE
UNSUPPORTEDNO SONG
08/12/27 11:57:46 31TM8600 0250
2010 Insight
The radio can receive the completeAM and FM bands.Those bands cover these frequen-cies:
AM band: 530 to 1,710 kHzFM band: 87.7 to 107.9 MHz
How well the radio receives stationsis dependent on many factors, suchas the distance from the station’stransmitter, nearby large objects,and atmospheric conditions.
Driving very near the transmitter ofa station that is broadcasting on afrequency close to the frequency ofthe station you are listening to canalso affect your radio’s reception.You may temporarily hear bothstations, or hear only the station youare close to.
A radio station’s signal gets weakeras you get farther away from itstransmitter. If you are listening to anAM station, you will notice the soundvolume becoming weaker, and thestation drifting in and out. If you arelistening to an FM station, you willsee the stereo indicator flickering offand on as the signal weakens.Eventually, the stereo indicator willgo off and the sound will fadecompletely as you get out of range ofthe station’s signal.
Radio stations on the AM band areassigned frequencies at least 10 kHzapart (530, 540, 550). Stations on theFM band are assigned frequencies atleast 0.2 MHz apart (87.9, 88.1, 88.3).
Stations must use these exactfrequencies. It is fairly common forstations to round-off the frequency intheir advertising, so your radio coulddisplay a frequency of 100.9 eventhough the announcer may identifythe station as ‘‘FM101.’’
Radio Frequencies Radio Reception
AM/FM Radio Reception
246
08/12/27 11:57:54 31TM8600 0251
2010 Insight
Radio signals, especially on the FMband, are deflected by large objectssuch as buildings and hills. Yourradio then receives both the directsignal from the station’s transmitter,and the deflected signal. This causesthe sound to distort or flutter. This isa main cause of poor radio receptionin city driving.
Radio reception can be affected byatmospheric conditions such asthunderstorms, high humidity, andeven sunspots. You may be able toreceive a distant radio station oneday and not receive it the next daybecause of a change in conditions.
Electrical interference from passingvehicles and stationary sources cancause temporary reception problems.
As required by the FCC:Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
AM/FM Radio ReceptionF
eatures
247
08/12/27 11:58:00 31TM8600 0252
2010 Insight
When a disc is not being played,store it in its case to protect it fromdust and other contamination. Toprevent warpage, keep discs out ofdirect sunlight and extreme heat.
To clean a disc, use a clean soft cloth.Wipe across the disc from the centerto the outside edge.
A new disc may be rough on theinner and outer edges. The smallplastic pieces causing this roughnesscan flake off and fall on therecording surface of the disc,causing skipping or other problems.Remove these pieces by rubbing theinner and outer edges with the sideof a pencil or pen.
Handle a disc by its edges; nevertouch either surface. Do not placestabilizer rings or labels on the disc.These, along with contaminationfrom finger prints, liquids, and felt-tip pens, can cause the disc to notplay properly, or possibly jam in thedrive.
When recording a CD-R orCD-RW, the recording must beclosed for it to be used by thesystem.
When using CD-R or CD-RW discs,use only high quality discs labeledfor audio use.
Never try to insert foreign objects inthe disc player.
Handle your discs properly toprevent damage and skipping.
Play only standard round discs.Odd-shaped discs may jam in thedrive or cause other problems.
General Information Protecting Discs
Protecting Your Discs
248
Do not use discs with adhesive labels.The label can curl up and cause thedisc to jam in the unit.
08/12/27 11:58:10 31TM8600 0253
2010 Insight
The in-dash disc player/changer hasa sophisticated and delicatemechanism. If you insert a damageddisc as indicated in this section, itmay become stuck inside anddamage the audio unit.
Examples of these discs are shownto the right:
Bubbled, wrinkled, labeled, and excessively thick discs
Damaged discs Poor quality discs
1.
2. 3.
CONTINUED
Additional Information onRecommended Discs
Protecting Your DiscsF
eatures
249
Sealed
Warped BurrsChipped/Cracked
With Label/Sticker
With PlasticRing
Using PrinterLabel Kit
Bubbled/Wrinkled
08/12/27 11:58:20 31TM8600 0254
2010 Insight
Small, irregular shaped discs Discs with scratches, dirty discs
CD-R or CD-RW may not play dueto the recording conditions.
Scratches and fingerprints on thediscs may cause the sound to skip.
Recommended discs are printedwith the following logo.
Audio unit may not play thefollowing formats.
4. 5.
Protecting Your Discs
250
Fingerprints, scratches, etc.
3-inch (8-cm) CD Triangle Shape
Arrow ShapeCan Shape
08/12/27 11:58:31 31TM8600 0255
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
+
-
+ -
+-
The VOL button adjusts the volumeup ( ) or down ( ). Press the topor bottom of the button and hold ituntil the desired volume is reached,then release it.
The MODE button changes themode. Pressing the buttonrepeatedly selects FM1, FM2, AM,disc or a PC card (if a disc or a PCcard is loaded), or an audio unitconnected to the auxiliary input jackor the USB adapter cable.
If you are listening to the radio, usethe CH button to change stations.Each time you press the top ( ) ofthe button, the system goes to thenext preset station on the band youare listening to. Press the bottom( ) to go back to the previousstation. If you press and hold the CHbutton ( ) or ( ), the system goesinto the seek mode. It finds a stationwith a strong signal.
If you are playing a disc, iPod or USBflash memory device, the systemskips to the beginning of the nexttrack (file in MP3, WMA or AACformat) each time you press the top( ) of the CH button. Press thebottom ( ) to return to thebeginning of the current track/file.Press it twice to return to theprevious track/file.
You will see the track/file numberand the elapsed time. If the disc hastext data or is compressed in MP3 orWMA, you can also see any otherinformation (track title, file name,folder name, etc.).
Three controls for the audio systemare mounted in the steering wheelhub. These let you control basicfunctions without removing yourhand from the wheel.
CONTINUED
On vehicles with navigation system
Remote Audio ControlsF
eatures
251
CH BUTTON
MODE BUTTONVOL BUTTON
08/12/27 11:58:39 31TM8600 0256
2010 Insight
+
-
+
-
In MP3 or WMA mode, you can usethe seek function to select folders.Press and hold the top ( ) of theCH button until you hear a beep toskip forward to the first file of thenext folder. Press the bottom ( ) toskip backward to the previous folder.
If you are playing a PC card, pressthe top ( ) of the CH button toadvance to the next file. Press thebottom ( ) to go back to theprevious file.
Your vehicle has the auxiliary inputjack on the front panel. The systemwill accept auxiliary input fromstandard audio accessories.
When a compatible audio unit isconnected to the jack, press the CD/AUX (on vehicles with navigationsystem) or AUX (on vehicles withoutnavigation system) button to select it.
Auxiliary Input Jack
Remote Audio Controls, Auxiliary Input Jack
252
On vehicles without navigation systemOn vehicles with navigation system
08/12/27 11:58:45 31TM8600 0257
2010 Insight
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, or theradio fuse is removed, the audiosystem will disable itself. If thishappens, you will see ‘‘ENTERCODE’’ in the frequency display thenext time you turn on the system.Use the preset buttons to enter thecode. On vehicles with navigationsystem, touch the icon to enter thecode number, then touch the Doneicon to set the code. The code is onthe radio code card included in yourowner’s manual kit. When it isentered correctly, the radio will startplaying.
Your vehicle’s audio system willdisable itself if it is disconnectedfrom electrical power for any reason.To make it work again, you mustenter a specific code using the presetbuttons (icon on vehicle’s withnavigation system). Because thereare hundreds of numbercombinations possible from specificdigits, making the system workwithout knowing the exact code isnearly impossible.
If you make a mistake entering thecode, do not start over; complete thesequence, then enter the correctcode. You have 10 tries to enter thecorrect code. If you are unsuccessfulin 10 attempts, you must then leavethe system on for 1 hour beforetrying again.
You should have received a card thatlists your audio system’s code andserial numbers. It is best to store thiscard in a safe place at home. Inaddition, you should write the audiosystem’s serial number in this owner’smanual.
If you lose the card, you must obtainthe code number from a dealer. Todo this, you will need the system’sserial number.
Radio Theft ProtectionF
eatures
253
08/12/27 11:58:51 31TM8600 0258
2010 Insight
The navigation system receivessignals from the global positioningsystem (GPS), and the displayedtime is updated automatically by theGPS. Refer to the navigation systemmanual for how to adjust the time.
For example:
Press and hold the FM/AM(CLOCK) button until the displayedtime begins to blink, then release thebutton. Change the hours bypressing the 1 (H) button until thenumbers advance to the desired time.Change the minutes by pressing the2 (M) button until the numbersadvance to the desired time.
Press the FM/AM (CLOCK) buttonagain to enter the set time.
You can quickly set the time to thenearest hour. If the displayed time isbefore the half hour, press the FM/AM (CLOCK) button until you heara beep, then press the 3 (R) buttonto set the clock back to the previoushour. If the displayed time is afterthe half hour, the clock sets forwardto the beginning of the next hour.
1:06 will reset to 1:001:53 will reset to 2:00
On vehicles without navigation system
On vehicles with navigation system
Setting the Clock
254
FM/AM (CLOCK)BUTTON
CLOCK
2 (M) BUTTON
1 (H) BUTTON 3 (R) BUTTON
08/12/27 11:58:58 31TM8600 0259
2010 Insight
The alarm will also be activated if apassenger inside the locked vehicleturns the ignition switch on.
Once the security system is set,opening any door, the hatch, or thehood without using the key or theremote transmitter, will cause thealarm to activate. It will also activateif the radio is removed from thedashboard or the wiring is cut.
The security system will not set ifthe hood, hatch, or any door is notfully closed. If the system will not set,check the door and hatch openindicator on the instrument paneland multi-information display (seepage ) to see if the doors andhatch are fully closed. Since it is notpart of the monitor display, manuallycheck the hood.
Do not attempt to alter this systemor add other devices to it.
To see if the system is setafter you exit the vehicle, press theLOCK button on the remotetransmitter within 5 seconds. If thesystem is set, the horn will beeponce.
The security system setsautomatically 15 seconds after youlock the doors, hood, and the hatch.For the system to activate, you mustlock the doors and the hatch fromthe outside with the key, driver’slock tab, door lock master switch, orremote transmitter. The securitysystem indicator on the instrumentpanel starts blinking immediately toshow you the system is setting itself.
The security system helps to protectyour vehicle and valuables from theft.The horn sounds and a combinationof headlights, parking lights, sidemarker lights and taillights flash ifsomeone attempts to break into yourvehicle or remove the audio unit.This alarm continues for 2 minutes,then the system resets. To reset anactivated system before the 2minutes have elapsed, unlock thedriver’s door with the key or use theremote transmitter.
12
Security SystemF
eatures
255
NOTE:SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR
08/12/27 11:59:05 31TM8600 0260
2010 Insight
Push the CRUISE button on thesteering wheel. The CRUISEMAIN indicator on the instrumentpanel comes on.
Accelerate to the desired cruisingspeed above 25 mph (40 km/h).
Press and release the SET/DECEL button on the steeringwheel. The CRUISE CONTROLindicator on the instrument panelcomes on to show the system isnow activated.
Cruise control allows you to maintaina set speed above 25 mph (40 km/h)without keeping your foot on theaccelerator pedal. It should be usedfor cruising on straight, openhighways. It is not recommended forcity driving, winding roads, slipperyroads, heavy rain, or bad weather.
Cruise control may not hold the setspeed when you are going up anddown hills. If your vehicle speedincreases going down a hill, use thebrakes to slow down. This will cancelthe cruise control. To resume the setspeed, press the RES/ACCEL button.The CRUISE CONTROL indicatoron the instrument panel will comeback on.
When climbing a steep hill, thetransmission speed may change tomaintain the set vehicle speed.
1.
2.
3.U.S. EX models and all Canadian models Using the Cruise Control
Cruise Control
256
CANCELBUTTON
CRUISE BUTTON RES/ACCELBUTTON
SET/DECELBUTTON
Improper use of the cruisecontrol can lead to a crash.
Use the cruise control onlywhen traveling on openhighways in good weather.
08/12/27 11:59:13 31TM8600 0261
2010 Insight
You can increase the set cruisingspeed in any of these ways:
Press and hold the RES/ACCELbutton. When you reach thedesired cruising speed, release thebutton.
To increase your speed in verysmall amounts, tap the RES/ACCEL button. Each time you dothis, the vehicle will speed upabout 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
Press and hold the SET/DECELbutton. Release the button whenyou reach the desired speed.
To slow down in very smallamounts, tap the SET/DECELbutton. Each time you do this,your vehicle will slow down about1 mph (1.6 km/h).
You can decrease the set cruisingspeed in any of these ways:
Even with the cruise control turnedon, you can still use the acceleratorpedal to speed up for passing. Aftercompleting the pass, take your footoff the accelerator pedal. The vehiclewill return to the set cruising speed.
Push on the accelerator pedal.Accelerate to the desired cruisingspeed, then press the SET/DECEL button.
Resting your foot on the brake pedalcauses cruise control to cancel.
Tap the brake pedal lightly withyour foot. The CRUISECONTROL indicator on theinstrument panel will go out.When the vehicle slows to thedesired speed, press the SET/DECEL button.
Changing the Set Speed
Cruise ControlF
eatures
257
08/12/27 11:59:22 31TM8600 0262
2010 Insight
You can cancel cruise control in anyof these ways:
Push the CANCEL button on thesteering wheel.
Push the CRUISE button on thesteering wheel.
Tap the brake pedal.
Pressing the CRUISE button turnsthe system off and erases theprevious cruising speed.
When you push the CANCEL button,or tap the brake pedal, the systemwill remember the previously-setcruising speed. To return to thatspeed, accelerate to above 25 mph(40 km/h) and then press andrelease the RES/ACCEL button. TheCRUISE CONTROL indicator comeson. The vehicle will accelerate to thesame cruising speed as before.
Tapping either of the paddle shiftersshifts the speed up or down, but doesnot cancel the cruise control. Formore information on driving withpaddle shifters, see page .316
EX models onlyCanceling Cruise Control Resuming the Set Speed
Cruise Control
258
CRUISE BUTTON
CANCELBUTTON
08/12/27 11:59:30 31TM8600 0263
2010 Insight
-
-
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink (HFL)allows you to place and receivephone calls using voice commands,without handling your cell phone.
Press andrelease to give a command or answera call.
Press andrelease to end a call, go back to theprevious command, or cancel thecommand.
To use HFL, you need a Bluetooth-compatible cell phone. For a list ofcompatible phones, pairingprocedures, and special featurecapabilities:
In the U.S., visitor call (888) 528-7876.
In Canada, visit or call(888) 9-HONDA-9.
handsfreelink.honda.com
www.honda.ca,
CONTINUED
On models with navigation systemHFL Buttons
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Using HFL
HFL Talk button
HFL Back button
Features
259
HFL BACK BUTTON
NAVI VOICECONTROLBUTTONS
HFL TALKBUTTON
08/12/27 11:59:39 31TM8600 0264
2010 Insight
Try to reduce all backgroundnoise. If the microphone picks upvoices other than yours,commands may be misinterpreted.
Many commands can be spokentogether. For example, you cansay ‘‘Call 123-456-7890’’ or ‘‘DialPeter.’’
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton each time you want tomake a command. After the beep,speak in a clear, natural tone.
When HFL is in use, navigationvoice commands cannot berecognized.
To change the volume level ofHFL, use the audio system volumeknob or the steering wheel volumecontrols.
Air or wind noise from thedashboard and side vents andwindows may interfere with themicrophone. Adjust or close themas necessary.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Voice Control Tips
260
MICROPHONE
08/12/27 11:59:46 31TM8600 0265
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
To hear general HFL information,including help on pairing a phoneor setting up the system, say‘‘Tutorial.’’
For help at any time, including alist of available commands, say‘‘Hands free help.’’
As an incoming call notification, youwill see the following display:
The Bluetooth icon will alsoappear on the audio display when aphone is linked.
Some phones may send battery,signal strength, and roaming statusinformation to HFL.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Help Features Information Display
Features
261
ROAM STATUS
HFLMODE
PHONE DIALING
BATTERY LEVELSTATUS
SIGNAL STRENGTH
08/12/27 11:59:54 31TM8600 0266
2010 Insight
A notification that there is anincoming call, or HFL is in use, willappear on the navigation screenwhen the audio system is on.
When there is an incoming call, orHFL is in use, ‘‘HFL’’ will appear atthe bottom of the map screen.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
262
HFL MESSAGE
08/12/27 11:59:59 31TM8600 0267
2010 Insight
####
CONTINUED
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
How to Use HFL
Features
263
‘‘Phone Setup’’
‘‘Call’’ or ‘‘Dial’’
‘‘Pair’’
‘‘Edit’’
‘‘Delete’’
‘‘Jim Smith’’
‘‘Set PairingCode’’
The ignition switch must be in the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position.
‘‘List’’
‘‘Status’’
‘‘Next Phone’’
Hear a list of all phones paired to the system (See page 267)
Delete a paired phone from the system (See page 267)
Edit the name of a paired phone (See page 267)
Pair a phone to the system (See page 266)
Hear which paired phone is currently linked to the system(See page 268)
Search for another previously paired phone to link to (See page 268)
Set the pairing code to a ‘‘Fixed’’ or ‘‘Random’’ number(See page 268)
Once a phonebook entry is stored, you can say a name here.(See page 269)
‘‘123-555- ’’ Enter desired phone number (See page 269)
Press HFLTalk button
Press and release the HFL Talk button each time you give a command.
08/12/27 12:00:07 31TM8600 0268
2010 Insight
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
264
‘‘Redial’’
‘‘Transfer’’
‘‘Mute’’
‘‘Send’’
‘‘Phonebook’’
‘‘Store’’
‘‘Edit’’
‘‘Delete’’
‘‘ReceiveContact’’
‘‘List’’
Transfer a call from HFL to your phone, or from your phone to HFL (See page 272)
Redial the last number called (See page 270)
Mute your voice to the person at the other end of the call (See page 272)
Send numbers or names during a call (See page 272)
Store a phonebook entry (See page 273)
Edit the name of an existing phonebook entry (See page 273)
Delete a phonebook entry (See page 274)
If your phone supports this function, use this to transfer contacts fromyour phone to HFL (See page 274)
Hear a list of all stored phonebook entries (See page 274)
Press HFLTalk button
Press and release the HFL Talk button each time you give a command.
08/12/27 12:00:12 31TM8600 0269
2010 Insight
*
*CONTINUED
Bluetooth HandsFreeLinkF
eatures
265
‘‘Change Language’’
‘‘Hands Free Help’’
‘‘SystemSet up’’
‘‘Tutorial’’
‘‘Clear’’
‘‘Auto Transfer’’
‘‘Call Notification’’
‘‘Security’’
‘‘Change Passcode’’
Hear a list of available commands and additional information describing each command(See page 261)
Hear a tutorial for general rules on using the system (See page 261)
Apply a security passcode to the system that must be input at each keycycle to access the system (See page 279)
Change your security passcode (See page 280)
Clear the system of all paired phones, phonebook entries and securitypasscode (See page 281)
Set how you would like to be notified of an incoming call(See page 280)
Press HFLTalk button
Press and release the HFL Talk button each time you give a command.
Set calls to automatically transfer from your phone to HFL when youenter the vehicle (See page 280)
Change language from English to French (See page 282)
: Canadian models
08/12/27 12:00:19 31TM8600 0270
2010 Insight
To use HFL, you need to pair yourBluetooth-compatible cell phone tothe system.
This command group is available forpaired cell phones.
You cannot pair your phone whilethe vehicle is moving.
Your phone must be in discoveryor search mode to pair. Refer toyour phone’s manual.
Up to six phones can be paired.
Your phone’s battery may drainfaster when it is paired to HFL.
If after three minutes your phoneis not ready to pair or a phone isnot found, the system will time outand return to idle.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton. If you are pairing a phonefor the first time, HFL will giveyou information about the pairingprocess. If it is not the first phoneyou are pairing, say ‘‘
’’ and say ‘‘ .’’
Follow the HFL prompts and putyour phone in discovery or searchmode. HFL will give you a 4-digitpairing code and begin searchingfor your phone.
When your phone finds aBluetooth device, select HFL fromthe options and enter the 4-digitcode from the previous step.
Follow the HFL prompts andname the newly paired phone.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Phone Setup
Phonesetup Pair
Phone pairing tips
To pair a cell phone:
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
266
08/12/27 12:00:30 31TM8600 0271
2010 Insight
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
If there is more than one phonepaired to the system, HFL will askyou which phone’s name you wantto change. Follow the HFLprompts and rename the phone.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
HFL will ask you which phone youwant to delete. Follow the HFLprompts to continue with thedeletion.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
HFL will read out all the pairedphone’s names.
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
Say ‘‘ .’’1.
2.
3. 3.
1.
2.1.
2.
3.
CONTINUED
Phone setup
Edit
Phone setup
DeleteList
Phone setup
To hear the names of all pairedphones:
To rename a paired phone: To delete a paired phone:
Bluetooth HandsFreeLinkF
eatures
267
08/12/27 12:00:41 31TM8600 0272
2010 Insight
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
HFL will tell you which phone islinked to the system.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’Say ‘‘ .’’
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ ’’ after theprompts.
HFL disconnects the linked phoneand searches for another pairedphone.
Once another phone is found, it islinked to the system. HFL willinform you which phone is nowlinked.
If no other phones are found orpaired, HFL will inform you that theoriginal phone is linked again.
Say ‘‘ ’’ after theprompts.
If you want HFL to create arandom code each time you pair aphone, say ‘‘ .’’ If you wantto choose your own 4-digit code tobe used each time, say ‘‘ ’’and follow the HFL prompts.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To hear which paired phone iscurrently linked:
To change from the currently linkedphone to another paired phone:
To change the pairing code setting:
Phone setup
Status
Phone setupPhone setup
Next phoneSet pairing code
Random
Fixed
268
08/12/27 12:00:54 31TM8600 0273
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
You can make calls using any phonenumber or a name in the HFLphonebook. You can also redial thelast number called.
The maximum range between yourphone and vehicle is 30 feet (10meters).
During a call, HFL allows you to talkup to 30 minutes after you removethe key from the ignition switch.However, this may weaken thevehicle’s battery.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ .’’
Follow the HFL prompts and saythe phone number you want to dial.
Follow the HFL prompts toconfirm the number and say‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ .’’
Once connected, you will hear theperson you called through the audiospeakers.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Follow the HFL prompts toconfirm the name and make thecall.
Follow the HFL prompts and saythe name stored in the HFLphonebook that you want to call.
Say ‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ .’’1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
3.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Making a Call
Call Dial
Call Dial
Call Dial
To make a call using a phonenumber:
To make a call using a name in theHFL phonebook:
Features
269
08/12/27 12:01:06 31TM8600 0274
2010 Insight
Select ‘‘.’’
Press the INFO button, then select‘‘ .’’
Select a phonebook you want tochoose a phone number from.
If the phonebook you select is PIN-protected, you will need to enter thePIN to access it. See page formore information.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton and say ‘‘ .’’
1.
2.
3.
277
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Search ImportedPhonebook
Cellular Phonebook
Redial
To redial the last number called byHFL:
To make a call from an importedphonebook:
270
08/12/27 12:01:14 31TM8600 0275
2010 Insight
Select the name. All the phonenumbers stored for that name willbe listed.
When you receive a call, an incomingcall notification (if activated) willplay and interrupt the audio systemif it is on.
Press the HFL Talk button to answerthe call, or the HFL Back button tohang up.
If your phone has Call Waiting, pressand release the HFL Talk button toput the original call on hold andanswer the incoming call.
To return to the original call, pressthe HFL Talk button again. If youdon’t want to answer the incomingcall, disregard it and continue withyour original call. If you want to hangup the original call and answer thenew call, press the HFL Back button.
To search for a specific name in thephonebook, enter the keyword foreither the first or last name.
To display all names in thephonebook, select the ‘‘ ’’ option.
If you choose ‘‘,’’ the phone
number will be stored in HFL, sothat you can call it using HFL’s nametag by voice.
Select the phone number, andHFL begins dialing.
4.
5.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Receiving a Call
ListStore in
HandsFreeLink
Call Waiting
Features
271
List ICON
08/12/27 12:01:24 31TM8600 0276
2010 Insight
#
You can transfer a call from HFL toyour phone, or from your phone toHFL.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton and say ‘‘ .’’
You can mute your voice to theperson you are talking to during acall.
HFL allows you to send numbers ornames during a call. This is usefulwhen you call a menu-driven phonesystem.To mute your voice during a call,
press and release the HFL Talkbutton and say ‘‘ .’’
To unmute your voice, press andrelease the HFL Talk button and say‘‘ ’’ again.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
To send a pound ( ), say‘‘pound.’’ To send a star (*), say ‘‘star.’’
Follow the HFL prompts to sendthe tones and continue the call.
Follow the HFL prompts and saythe name or number you want tosend.
Say ‘‘ .’’1.
2.
3.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Transferring a Call
Transfer
Muting a Call Send Numbers or Names Duringa Call
Mute
MuteSend
To send a name or number during acall:
272
NOTE:
08/12/27 12:01:35 31TM8600 0277
2010 Insight
You can store up to 50 names withtheir associated numbers on HFL.The numbers you store can be notonly phone numbers but other types,such as account numbers orpasswords, which can be sent duringa menu-driven call.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
Say a name you want to list as yourphonebook entry.
Say the number you want to storefor the name entry.
Follow the HFL prompts and say‘‘ ’’ to store the entry.
Avoid using duplicate nameentries.
Avoid using ‘‘home’’ as a nameentry.
It is easier for HFL to recognize amultisyllabic or longer name. Forexample, use ‘‘Peter’’ instead of‘‘Pete,’’ or ‘‘John Smith’’ instead of‘‘John.’’
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
Follow the HFL prompts and saythe name entry you want to edit.
When asked, say the new numberfor that name.
Follow the HFL prompts tocomplete the edit.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
CONTINUED
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To store a phonebook entry:
To edit the number stored in a name:
Phonebook
Store
Enter
NOTE:
Phonebook
Edit
Phonebook
Features
273
08/12/27 12:01:50 31TM8600 0278
2010 Insight
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
Say the name you want to deleteand follow the HFL prompts tocomplete the deletion.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
HFL begins reading the names inthe order they were stored.
If you hear a name you want to call,immediately press the HFL Talkbutton and say ‘‘ .’’
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Follow the HFL prompts, select anumber from your cell phone, andsend it to HFL.
Say ‘‘ ’’ after theprompts.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Follow the HFL prompts andname the number, or say‘‘ ’’ if it is not the numberyou want to store.
Follow the HFL prompts if youwant to store another number.
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.
2.
3.
5.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Phonebook
Delete
Phonebook
List
Call
Receive contact
Phonebook
Discard
To delete a name: To list all names in the phonebook: To store a specific phone numberfrom your cell phone directly to theHFL phonebook (available on somephones):
274
08/12/27 12:02:03 31TM8600 0279
2010 Insight
(available on some phones)
handsfreelink.honda.com
www.honda.ca,
If you selectfrom the navigation system
menu, you will see four HFL options.
In the U.S., visitor call (888) 528-7876.
In Canada, visit or call(888) 9-HONDA-9.
The entire phonebook data of thecell phone that is linked to HFL canbe imported to the navigation system.
Select ‘‘,’’ and HFL will begin
importing the phonebook. Select‘‘ ’’ after the import is completed.
Once a phonebook has beenimported, you can search the phonenumbers by the person’s name.
Select ‘‘,’’ and a list of imported
phonebooks will be displayed.
Select a phonebook from the list.
For a list of cell phones that arecompatible with this feature:
CONTINUED
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Cellular Phonebook Options
Cellular PhonebookOptions
Import CellularPhonebook
OK
Search CellularPhonebook
Import Cellular Phonebook: Search Imported Phonebook:
Features
275
IMPORTED PHONEBOOK
IMPORTED DATE
PIN ICON
08/12/27 12:02:16 31TM8600 0280
2010 Insight
Select a person from the list. Up tothree category icons are displayed inthe left side of the list:
Select the person’s number you wantto call, and press the HFL Talkbutton.
These category icons indicate howmany numbers are stored for thename. If a name has more than threecategory icons, ‘‘…’’ is displayed.
If the phonebook is PIN-protected,you will need to enter the 4-digit PINon the following screen.
To search for a specific name in thephonebook, enter the keyword foreither the first or last name.
To display all names in thephonebook, select the ‘‘ ’’ option.List
276
Preference
Home
Mobile
Work
Pager
Fax
Car
Voice
Other
List ICON
08/12/27 12:02:28 31TM8600 0281
2010 Insight
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Select ‘‘,’’ and a list of imported
phonebooks will be displayed.
After making a selection, thefollowing screen will appear.
Select ‘‘ ,’’ then ‘‘ ’’ to completethe deletion.
You can add, change, or remove aPIN number from any phonebook.
You can delete any importedphonebook.
Select a phonebook you want todelete. If the phonebook is PIN-protected, you will need to enter the4-digit PIN number.
If you have selected a phonebookwithout a PIN, you will see the abovedisplay.
Enter the new 4-digit PIN. You willhave to re-enter the PIN forconfirmation.
CONTINUED
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
Delete ImportedPhonebook
Yes OK
PIN NumberDelete Imported Phonebook:
To add a PIN:
Features
277
08/12/27 12:02:38 31TM8600 0282
2010 Insight
Select ‘‘ ,’’ then select‘‘ ’’ after you enterthe current PIN.
Enter the new 4-digit PIN number.You will be asked to re-enter the PINfor verification.
The display will change as shownabove.
Select the phonebook you want. Thedisplay will change as shown above.
Enter the current PIN for thisphonebook.
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To remove a PIN:To change the PIN to a new number:PIN number
Do not use PIN
278
08/12/27 12:02:45 31TM8600 0283
2010 Insight
This command group allows you tochange or customize HFL basicsettings.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’Say ‘‘ ’’after the prompts.Follow the HFL prompts and saythe 4-digit passcode you want toset.Follow the HFL prompts toconfirm the number.
Once a passcode is set, youwill need to enter it to use HFL eachtime you start the vehicle. If youforget the code, your dealer will haveto reset it for you, or you will have toclear the entire system (see page
).1.2.3.
4.
281
CONTINUED
System Setup
System setupSecurity
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To set a 4-digit passcode to lock theHFL system for security purposes:
Features
279
NOTE:
08/12/27 12:02:53 31TM8600 0284
2010 Insight
*
*
If you get into the vehicle while youare on the phone, the call can beautomatically transferred to HFLwith the ignition switch in theACCESSORY (I) position.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’Say ‘‘ ’’ after theprompts.HFL will let you know if autotransfer is on or off, depending onthe previous setting. Follow theHFL prompts to change thesetting.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’Say ‘‘ ’’ after theprompts.Follow the HFL prompts and saythe new 4-digit passcode.Follow the HFL prompts toconfirm the number.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’Say ‘‘ ’’ after theprompts.Follow the HFL prompts and say‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ .’’ Youcan also say ‘‘ ’’ for no audibleincoming call notification.
The default setting is a ring tone.
2.
3.
4.
1.2.
3.1.2.
3.
1.
:
System setupAuto transfer
System setupChange passcode
System setupCall notif ication
Ring tone PromptOff
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To change your security pass code: To select either a ring tone or aprompt as the incoming callnotif ication :
To activate or deactivate the autotransfer function:
280
08/12/27 12:03:05 31TM8600 0285
2010 Insight
This operation clears the passcodes,paired phones, all names in the HFLphonebook, and all importedphonebook data.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Say ‘‘ ’’ after the prompts.
Follow the HFL prompts tocontinue to complete the clearingprocedure.
You can also clear the system whenyou have forgotten the passcode andcannot access HFL. When HFL asksyou for the passcode, say ‘‘
.’’ Paired phones, all names inthe HFL phonebook and all importedphonebook data will be lost.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Follow the HFL prompts.
Say the language you want tochange to in that language.
1.
2.
3.
2.
1.
Canadian models only
System setup
Clear
Systemclear
Quick Language Selection
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To clear the system:
To quickly change the language:
Features
281
08/12/27 12:03:15 31TM8600 0286
2010 Insight
The Bluetooth name and logos areregistered trademarks owned byBluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use ofsuch marks by Honda Motor Co.,Ltd. is under license. Othertrademarks and trade names arethose of their respective owners.
Press and release the HFL Talkbutton before a command.
Say ‘‘ .’’
Follow the HFL prompts tochange the language to English orFrench.
If you have not named your pairedphone in the language you justselected, HFL will ask you to name itin the current language.
When French is your currentlyselected language, you can give voicecommands in French.
1.
2.
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
Canadian models onlyBluetooth Wireless TechnologyChange Language
Change language
Bluetooth HandsFreeLink
To change the system languagebetween English and French:
282
08/12/27 12:03:24 31TM8600 0287
2010 Insight
Before you begin driving yourvehicle, you should know whatgasoline to use and how to check thelevels of important fluids. You alsoneed to know how to properly storeluggage or packages. Theinformation in this section will helpyou. If you plan to add anyaccessories to your vehicle, pleaseread the information in this sectionfirst.
.............................Break-in Period . 284.................Fuel Recommendation . 284
.........Service Station Procedures . 285....................................Refueling . 285
.....Tighten Fuel Cap Message . 286Opening and Closing the
.......................................Hood . 287...................................Oil Check . 288
.............Engine Coolant Check . 289...............................Fuel Economy . 290
...Accessories and Modifications . 293.............................Carrying Cargo . 295
Before DrivingB
eforeD
riving
283
08/12/27 12:03:28 31TM8600 0288
2010 Insight
Help assure your vehicle’s futurereliability and performance by payingextra attention to how you driveduring the first 600 miles (1,000 km).During this period:
Avoid full-throttle starts and rapidacceleration.
You should also follow theserecommendations with anoverhauled or exchanged engine, orwhen the brakes are replaced.
Your vehicle is designed to operateon unleaded gasoline with a pumpoctane number of 87 or higher. Useof a lower octane gasoline can causea persistent, heavy metallic rappingnoise that can lead to engine damage.
Do not change the oil until thescheduled maintenance time.
Avoid hard braking for the first200 miles (300 km).
In addition, in order to maintain goodperformance, fuel economy, andemissions control, we stronglyrecommend, in areas where it isavailable, the use of gasoline thatdoes NOT contain manganese-basedfuel additives such as MMT.
We recommend using qualitygasolines containing detergentadditives that help prevent fuelsystem and engine deposits.
Use of gasoline with these additivesmay adversely affect performance,and cause the malfunction indicatorlamp on your instrument panel tocome on. If this happens, contact
your authorized dealer for service.
Some gasoline today is blended withoxygenates such as ethanol orMTBE. Your vehicle is designed tooperate on oxygenated gasolinecontaining up to 10% ethanol byvolume and up to 15% MTBE byvolume. Do not use gasolinecontaining methanol.
If you notice any undesirableoperating symptoms, try anotherservice station or switch to anotherbrand of gasoline.
For further important fuel-relatedinformation for your vehicle, orinformation on gasoline that does notcontain MMT, contact your dealer orvisit Owner Link at www.hondacars.com.
Break-in Period Fuel Recommendation
Break-in Period, Fuel Recommendation
284
08/12/27 12:03:38 31TM8600 0289
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
Stop filling the tank after the fuelnozzle automatically clicks off. Donot try to ‘‘top off’’ the tank. Thisleaves some room in the fuel tankfor the fuel to expand withtemperature changes.
Park with the driver’s side closestto the service station pump.
Remove the fuel fill cap slowly.You may hear a hissing sound aspressure inside the tank equalizes.The fuel fill cap is attached to thefuel filler with a tether. Place thecap in the holder on the fuel filldoor.
even though the tank is not full,there may be a problem with yourvehicle’s fuel vapor recoverysystem. The system helps keepfuel vapor from going into theatmosphere. Try filling at anotherpump. If this does not fix theproblem, consult your dealer.
Push on the right edge of the fuelfill door and release it so that itpops open. Pull it out to open itfully.
1.
2.
3.
4.
If the fuel nozzle keeps clicking off
Service Station Procedures
Refueling
Before
Driving
285
Push
HOLDER FUEL FILL CAP
TETHER
FUEL FILL DOOR Gasoline is highly flammableand explosive. You can beburned or seriously injuredwhen handling fuel.
Stop the engine, and keepheat, sparks, and flame away.Handle fuel only outdoors.Wipe up spills immediately.
08/12/27 12:03:47 31TM8600 0290
2010 Insight
Push the fuel fill door closed untilit latches.
Screw the fuel fill cap back onuntil it clicks at least once. If youdo not properly tighten the cap,you will see a ‘‘TIGHTEN FUELCAP’’ message on the multi-information display. If the systemstill detects an evaporative systemleak after retightening the cap, themalfunction indicator lamp maycome on (see page ).
Your vehicle’s on board diagnosticsystem will detect a loose or missingfuel fill cap as an evaporative systemleak. The first time a leak is detecteda ‘‘TIGHTEN FUEL CAP’’ messageappears on the multi-informationdisplay.
Turn the engine off, and confirm thefuel fill cap is installed. If it is, loosenit, then retighten it until it clicks atleast once. The message should gooff after several days of normaldriving once you tighten or replacethe fuel fill cap. To scroll to anothermessage, press the INFO button.
The ‘‘TIGHTEN FUEL CAP’’message will appear each time yourestart the engine until the systemturns the message off.
5.
6.
403
Service Station Procedures
Tighten Fuel Cap Message
286
08/12/27 12:03:54 31TM8600 0291
2010 Insight
Park the vehicle, and set theparking brake. Pull the hoodrelease handle located under thelower left corner of the dashboard.The hood will pop up slightly.
If the system still detects a leak inthe vehicle’s evaporative emissionssystem, the malfunction indicatorlamp (MIL) comes on. If the fuel fillcap was not already tightened, turnthe engine off, and check orretighten the fuel fill cap until itclicks at least once. The MIL shouldgo off after several days of normaldriving once the cap is tightened orreplaced. If the MIL does not go off,have your vehicle inspected by adealer. For more information, seepage .
If the hood latch handle movesstiffly, or if you can open the hoodwithout lifting the handle, themechanism should be cleaned andlubricated.
Put your fingers under the frontedge of the hood near the center.Slide your hand to the left untilyou feel the hood latch handle.Push this handle to the left torelease the hood. Lift up the hood.
1. 2.403
CONTINUED
Opening and Closing the Hood
Service Station ProceduresB
eforeD
riving
287
LATCHHOOD RELEASE HANDLE
Pull
08/12/27 12:04:01 31TM8600 0292
2010 Insight
Insert the dipstick all the way backinto its hole.
Wipe off the dipstick with a cleancloth or paper towel.
Remove the dipstick (orange loop).
Wait a few minutes after turning theengine off before you check the oil.
To close the hood, lift it up slightly toremove the support rod from thehole. Put the support rod back intoits holding clip. Lower the hood toabout a foot (30 cm) above thefender, then let it drop. Make sure itis securely latched.
Holding the grip, pull the supportrod out of its clip. Insert the endinto the designated hole in thehood.
2.
3.
1.
3.
Oil Check
Service Station Procedures
288
DIPSTICK
SUPPORT ROD CLIP
GRIP
08/12/27 12:04:10 31TM8600 0293
2010 Insight
Refer toon page for information
about checking other items on yourvehicle.
Look at the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. Make sure it isbetween the MAX and MIN lines. Ifit is below the MIN line, see
on page forinformation on adding the propercoolant.
Remove the dipstick again, andcheck the level. It should bebetween the upper and lowermarks.
If it is near or below the lower mark,see on page .
4.
348
353
345Owner’s Maintenance
ChecksEngine Coolant Check
AddingEngine Coolant
Adding Engine Oil
Service Station ProceduresB
eforeD
riving
289
MAX
MIN
LOWER MARK
UPPER MARK
RESERVE TANK
08/12/27 12:04:17 31TM8600 0294
2010 Insight
-
-
-
-
Fuel economy is not a fixed number.It varies based on driving conditions,driving habits and vehicle condition.Therefore, it is not possible for oneset of estimates to predict fueleconomy precisely for all drivers inall environments.
The EPA fuel economy estimatesshown in the example to the rightare a useful tool for comparisonwhen buying a vehicle. EPAestimates include:
Represents a combination of city andhighway driving. The scalerepresents the range of combinedfuel economy for other vehicles inthe class.
Represents amixture of rural and interstatedriving, in a warmed-up vehicle,typical of longer trips in free-flowingtraffic. A range of miles per gallon
achieved is also provided.
Represents urbandriving in light traffic. A range ofmiles per gallon achieved is alsoprovided.
Provides an estimated annual fuelcost, based on 15,000 miles in theU.S. or 20,000 km in Canada per year
multiplied by the cost per gallon(based on EPA fuel cost data)divided by the combined fueleconomy.
For more information on fueleconomy ratings and factors thataffect fuel economy, visit
(Canada: Visit)
www.fueleconomy.gov www.vehicles.gc.ca
Actual Mileage and EPA FuelEconomy Estimates Comparison.
Combined Fuel Economy
Highway MPG
City MPG
Estimated Annual Fuel Cost
Fuel Economy
290
Combined FuelEconomy
(Sample U.S. EPA label shown)
Estimated AnnualFuel Cost
City MPG Highway MPG
08/12/27 12:04:26 31TM8600 0295
2010 Insight
-
--
-
- -
Aggressive driving (hardacceleration and braking)Excessive idling, accelerating andbraking in stop-and-go trafficCold engine operation (enginesare more efficient when warmedup)Driving with a heavy load or theair conditioner runningImproperly inflated tires
The following factors can lower yourvehicle’s fuel economy:
A properly maintained vehiclemaximizes fuel economy. Poormaintenance can significantly reducefuel economy. Always maintain yourvehicle according to the maintenancemessages displayed on the multi-information display (see
on page ).For example:
Rapidacceleration, abrupt cornering,and hard braking increase fuelconsumption.
Aerodynamic drag has a big effecton fuel economy at speeds above45 mph (75 km/h). Reduce yourspeed and you reduce the drag.Trailers, car top carriers, roofracks and bike racks are also bigcontributors to increased drag.
An underinflated tire increases‘‘rolling resistance,’’ which reducesfuel economy.
It puts a heavierload on the engine, increasing fuelconsumption.
Inparticular, a build-up of snow ormud on your vehicle’s undersideadds weight and rolling resistance.Frequent cleaning helps your fueleconomy.
Idlingresults in 0 miles per gallon (0 kmsper liter).
Use the ECON ON mode as muchas possible.
345CONTINUED
Fuel Economy Factors Use the recommended viscositymotor oil, displaying the APICertif ication Seal (see page
).
Improving Fuel Economy
Owner’sMaintenance Checks
Drive moderately
Observe the speed limitMaintain proper tire inflation
Avoid carrying excess weight inyour vehicle
Keep your vehicle clean Avoid excessive idling
348
Vehicle Maintenance
Drive Efficiently
Fuel EconomyB
eforeD
riving
291
08/12/27 12:04:38 31TM8600 0296
2010 Insight
-
-
Fill the fuel tank until the nozzle automatically clicks off.Reset trip counter to zero.Record the total gallons (liters) needed to refill.Follow one of the simple calculations above.
The A/Cputs an extra load on the enginewhich makes it use more fuel. Usethe fresh-air ventilation whenpossible.
Direct calculation is therecommended source of informationabout your actual fuel economy.Using frequency of fill-ups or takingfuel gauge readings are NOTaccurate measures of fuel economy.Fuel economy may improve over thefirst several thousand miles.
Combine several short trips intoone. A warmed-up engine is morefuel efficient than a cold one.
1)2)3)4)
Checking Your Fuel Economy
Measuring Techniques
Minimize the use of the airconditioning system
Calculating Fuel Economy
Plan and combine trips
Fuel Economy
292
Milesdriven
Gallonsof fuel
Miles perGallon
100 KilometersL per
100 kmLiter
08/12/27 12:04:47 31TM8600 0297
2010 Insight
Your dealer has Honda accessoriesthat allow you to personalize yourvehicle. These accessories havebeen designed and approved for yourvehicle, and are covered by warranty.
Before installing any accessory:Modifying your vehicle, or installingsome non-Honda accessories, canmake it unsafe. Before you make anymodifications or add any accessories,be sure to read the followinginformation.
Although non-Honda accessoriesmay fit on your vehicle, they may notmeet factory specifications, andcould adversely affect your vehicle’shandling and stability.
When properly installed, cellularphones, alarms, two-way radios, andlow-powered audio systems shouldnot interfere with your vehicle’scomputer controlled systems, suchas your airbags, anti-lock brakes, andtire pressure monitoring system (ifequipped).
Do not install accessories on theside pillars or across the rearwindows. Accessories installed inthese areas may interfere withproper operation of the sidecurtain airbags.
Before installing any electronicaccessory, have the installercontact your dealer for assistance.If possible, have your dealerinspect the final installation.
Be sure electronic accessories donot overload electrical circuits(see page ) or interfere withthe proper operation of yourvehicle.
Make sure the accessory does notobscure any lights, or interferewith proper vehicle operation orperformance.
405
Accessories
Accessories and ModificationsB
eforeD
riving
293
Improper accessories ormodifications can affect yourvehicle’s handling, stability, andperformance, and cause acrash in which you can be hurtor killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regardingaccessories and modifications.
08/12/27 12:04:56 31TM8600 0298
2010 Insight
*
*
Some examples are:
Removing parts from your vehicle,or replacing components withnon-Honda components couldseriously affect your vehicle’shandling, stability, and reliability.
If you plan to modify your vehicle,consult your dealer.
Modifying your steering wheel orany other part of your vehicle’ssafety features can make thesystems ineffective.
Larger or smaller wheels and tirescan interfere with the operation ofyour vehicle’s anti-lock brakes andother systems.
Non-Honda wheels, because theyare a universal design, can causeexcessive stress on suspensioncomponents and will not becompatible with the tire pressuremonitoring system (TPMS) .
Raising your vehicle with anon-Honda suspension kit canaffect the handling and stability.
Lowering your vehicle with anon-Honda suspension kit thatsignificantly reduces groundclearance can allow theundercarriage to hit speed bumpsor other raised objects, whichcould cause the airbags to deploy.
: U.S. models
Modifying Your Vehicle
Accessories and Modifications
294
08/12/27 12:05:03 31TM8600 0299
2010 Insight
*
*
*
*
*
*
**
**
Your vehicle has several convenientstorage areas:
Glove box
Seat-back pocketsDoor pockets
Cargo areaCoin pocketConsole compartmentCenter trayFloor storage compartmentUnder floor storages
However, carrying too much cargo,or improperly storing it, can affectyour vehicle’s handling, stability,stopping distance, and tires, andmake it unsafe. Before carrying anytype of cargo, be sure to read thefollowing pages.
2 :1 :
LX models onlyEX models only
1
2
1
Carrying CargoB
eforeD
riving
295
CENTER TRAY
CONSOLE COMPARTMENT
COIN POCKET
1 :LX models only2 :EX models only
SEAT-BACKPOCKETS
CARGO AREA
DOOR POCKETS
GLOVE BOX
FLOOR STORAGECOMPARTMENT
EX model is shown.
UNDER FLOORSTORAGES
1
2
1
08/12/27 12:05:14 31TM8600 0300
2010 Insight
- ×
-
The resulting figure equals theavailable amount of cargo andluggage load capacity. Forexample, if the ‘‘XXX’’ amountequals 1,400 lbs. and there will befive 150 lb. passengers in yourvehicle, the amount of availablecargo and luggage load capacity is650 lbs.(1,400 750 (5 150) = 650 lbs.)
Determine the combined weightof luggage and cargo being loadedon the vehicle. That weight maynot safely exceed the availablecargo and luggage load capacitycalculated in Step 4.
If your vehicle will be towing atrailer, load from your trailer willbe transferred to your vehicle.Consult this manual to determinehow this reduces the availablecargo and luggage load capacity ofyour vehicle.
Subtract the combined weight ofthe driver and passengers fromXXX kg or XXX lbs.
Locate the statement ‘‘Thecombined weight of occupants andcargo should never exceed XXXkg or XXX lbs.’’ on your vehicle’splacard.
Steps for Determining Correct LoadLimit
Determine the combined weightof the driver and passengers thatwill be riding in your vehicle.
The maximum load for your vehicleis 850 lbs (385 kg).
See Tire And Loading Informationlabel attached to the driver’sdoorjamb.
Label Example
This figure includes the total weightof all occupants, cargo, andaccessories, and the tongue load ifyou are towing a trailer.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(6)
(5)
(4)Load Limits
Carrying Cargo
296
Overloading or improperloading can affect handling andstability and cause a crash inwhich you can be hurt or killed.
Follow all load limits and otherloading guidelines in thismanual.
08/12/27 12:05:25 31TM8600 0301
2010 Insight
In addition, the total weight of thevehicle, all occupants, accessories,cargo, and trailer tongue load mustnot exceed the Gross VehicleWeight Rating (GVWR) or the GrossAxle Weight Rating (GAWR). Bothare on a label on the driver’sdoorjamb.
Example 1
Example 2
Example 3
Carrying CargoB
eforeD
riving
297
Max Load (850 lbs)
Max Load (850 lbs)
Max Load (850 lbs)
Cargo Weight(550 lbs)
Cargo Weight(250 lbs)
Cargo Weight(100 lbs)
Passenger Weight(150 lbs x 2 = 300 lbs)
Passenger Weight(150 lbs x 4 = 600 lbs)
Passenger Weight(150 lbs x 5 = 750 lbs)
08/12/27 12:05:31 31TM8600 0302
2010 Insight
Store or secure all items that couldbe thrown around and hurtsomeone during a crash.
Be sure items placed on the floorbehind the front seats cannot rollunder the seats and interfere withthe driver’s ability to operate thepedals, the operation of the seats,or the operation of the sensorsunder the seats.
Keep the glove box closed whiledriving. If it is open, a passengercould injure their knees during acrash or sudden stop.
Distribute cargo evenly on thefloor of the hatch, placing theheaviest items on the bottom andas far forward as possible.
Try to secure the items with ropeor cord so they will not shift whileyou are driving.
Do not place items on the cargoarea cover (if equipped), or stackobjects higher than the top of theback seat. They could block yourview and be thrown about thevehicle during a crash or suddenstop.
If you carry large items thatprevent you from closing thehatch, exhaust gas can enter thepassenger area. To avoid thepossibility of
, follow the instructionson page .
If you fold the rear seats down, tiedown items that could be thrownabout the vehicle during a crash orsudden stop. Keep all cargo belowthe bottom of the windows. If it ishigher, it could interfere withproper operation of the sidecurtain airbags.
Refer to page for folding rearseats.
56
142
Carrying Items in the PassengerCompartment
Carrying Cargo in the Cargo Area
carbon monoxidepoisoning
Carrying Cargo
298
08/12/27 12:05:40 31TM8600 0303
2010 Insight
Do not spill any liquids over the airintake or insert any foreign objectsin it. This may damage the IMAbattery and the power control unit.
The air intake for the IMA batteryand electronics is located on the rearleft pillar. Do not block this air intake,it may cause the IMA battery and thepower control unit to overheat,causing the IMA to shut down. It willstart working again after it cools.
Air Intake
Carrying CargoB
eforeD
riving
299
AIR INTAKE
08/12/27 12:05:45 31TM8600 0304
2010 Insight
300
08/12/27 12:05:47 31TM8600 0305
2010 Insight
This section gives you tips onstarting the engine under variousconditions, and how to operate theautomatic transmissions (CVT). Italso includes important informationon parking your vehicle, the brakingsystem, the vehicle stability assist(VSA ) system, and the tire pressuremonitoring system (TPMS).
........................Preparing to Drive . 302.......................Starting the Engine . 303
Ecological Drive Assist System............................(Eco Assist . 304
.Automatic Transmission (CVT) . 311Driving with the Paddle
.......................................Shifters . 316................................Auto Idle Stop . 321
...........................................Parking . 323.............................Braking System . 324
...............Anti-lock Brakes (ABS) . 326Tire Pressure Monitoring System
......................................(TPMS) . 328Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA ),
aka Electronic Stability........Control (ESC), System . 332
...........................Towing a Trailer . 334
DrivingD
riving
301
TM)
08/12/27 12:05:51 31TM8600 0306
2010 Insight
Make sure all windows, mirrors,and outside lights are clean andunobstructed. Remove frost, snow,or ice.
Check that any items you may becarrying are stored properly orfastened down securely.
Check the seat adjustment (seepage ).
Check the adjustment of theinside and outside mirrors (seepage ).
Check the steering wheeladjustment (see page ).
Make sure the doors are securelyclosed and locked.
Fasten your seat belt. Check thatyour passengers have fastenedtheir seat belts (see page ).
You should do the following checksand adjustments before you driveyour vehicle.
Visually check the tires. If a tirelooks low, use a gauge to check itspressure (see page ).
Check that the hood and hatch arefully closed.
When you start the engine, checkthe gauges and indicators in theinstrument panel, and themessages on the multi-informationdisplay (see pages , and
).
1.
2.
3.
8.
7.
6.
9.4.
5.
375
61 7275
17
138
144
125
10.
Preparing to Drive
302
08/12/27 12:06:00 31TM8600 0307
2010 Insight
Apply the parking brake.
In cold weather, turn off allelectrical accessories to reducethe drain on the battery.
In cold weather, the conventionalstarter is used instead of the IMAsystem starter. This is normal.
Make sure the shift lever is inPark. Press on the brake pedal.
Without touching the acceleratorpedal, turn the ignition key to theSTART (III) position. Do not holdthe key in the START (III)position for more than 15 secondsat a time. If the engine does notstart right away, pause for at least10 seconds before trying again.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Starting the Engine
Starting in Cold Weather
Driving
303
The engine is harder to start in coldweather. Also, the thinner air f ound ataltitudes above 8,000 f eet (2,400meters) adds to this problem.
The immobilizer system protects yourvehicle f rom thef t. If an improperlycoded key (or other device) is used, theengine’s f uel system is disabled. Formore inf ormation, see page .127
08/12/27 12:06:07 31TM8600 0308
2010 Insight
The multi-information display (seepage ).
Your vehicle’s fuel economy mayimprove more with the ECON modeon (see page ).
The driver feedback information isshown in two locations:
The ambient meter, locatedbehind the speedometer (see page
).
The system monitors your drivingstyle, and can display how it impactsyour vehicle’s fuel economy. You canthen make adjustments to yourdriving style to maximize fueleconomy. (For additionalinformation on fuel economy, seepage .)
Ecological Drive Assist System (EcoAssist ) is a driver feedback systemdesigned to help you develop andmaintain a fuel efficient driving style.
72290
75
124
Ecological Drive Assist System (Eco Assist )
304
ECO-drive Result
ECON BUTTON
ECO-guide feedback
ECON MODE INDICATORAmbient Meter
TM
TM
08/12/27 12:06:16 31TM8600 0309
2010 Insight
The Eco Drive Bar on the Eco guidefeedback display appears on themulti-information display while youdrive.
During acceleration, the barextends to the right of the centerline.
If the bar extends into theInefficient Driving Zones, yourcurrent driving style is notconducive to good fuel economy.
If the bar stays within the EfficientDriving Zones, your currentdriving style is conducive to goodfuel economy.
During deceleration, the barextends to the left of the centerline.
It is recommended to drive in the Dposition for better fuel efficiency.
CONTINUED
Driving Style Eco Drive BarSlow, steadyacceleration -maximizes fueleconomySlow deceleration -maximizes fueleconomyModerateacceleration
Moderatedeceleration
Aggressive/Inconsistentacceleration - lowersfuel economyAggressivedeceleration - lowersfuel economy
Eco Guide Feedback Eco Drive Bar Examples
Ecological Drive Assist System (Eco Assist )D
riving
305
ECODRIVEBAR
AccelerationMonitor
Inefficient Driving Zone
Center Position
DecelerationMonitor
Inefficient Braking Zone
Efficient Zones
ECO ELEMENTS
TM
08/12/27 12:06:29 31TM8600 0310
2010 Insight
The Ambient Meter (the lightbehind the speedometer) changescolor to show the effects of yourdriving style. This feature can beturned off (see page ).
Fuel EconomyMeter Background Color
103
Ambient Meter
Ecological Drive Assist System (Eco Assist )
306
AMBIENT METER
U.S. model is shown.
(Background Color)Green
Blue Green
Blue
High
Low
TM
08/12/27 12:06:37 31TM8600 0311
2010 Insight
-
CONTINUED
Eco assist scoring is displayed on themulti-information display in thefollowing ways:
A point system is used so you canmonitor your driving style and theimpact on fuel economy. Points are:
Accumulated when your drivingstyle is fuel efficientDeducted when your style is notfuel efficient
Your currenttrip is represented on the Eco Guidescreen, starting without any leaveson the plants. Leaves thenaccumulate during the current trip,as long as you maintain an economicdriving style.
Eco Assist Scoring
Real Time Score
Ecological Drive Assist System (Eco Assist )D
riving
307
FIRST STAGE THIRD STAGE
PLANT ICON
SECOND STAGE
Real Time Score
With the ignition switch in the ON (II) position
TM
08/12/27 12:06:46 31TM8600 0312
2010 Insight
-
-
The scorefrom your just completed trip isrepresented on the Eco Score screenby the ‘‘plant’’ icons.
Cumulative, orlifetime trips, which build up overtime, represented by a bar graph atthe bottom of the Eco Score display.
Each time you turn the ignitionswitch to the LOCK (0) position, theEco Score displays for a few secondsto show your current stage andlifetime points.
Drive Cycle Score
Lifetime Points
Ecological Drive Assist System (Eco Assist )
308
STAGE-UPRECOGNITIONICON
When turning off the ignition switch
TROPHY
DRIVE CYCLESCORE
LIFETIMEPOINTS
STAGE-DOWN RECOGNITION ICON
Drive Cycle Score/Lifetime Points
TM
08/12/27 12:06:52 31TM8600 0313
2010 Insight
There are three Eco stages, with fiveplants per stage. As you accumulatea specified number of leaves, youadvance from one stage to the next.The plant grows leaves from left toright, or loses them from right to left.A trophy icon appears once you havereached the maximum third stagescore.
Idle durationECON button usageVehicle speedBraking and accelerating
The scoring system for points isbased on:
Real time scores must accumulate over time to result in a stage change. In order to build lifetimepoints and advance to the next stage, you need to keep your efficient driving style every time youmake a trip. It can take several months to move from one stage to the next. Individual results willvary.
A total of two leaves can be put on each plant icon.
A total of four leaves can be added to each plant icon.
A circular shaped icon, which represents a blossom, can beadded on top of each plant icon with four leaves.
An icon appears once you have reached the maximum score foreach stage and are moving up to the next stage. These iconsappear briefly when the ignition switch is turned off.Once the 3rd stage maximum score is reached, the systemcontinues to monitor your driving. If you maintain a fuelefficient driving style, your score remains at the highest stage.If you drive less efficiently, points will be deducted and youmay drop (stage down) to the previous stage.
Stages/Displays and Icons Definition
Ecological Drive Assist System (Eco Assist )D
riving
309
First Stage
Second Stage
Third Stage
Maximum Score Icons
Second
Stage
First
Stage
Third
Stage
TM
08/12/27 12:07:03 31TM8600 0314
2010 Insight
*
*
The following procedure clears allleaves and your lifetime points. Thisprocedure must be followed exactly.
As you progress to a higher level, thesystem monitors your driving stylemore strictly. As a result, you mustfurther refine your driving style tocontinue to move up to the next level.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position. Confirm that the ECONmode is OFF. If it is OFF, proceed tostep 1. Do run the engine.
The following are some of theconditions that may effect yourscore:
Extremely high or low ambienttemperatureInconsistent acceleration use, suchas pumping the pedal repeatedlywithin a short period of timeFrequent use of the climatecontrol systemShort distance trips
If the ECON mode is on, press andrelease the ECON button to turn itoff. You also need to turn the ignitionswitch off.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position again. Do run theengine.
Press and release the brake pedalat least two times. The ambientmeter color changes from blue togreen .
Complete the following steps within30 seconds:
The ambient meter colorchanges only if the multi-information display’s metercolor change setting is on. (Seepage .)
Press and release the ECONbutton two times (ECON modecomes on, then goes off). Theambient meter color goes off, andthe accumulated data is cleared.
Turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position.
:
1.
2.
3.
103
Reset the System
not
not
Ecological Drive Assist System (Eco Assist )
310
TM
08/12/27 12:07:13 31TM8600 0315
2010 Insight
Honda’s Continuously VariableTransmission’s unique designprovides a smooth, constant flow ofpower. It is electronically controlledfor more precise operation andbetter fuel economy.
These indicators on the instrumentpanel show which position the shiftlever is in.
The ‘‘D’’ indicator comes on for afew seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. If it flashes while driving (inany shift position), it indicates apossible problem in the transmission.
If the malfunction indicator lampcomes on along with the ‘‘D’’indicator, there is a problem with theautomatic transmission controlsystem. Avoid rapid acceleration, andhave the transmission checked byyour dealer as soon as possible.When the ‘‘D’’ indicator warns of apossible problem with thetransmission, you will see a ‘‘CHECKTRANSMISSION’’ message on themulti-information display.
Continuously VariableTransmission (CVT)
Shift Lever Position Indicators
Automatic Transmission (CVT)D
riving
311
LX models Except LX models
08/12/27 12:07:21 31TM8600 0316
2010 Insight
To shift from Park to any position,press firmly on the brake pedal,press the release button on the frontof the shift lever, then pull the lever.You cannot shift out of Park whenthe ignition switch is in the LOCK(0) or the ACCESSORY (I) position.
Do this:Press the brake pedal andpress the release button.
Press the release button.
Move the lever.
To shift from:P to R
R to PN to RS to LL to SS to DD to ND to SN to DR to N
To shift from:
P to R
R to PN to RD to SS to DD to NN to DR to N
Do this:Press the brake pedal andpress the release button.
Press the release button.
Move the lever.
LX models Except LX modelsShifting
Automatic Transmission (CVT)
312
SHIFT LEVERRELEASE BUTTON
08/12/27 12:07:28 31TM8600 0317
2010 Insight
-
--
-
-
CONTINUED
Selecting Secondshifts the transmission into a lowerrange of ratios for betteracceleration and increased enginebraking. Use Second when you aregoing down a steep hill.
Use this position foryour normal driving. Thetransmission automatically adjusts tokeep the engine at the best speed fordriving conditions. To help theengine warm up faster, thetransmission will select ratios thatallow the engine to run at higherspeeds when it is cold.
Press the brakepedal and the release button on thefront of the shift lever to shift fromPark to reverse. To shift fromreverse to neutral, come to acomplete stop, and then shift. Pressthe release button before shiftinginto reverse from neutral.
Use Neutral if youneed to restart a stalled engine or ifit is necessary to stop briefly withthe engine idling. Always shift to thePark position if you need to leave thevehicle for any reason. Press on thebrake pedal when you are movingthe shift lever from Neutral toanother position.
This position mechani-cally locks the transmission. UsePark whenever you are turning off orstarting the engine. To shift out ofPark, you must press on the brakepedal and have your foot off theaccelerator pedal. Press the releasebutton on the front of the shift leverto move it.
If you have done all of the above andstill cannot move the lever out ofPark, see onpage .
You must also press the releasebutton to shift into Park. To avoidtransmission damage, come to acomplete stop before shifting intoPark. The shift lever must be in Parkbefore you can remove the key fromthe ignition switch.
315
LX models
Automatic Transmission (CVT)
Second (S)
Drive (D)Reverse (R)
Neutral (N)
Park (P)
Shift Lock Release
Driving
313
08/12/27 12:07:35 31TM8600 0318
2010 Insight
-- When the vehicle reaches themaximum speed in any shift position,you may feel the engine cut in andout. This is caused by a limiter (112mph, 180 km/h) in the engine’scomputer controls. The engine willrun normally when you reduce thespeed to below the maximum.
To shift into the Sposition, press the release button onthe front of the shift lever, and movethe lever to S. The S position issimilar to D, except the range ofratios are different for betteracceleration and increased enginebraking.
With the shift lever in D or S, youcan also use the paddle shifters toshift the transmission up or down.With the paddle shifters, you canoperate the transmission much like amanual transmission without aclutch pedal. For more informationon driving with the paddle shifters,see page .
To shift to Low, pressthe release button on the front of theshift lever. Use Low to get morepower when climbing, and formaximum engine braking whengoing down steep hills.
For faster acceleration when in D, Sor L, the transmission willautomatically ‘‘kick down’’ to a lowerrange of ratios by pushing theaccelerator pedal to the floor.
316
Except LX modelsLX models
Automatic Transmission (CVT)
Second (S)Low (L)Speed Limiter
314
08/12/27 12:07:41 31TM8600 0319
2010 Insight
If you need to use the shift lockrelease, it means your vehicle isdeveloping a problem. Have itchecked by your dealer.
Push down on the key while youpress the release button on theshift lever and move the shift leverout of Park to neutral.
Insert the key in the shift lockrelease slot.
This allows you to move the shiftlever out of Park if the normalmethod of pushing on the brakepedal and pressing the releasebutton does not work.
Remove the key from the shiftlock release slot, then reinstall thecover. Make sure the notch on thecover is on the left side. Insert thekey back into the ignition switch,press the brake pedal, and restartthe engine.
Put a cloth on the notch of theshift lock release slot cover. Usinga small flat-tipped screwdriver or ametal fingernail file, carefully pryon the notch of the cover toremove it.
Remove the key from the ignitionswitch.
Set the parking brake.1.
2.
3.4.
5.
6.
Shift Lock Release
Automatic Transmission (CVT)D
riving
315
SHIFT LOCKRELEASE SLOT
RELEASE BUTTON
COVER
08/12/27 12:07:50 31TM8600 0320
2010 Insight
+-
+-
To shift up or down, use the(right) or (left) paddle shifter oneither side of the steering wheel.
Pull the (right) paddle shifter toupshift. Pull (left) to downshift.
When you pull either paddle shifter,the shift indicator shows you theselected speed number.
Downshifting gives you more powerwhen climbing, and provides enginebraking when going down a steep hill.
When you are driving in the Dposition, pulling either paddle shifterswitches from the ordinaryautomatic transmission (CVT) to theD-paddle shift mode. You can shiftthe transmission up or down throughseven-stages manually with thepaddle shifters.
When the transmission returns toordinary automatic transmission(CVT), the displayed shift indicatordisappears.
Except LX models
Driving with the Paddle Shifters
Using the Paddle Shifters in theD position (D-Paddle Shift Mode)
316
SHIFT INDICATOR
08/12/27 12:07:58 31TM8600 0321
2010 Insight
+
-
CONTINUED
The transmission control systemmonitors the accelerator pedal useand your driving conditions. Whenyou press the accelerator pedal as inthe normal driving, the systemjudges that you are driving at aconstant cruising speed withoutusing the paddle shifters. Underthese conditions, D-paddle shiftmode is canceled, and thetransmission automatically returns toordinary automatic transmission(CVT).
When the transmission returns toordinary automatic transmission(CVT), the displayed shift indicatordisappears.
To cancel the D-paddle shift modemanually, pull and hold the sidepaddle shifter until the shift indicatorgoes out.
Downshifting with the (left)paddle shifter allows you to increasethe engine braking when going downsteep or long hills, and providesmore power when climbing uphills.You can upshift the transmissionmanually to reduce the rpm.
The transmission remains in theselected speed if you do notaccelerate.
Driving with the Paddle ShiftersD
riving
317
08/12/27 12:08:03 31TM8600 0322
2010 Insight
Each time you pull either paddleshifter, the transmission shifts onespeed up or down. If you want toshift up or down more than twospeeds, pull the paddle shifter twice,pause, and then pull it again.
The automatic transmission (CVT)will not allow you to change shift if:
The transmission downshifts to firstspeed and returns to ordinaryautomatic transmission (CVT) whenthe vehicle comes to a complete stopand the vehicle speed is about 6 mph(10 km/h).
If there is a problem in thetransmission while you are drivingwith the paddle shifters, the Dindicator flashes, the D-paddle shiftmode is canceled, and thetransmission returns to ordinaryautomatic transmission (CVT).
You downshift before the enginespeed reaches the highestthreshold of the lower speed.
If you try to do this, the shiftindicator will flash the number ofthe lower speed several times,then return to a higher speed.
You upshift before the enginespeed reaches the lowestthreshold of the higher speed.
You press both paddle shifters atthe same time.
You pull one of the two paddleshifters with another paddleshifter being pressed.
Driving with the Paddle Shifters
318
08/12/27 12:08:11 31TM8600 0323
2010 Insight
+-
-
With the shift lever in the S position,you can select the 7-Speed Manualshift mode to shift speeds; much likea manual transmission using thepaddle shifters, but without a clutchpedal.
To enter the 7-speed manual shiftmode, press the release button onthe side of the shift lever, move thelever to the S position, then pulleither paddle shifter. To cancel the7-speed manual shift mode andreturn to the ordinary automatictransmission (CVT), move the shiftlever from the S position. Whenmoving the shift lever, be careful notto operate incorrectly. While you aredriving in the 7-speed manual shiftmode, the transmission will notautomatically return to the ordinaryautomatic transmission (CVT).
When you move the shift lever fromthe ‘‘D’’ to ‘‘S’’ position and pulleither paddle shifter, the shiftindicator displays ‘‘M’’ along with theselected speed number.
To upshift, pull the (right) paddleshifter. To downshift, pull the(left) paddle shifter.
If you keep depressing theaccelerator pedal without pressingthe paddle shifter, the speed will beautomatically shifted up just beforethe tachometer’s red zone.
The transmission also shiftsautomatically as the vehicle comes toa complete stop. It downshifts to firstspeed when the vehicle speedreaches 6 mph (10 km/h) or less.
Downshifting with the (left)paddle shifter allows you to increasethe engine braking when going downsteep or long hills, and providesmore power when climbing uphills.You can upshift the transmissionmanually to reduce the rpm.
CONTINUED
Except LX models
Driving with the Paddle Shifters
Using the Paddle Shifters in the Sposition (7-Speed Manual ShiftMode)
Driving
319
SHIFT INDICATOR
‘‘M’’ INDICATOR
08/12/27 12:08:20 31TM8600 0324
2010 Insight
-
→
→
→
→
→
→
The automatic transmission (CVT)will not allow you to change shift if:
You downshift before the enginespeed reaches the highestthreshold of the lower speed.
If you try to do this, the shiftindicator will flash the number ofthe lower speed several times,then return to a higher speed.
You upshift before the enginespeed reaches the lowestthreshold of the higher speed.
You press both paddle shifters atthe same time.
You pull one of the two paddleshifters with another paddleshifter being pressed.
Drive in the highest speed numberthat lets the engine run andaccelerate smoothly. This will giveyou effective emissions control. Thefollowing shift points arerecommended:
To shift to Low,press and hold both paddle shifterssimultaneously until you see L in theshift indicator. Use Low to get morepower when climbing, and formaximum engine braking whengoing down steep hills.
Shift up
1 2
2 3
3 4
4 5
5 6
6 7
Normal acceleration
15 mph (24 km/h)
25 mph (40 km/h)
40 mph (64 km/h)
45 mph (72 km/h)
50 mph (81 km/h)
55 mph (89 km/h)
Driving with the Paddle Shifters
Recommended Shift Points L (Low) mode
320
08/12/27 12:08:28 31TM8600 0325
2010 Insight
The engine automatically stopswhen:
The vehicle comes to a stop with theshift lever in the D position and thebrake pedal pressed.
The engine will not stopautomatically under the followingconditions:
Vehicle speed does not go above 7mph (11 km/h) after starting theengine
The engine coolant temperature islow
The transmission fluidtemperature is low
The vehicle is stopped with theshift position in R, S, or L
When the vehicle is stopped on anincline
The climate control is in use andeither or is pressed
The engine may not stopautomatically under the followingconditions:
When the ECON button is on, theengine is more likely to stop. Seepage for the ECON button.
The vehicle is stopped by brakingsuddenly
The climate control system is inuse to dehumidify the moist airinside the vehicle
The ECON button is off, and thereis a significant difference betweenthe ambient temperature and thetemperature setting of the climatecontrol system
The IMA battery temperature isexcessively high or low
The IMA battery charge is low
The engine may also stop whenvehicle speed drops below 7 mph (11km/h) with the brake pedal pressed.
To help maximize fuel economy,your vehicle has an Auto Idle Stopfunction. Depending onenvironmental conditions and vehicleoperation, the engine will shut offwhen you come to a stop.
124
Auto Idle StopD
riving
321
08/12/27 12:08:41 31TM8600 0326
2010 Insight
The engine automatically restartswhen:
The brake pedal is released
Under the following conditions, theengine restarts even if the brakepedal is pressed:
The shift position is changed to Ror L
The accelerator pedal is pressed
The pressure to the brake pedal isreduced and the vehicle startsmoving while stopped on an incline
The IMA battery charge becomeslow
The engine coolant temperaturebecomes low
The pressure on the brake pedal isrepeatedly applied and releasedslightly during a stop
The ECON button is off, and thedifference between the ambienttemperature and the temperaturesetting of the climate controlsystem becomes significant
The climate control system startsto dehumidify the interior This indicator blinks when the Auto
Idle Stop system is in operation.If the driver’s door is opened whilethe indicator is blinking, the buzzersounds to notify that the Auto IdleStop system is in operation.
Auto Idle Stop
Auto Idle Stop Indicator
322
AUTO IDLE STOP INDICATOR
08/12/27 12:08:51 31TM8600 0327
2010 Insight
If the vehicle is facing downhill,turn the front wheels toward thecurb.
Make sure the parking brake isfully released before driving away.Driving with the parking brakepartially set can overheat ordamage the rear brakes.
Set the parking brake before you putthe transmission in Park. This keepsthe vehicle from moving and puttingpressure on the parking mechanismin the transmission.
Always use the parking brake whenyou park your vehicle. Make surethe parking brake is set firmly, oryour vehicle may roll if it is parkedon an incline.
If the vehicle is facing uphill, turnthe front wheels away from thecurb.
Never park over dry leaves, tallgrass, or other flammablematerials. The hot three waycatalytic converter could causethese materials to catch on fire.
Check the indicator on theinstrument panel to verify that thesecurity system is set.
Lock the doors.
Place any packages, valuables, etc.in the cargo area or take themwith you.
Turn off the lights.
Make sure the windows are closed.
Parking Tips
ParkingD
riving
323
08/12/27 12:08:59 31TM8600 0328
2010 Insight
Your vehicle is equipped with frontdisc brakes. The brakes on the rearwheels are drum. A power assisthelps reduce the effort needed onthe brake pedal. The ABS helps youretain steering control when brakingvery hard.
Resting your foot on the pedal keepsthe brakes applied lightly, builds upheat, reduces their effectiveness andreduces brake pad life. In addition,fuel economy can be reduced. It alsokeeps your brake lights on all thetime, confusing drivers behind you.
Check the brakes after drivingthrough deep water. Apply thebrakes moderately to see if they feelnormal. If not, apply them gently andfrequently until they do. Be extracautious in your driving.
Constant application of the brakeswhen going down a long hill buildsup heat and reduces theireffectiveness. Use the engine toassist the brakes by taking your footoff the accelerator and downshiftingto a lower speed.
Braking System
324
08/12/27 12:09:04 31TM8600 0329
2010 Insight
The hydraulic system that operatesthe brakes has two separate circuits.Each circuit works diagonally acrossthe vehicle (the left-front brake isconnected with the right-rear brake,etc.). If one circuit should develop aproblem, you will still have brakingat two wheels.
If the brake pads need replacing, youwill hear a distinctive, metallicscreeching sound when you applythe brake pedal. If you do not havethe brake pads replaced, they willscreech all the time. It is normal forthe brakes to occasionally squeal orsqueak when you apply them.
The following features are alsoequipped:
When you release the brake pedalwhile the Auto Idle Stop function isactivated, this feature keeps thebraking pressure until the enginestarts, and prevents the vehicle fromdropping back.
This feature helps you apply thebrakes with less force during anemergency braking situation.
Creep Aid System
Brake-Assist
Braking System Design Brake Pad Wear Indicators
Braking SystemD
riving
325
08/12/27 12:09:11 31TM8600 0330
2010 Insight
The anti-lock brake system (ABS)helps prevent the wheels fromlocking up, and helps you retainsteering control by pumping thebrakes rapidly, much faster than aperson can do it.
The electronic brake distribution(EBD) system, which is part of theABS, also balances the front-to-rearbraking distribution according tovehicle loading.
Let the ABS work for you by alwayskeeping firm, steady pressure on thebrake pedal. This is sometimesreferred to as ‘‘stomp and steer.’’
You will feel a pulsation in the brakepedal when the ABS activates, andyou may hear some noise. This isnormal: it is the ABS rapidlypumping the brakes. On drypavement, you will need to press onthe brake pedal very hard before theABS activates. However, you mayfeel the ABS activate immediately ifyou are trying to stop on snow or ice.
If this indicator comes on, the anti-lock function of the braking systemhas shut down. The brakes still worklike a conventional system, butwithout anti-lock. You should haveyour dealer inspect your vehicle assoon as possible.
When the ABS indicator comes on,you will also see a ‘‘CHECK ABSSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display.
If the ABS indicator comes on whiledriving, test the brakes as shown onpage .404
You should never pump the brake pedal.
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)
ABS Indicator
326
08/12/27 12:09:18 31TM8600 0331
2010 Insight
If the ABS indicator and the brakesystem indicator come on together,and the parking brake is fullyreleased, the EBD system may alsobe shut down.
Test your brakes as instructed onpage . If the brakes feel normal,drive slowly and have your vehiclerepaired by your dealer as soon aspossible. Avoid sudden hard brakingwhich could cause the rear wheels tolock up and possibly lead to a loss ofcontrol.
The VSA indicator will come onalong with the ABS indicator.
Always steer moderatelywhen you are braking hard. Severeor sharp steering wheel movementcan still cause your vehicle to veerinto oncoming traffic or off the road.
on loose oruneven surfaces, such as gravel orsnow, than a vehicle without anti-lock.
such as trying to take acorner too fast or making a suddenlane change. Always drive at a safespeed for the road and weatherconditions.
It only helps with steeringcontrol during braking.
404
Important Safety Reminders ABS cannot prevent a loss ofstability.
A vehicle with ABS may require alonger distance to stop
ABS will not prevent a skid thatresults from changing directionabruptly,
ABS does not reduce the time ordistance it takes to stop thevehicle.
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)D
riving
327
08/12/27 12:09:25 31TM8600 0332
2010 Insight
If you think you can safely drive ashort distance to a service station,proceed slowly to the station, theninflate the tire to the recommendedpressure.
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire tooverheat and can lead to tire failure.Under-inflation also reduces fuelefficiency and tire tread life, and mayaffect the vehicle’s handling andstopping ability.
Because tire pressure varies bytemperature and other conditions,the low tire pressure/TPMSindicator may come on unexpectedly.
If the tire is flat, or if the tirepressure is too low to continuedriving, replace the tire with thecompact spare tire (see page ).
When the low tire pressure/TPMSindicator is on, one or more of yourtires is significantly underinflated.You should stop and check your tiresas soon as possible, and inflate themto the proper pressure as indicatedon the vehicle’s tire informationplacard.
Your vehicle is equipped with a tirepressure monitoring system (TPMS)that turns on every time you start theengine and monitors the pressure inyour tires while driving.
Each tire has its own pressuresensor. If the air pressure of a tirebecomes significantly low, thesensor in that tire immediately sendsa signal that causes the low tirepressure/TPMS indicator in theinstrument panel to come on. If thishappens, you will see a ‘‘CHECKTIRE PRESSURE’’ message on themulti-information display.
If you cannot make the low tirepressure/TPMS indicator andmessage on the multi-informationdisplay go out after inflating the tiresto the specified values, have yourdealer check the system as soon aspossible.
386
U.S. models only Low Tire Pressure/TPMS Indicator
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
328
08/12/27 12:09:33 31TM8600 0333
2010 Insight
For example, if you check and fillyour tires in a warm area, then drivein extremely cold weather, the tirepressure will be lower thanmeasured and could be underinflatedand cause the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator to come on. Or, ifyou check and adjust your tirepressure in cooler conditions, anddrive into extremely hot conditions,the tires may become overinflated.However, the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator will not come on ifthe tires are overinflated.
Refer to page for tire inflationguidelines.
Although your tire pressure ismonitored, you must manually checkthe tire pressures monthly.
Each tire, including the spare, shouldbe checked monthly when thevehicle is cold, and set to therecommended inflation pressure asspecified on the vehicle placard andin the owner’s manual (see page
).
If there is a problem with the TPMS,you will see the above message onthe multi-information display.
If you see this message, the systemis off and is not monitoring the tirepressures. Have the system checkedby your dealer as soon as possible.
If there is a problem with the TPMS,this indicator begins to flash. It stopsflashing after approximately 1minute, then stays on. You will alsosee a ‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’message on the multi-informationdisplay (see TPMS System Failure).
375
376
CONTINUED
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
TPMS System Failure
Driving
329
08/12/27 12:09:41 31TM8600 0334
2010 Insight
This indicator and the warningmessage on the multi-informationdisplay will go off, after several miles(kilometers) driving, when the sparetire is replaced with the specifiedregular tire equipped with the tirepressure monitor sensor.
Each wheel is equipped with a tirepressure sensor mounted inside thetire behind the valve stem. You mustuse TPMS specific wheels. It isrecommended that you always haveyour tires serviced by your dealer ora qualified technician.
Also, the low tire pressure/TPMSindicator begins to flash, then stayson (see page ).
If the low tire pressure/TPMSindicator comes on, or the multi-information display shows a‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’ message,the VSA system automatically turnson even when the VSA system isturned off by pressing the VSA OFFswitch (see page ). If thishappens, you cannot turn the VSAsystem off by pressing the VSA OFFswitch again.
When you restart the vehicle withthe compact spare tire, the TPMSsystem message will also bedisplayed on the multi-informationdisplay after several miles(kilometers) driving.
If you have a flat tire, the low tirepressure/TPMS indicator will comeon. Replace the flat tire with thecompact spare tire (see page ).
After the flat tire is replaced with thespare tire, the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator stays on whiledriving. After several miles(kilometers) driving, this indicatorbegins to flash, then stays on again.You will also see a ‘‘CHECK TPMSSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display. This is normal;the system cannot monitor the sparetire pressure. Manually check thespare tire pressure to be sure it iscorrect.
328
333
387
Changing a Tire with TPMS
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
330
08/12/27 12:09:48 31TM8600 0335
2010 Insight
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
Never use a puncture-repairing agentin a flat tire. If used, you will have toreplace the tire pressure sensor.Have the flat tire repaired by yourdealer as soon as possible.
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)D
riving
331
08/12/27 12:09:53 31TM8600 0336
2010 Insight
The main function of theVSA system is generally known asElectronic Stability Control (ESC).The system also includes a tractioncontrol function.
The vehicle stability assist (VSA)system helps to stabilize the vehicleduring cornering if the vehicle turnsmore or less than desired. It alsoassists you in maintaining tractionwhile accelerating on loose orslippery road surfaces. It does thisby regulating the engine’s output andby selectively applying the brakes.
When VSA activates, you may noticethat the engine does not respond tothe accelerator in the same way itdoes at other times. There may alsobe some noise from the VSAhydraulic system. You will also seethe VSA activation indicator blink.
The VSA system cannot enhance thevehicle’s driving stability in allsituations and does not control yourvehicle’s entire braking system. It isstill your responsibility to drive andcorner at reasonable speeds and toleave a sufficient margin of safety.
If this indicator comes on whiledriving, pull to the side of the roadwhen it is safe, and turn off theengine. Reset the system byrestarting the engine. If the VSAsystem indicator stays on or comesback on while driving, have the VSAsystem inspected by your dealer.
When VSA is off, the VSA offindicator comes on as a reminder.
If the indicator does not come onwhen the ignition switch is turned tothe ON (II) position, there may be aproblem with the VSA system. Haveyour dealer inspect your vehicle assoon as possible.
When VSA activates, you will see theVSA system indicator blink.
If the low tire pressure/TPMSindicator comes on (see page ),or the multi-information displayshows a ‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’message with the indicator flashing(see page ), the VSA systemautomatically turns on even if theVSA system is turned off with theVSA OFF switch. In this case, youcannot turn the VSA system off bypressing the VSA OFF switch again.
Without VSA, your vehicle will havenormal braking and cornering ability,but it will not have VSA traction andstability enhancement.
329
328
On U.S. models
EX models only
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA ), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
Vehicle Stability Assist(VSA) System Indicator
VSA Off Indicator
332
NOTE:
08/12/27 12:10:03 31TM8600 0337
2010 Insight
Driving with varying tire or wheelsizes may cause the VSA tomalfunction. When replacing tires,make sure they are of the same sizeand type as your original tires (seepage ).
If you install winter tires, make surethey are the same size as those thatwere originally supplied with yourvehicle. Exercise the same cautionduring winter driving as you would ifyour vehicle was not equipped withVSA.This switch is under the driver’s side
vent. To turn the VSA system on andoff, press and hold it until you hear abeep.
When VSA is off, the VSA activationindicator comes on as a reminder.Press and hold the switch again. Itturns the system back on.
VSA is turned on every time youstart the engine, even if you turned itoff the last time you drove thevehicle.
In certain unusual conditions whenyour vehicle gets stuck in shallowmud or fresh snow, it may be easierto free it with the VSA temporarilyswitched off. When the VSA systemis off, the traction control system isalso off. You should only attempt tofree your vehicle with the VSA off ifyou are not able to free it when theVSA is on.
Immediately after freeing yourvehicle, be sure to switch the VSA onagain. We do not recommend drivingyour vehicle with the VSA andtraction control systems switched off.
379
VSA and Tire SizesVSA OFF Switch
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA ), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), SystemD
riving
333
VSA OFFSWITCH
08/12/27 12:10:11 31TM8600 0338
2010 Insight
Your vehicle is not designed to tow atrailer. Attempting to do so can voidyour warranties.
Towing a Trailer
334
08/12/27 12:10:14 31TM8600 0339
2010 Insight
If you have the skills and tools toperform more complex maintenancetasks on your vehicle, you may wantto purchase the service manual. Seepage for information on how toobtain a copy, or see your dealer.
This section explains why it isimportant to keep your vehicle wellmaintained and how to follow basicmaintenance safety precautions.
This section also includesinstructions on how to read themaintenance minder messages onthe multi-information display, andinstructions for simple maintenancetasks you may want to take care ofyourself.
......................Maintenance Safety . 336....................Maintenance Minder . 337
..............................Fluid Locations . 347........................Adding Engine Oil . 348
.........Changing the Oil and Filter . 350..............................Engine Coolant . 353
....................Windshield Washers . 355....Automatic Transmission Fluid . 356
Continuously Variable............Transmission (CVT) . 356
....................................Brake Fluid . 357.............................................Lights . 359
................................Roof Antenna . 369................Cleaning the Seat Belts . 369
.....................................Floor Mats . 369..................Dust and Pollen Filter . 370
.................................Wiper Blades . 370...............................................Tires . 375
......Checking the 12 Volt Battery . 381.............................Vehicle Storage . 383
MaintenanceM
aintenance
335
08/12/27 12:10:19 31TM8600 0340
2010 Insight
435
To eliminate potential hazards, readthe instructions before you begin,and make sure you have the toolsand skills required.
To clean parts, use a commerciallyavailable degreaser or partscleaner, not gasoline.
To reduce the possibility of fire orexplosion, keep cigarettes, sparks,and flames away from the batteryand all fuel-related parts.
Make sure your vehicle is parkedon level ground, the parking brakeis set, and the engine is off.
Some of the most important safetyprecautions are given here. However,we cannot warn you of everyconceivable hazard that can arise inperforming maintenance. Only youcan decide whether or not youshould perform a given task.
Donot run the engine unlessinstructed to do so.
Let theengine and exhaust system cooldown before touching any parts.
Wear eye protection andprotective clothing when workingwith the battery or compressed air.
All service items not detailed in thissection should be performed by acertified technician or qualifiedmechanic.
Be sure there isadequate ventilation whenever youoperate the engine.
Maintenance Safety
Important Safety PrecautionsInjury from moving parts.
Burns from hot parts.
Carbon Monoxide poison fromengine exhaust.
Potential Vehicle Hazards
336
Failure to properly followmaintenance instructions andprecautions can cause you tobe seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the proceduresand precautions in this owner’smanual.
Improperly maintaining thisvehicle, or failing to correct aproblem before driving cancause a crash in which you canbe seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the inspectionand maintenancerecommendations andschedules in this owner’smanual.
08/12/27 12:10:29 31TM8600 0341
2010 Insight
------------
The remaining engine oil life isshown on the display according tothis table:
Calculated EngineOil Life (%)
100% 91%90% 81%80% 71%70% 61%60% 51%50% 41%40% 31%30% 21%20% 16%15% 11%10% 6%5% 1%
0%
DisplayedEngine Oil Life
(%)100%90%80%70%60%50%40%30%20%15%10%5%0%
Your vehicle displays engine oil lifeand maintenance service items onthe multi-information display to showyou when you should have yourdealer perform engine oilreplacement and indicatedmaintenance service.
To see the current engine oil lifedisplayed on the multi-informationdisplay, turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, and press theSEL/RESET button on the steeringwheel repeatedly until the engine oillife is displayed.
Based on the engine operatingconditions, the onboard computer inyour vehicle calculates the remainingengine oil life and displays it as apercentage.
CONTINUED
Engine Oil Life Display
Maintenance MinderM
aintenance
337
ENGINE OIL LIFE DISPLAY
REMAINING ENGINE OIL LIFE
08/12/27 12:10:36 31TM8600 0342
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
When the remaining engine oil life is15 to 6 percent, the multi-informationdisplay shows a ‘‘SERVICE DUESOON’’ message along with themaintenance item code(s) indicatingthe main and sub items required atthe time of the oil change. Refer topage for a complete list of themaintenance main items and subitems.
Pressing either INFO button ( / )switches the display from themessage to another display. Onceyou switch the display, this messagewill go off.
Along with the message, the systemmessage indicator comes on (seepage ).
The message appears on the multi-information display each time youturn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
This message reminds you that yourvehicle will soon be due forscheduled maintenance.
Press the SEL/RESET button on thesteering wheel repeatedly to selectthe engine oil life information. Alongwith the ‘‘OIL LIFE’’ message, youwill see the percentage of theremaining engine oil life and themaintenance item codes on themulti-information display.346
70
Maintenance Minder
338
REMAINING ENGINEOIL LIFE
MAINTENANCE SUB ITEM CODE (S)
MAINTENANCE MAIN ITEM CODE (S)
SUB ITEM (S)
MAIN ITEM (S)
08/12/27 12:10:43 31TM8600 0343
2010 Insight
-
▲ ▼
When the remaining oil life is 5 to 1percent, the multi-informationdisplay shows a ‘‘SERVICE DUENOW’’ message with the samemaintenance items ‘‘SERVICE DUESOON’’ was displayed with. Whenyou see this message, have theindicated maintenance performed assoon as possible.
Press the SEL/RESET button on thesteering wheel repeatedly to selectthe engine oil life. The message‘‘SERVICE,’’ along with ‘‘5%,’’ and themaintenance item code are displayedon the multi-information displaywhen the calculated engine oil life is1 5 percent (see page ).
Pressing either INFO button ( / )switches the display from themessage to another display. Onceyou switch the display, this messagewill go off.
Along with the message, the systemmessage indicator comes on (seepage ).70
337
CONTINUED
Maintenance MinderM
aintenance
339
08/12/27 12:10:50 31TM8600 0344
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
-
If the indicated maintenance serviceis not done and the remaining engineoil life reaches 0%, the multi-information display will show themessage ‘‘SERVICE PAST DUE’’and the maintenance item code(s).This message is displayed when thetotal distance traveled is less than 10miles (for U.S. models) or 10 km (forCanadian models) after the engineoil life became 0%.
These messages will come on everytime you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position.
Immediately have the serviceperformed, and make sure to resetthe display as described on page .
Pressing either INFO button ( / )switches the display from themessage to another display. To seethe message again, press eitherINFO button repeatedly.
Press the SEL/RESET button on thesteering wheel repeatedly to selectthe engine oil life. The message‘‘SERVICE,’’ along with ‘‘0%,’’ and themaintenance item code are displayedon the multi-information displaywhen the calculated engine oil life is0 1 percent.
Along with the message, the systemmessage indicator comes on (seepage ).
342
70
Maintenance Minder
340
08/12/27 12:10:57 31TM8600 0345
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
If the indicated required service isnot done and the remaining engineoil life becomes 0%, the multi-information display will show a‘‘SERVICE PAST DUE’’ message,the total distance traveled after theremaining oil life became 0%, and themaintenance item code(s).
Immediately have the serviceperformed, and make sure to resetthe display as described on page .
Pressing either INFO button ( / )switches the display from themessage to another display. To seethe message again, press eitherINFO button repeatedly.
When you press the SEL/RESETbutton to select the engine oil life,the message ‘‘SERVICE,’’ along withthe maintenance item code(s) andthe total negative distance traveledafter the oil life became 0%, will bedisplayed on the multi-informationdisplay.
This message is displayed againwhen you drive over 10 miles (forU.S. models) or 10 km (for Canadianmodels) after seeing the 0% message.
342
Maintenance MinderM
aintenance
341
CANADAU.S.TOTAL PAST DUE MILEAGE
U.S. CANADA
TOTAL PAST DUE MILEAGEMAINTENANCE ITEM CODE (S)
08/12/27 12:11:04 31TM8600 0346
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
All the maintenance items displayedin the multi-information display arein code.
For an explanation of themaintenance codes, see page .
Your dealer will reset the displayafter completing the requiredmaintenance service. You will see‘‘OIL LIFE 100%’’ on the display thenext time you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position.
If maintenance service is done bysomeone other than your dealer,reset the maintenance minder asfollows:
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
If the engine oil life is notdisplayed, press the SEL/RESETbutton on the steering wheelrepeatedly.
Press and hold the SEL/RESETbutton on the steering wheel formore than 10 seconds. Theremaining engine oil life resetmode will be shown on the multi-information display.
1.2.
3.
346
Maintenance Main Items and SubItems
Resetting the Engine Oil LifeDisplay
Maintenance Minder
342
ENGINE OIL LIFEDISPLAY
MESSAGEDISPLAY
MAINTENANCESUB ITEMS
SEL/RESET BUTTON
INFO BUTTONS ( / )
MAINTENANCEMAIN ITEM
Models with cruise control
08/12/27 12:11:13 31TM8600 0347
2010 Insight
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
CONTINUED
If you have the required servicedone but do not reset the display, orreset the display without doing theservice, the system will not show thecorrect maintenance intervals. Thiscan lead to serious mechanicalproblems because you will no longerhave an accurate record of whenmaintenance is needed.
Select ‘‘RESET’’ by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then pressthe SEL/RESET button to resetthe engine oil life display. Themaintenance item code(s) willdisappear, and the engine oil lifewill reset to ‘‘100.’’ If you want tocancel the oil life reset mode,select ‘‘CANCEL.’’
4.
Maintenance Minder
Important MaintenancePrecautions
Maintenance
343
INFO BUTTON( / )
SEL/RESETBUTTON
Models without cruise control
08/12/27 12:11:19 31TM8600 0348
2010 Insight
We recommend using Honda partsand fluids whenever you havemaintenance done. These aremanufactured to the same highquality standards as the originalcomponents, so you can be confidentof their performance and durability.
However, service at a dealer is notmandatory to keep your warrantiesin effect. Maintenance may be doneby any qualified service facility orperson who is skilled in this type ofautomotive service. Make sure tohave the service facility or personreset the display as previouslydescribed. Keep all receipts as proofof completion, and have the personwho does the work fill out yourHonda Service History or CanadianMaintenance Log. Check yourwarranty booklet for moreinformation.
Your authorized Honda dealerknows your vehicle best and canprovide competent, efficient service.
Maintenance Minder
344
08/12/27 12:11:23 31TM8600 0349
2010 Insight
-
-
-
-
-
-You should check the followingitems at the specified intervals. Ifyou are unsure of how to performany check, turn to the appropriatepage listed.
Engine oil level Check everytime you fill the fuel tank. Seepage .
Engine coolant level Check theradiator reserve tank every timeyou fill the fuel tank. See page .
Automatic transmission Checkthe fluid level monthly. See page
.
Brakes Check the fluid levelmonthly. See page .
Tires Check the tire pressuremonthly. Examine the tread forwear and foreign objects. See page
.
Lights Check the operation ofthe headlights, parking lights,taillights, high-mount brake light,turn signals, brake lights, andlicense plate light monthly. Seepage .
According to state and federalregulations, Honda will not deny aclaim for emissions warrantycoverage simply because you did notmaintain the vehicle or do not havemaintenance records to show thatyou did. However, any part of thatfails because of abuse or lack ofrequired maintenance will not becovered by this warranty.
U.S. Vehicles:
289
356
357
375
359
288
CONTINUED
Owner’s Maintenance ChecksMaintenance, replacement, orrepair of emissions controldevices and systems may be doneby any automotive repairestablishment or individual usingparts that are ‘‘certif ied’’ to EPAstandards.
Maintenance MinderM
aintenance
345
08/12/27 12:11:32 31TM8600 0350
2010 Insight
*
*
#
#
#
*
Maintenance Minder
346
:
Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 only if they are noisy.
See information on maintenance and emissions warranty on page .
Inspect idle speed every 160,000 miles (256,000 km).
Independent of the maintenance messages on the multi-informationdisplay, replace the brake fluid every 3 years.
If the message ‘‘SERVICE DUE NOW’’ does not appear more than 12 monthsafter the display is reset, change the engine oil every year.
NOTE:
:
345
Maintenance Sub ItemsRotate tiresReplace air cleaner element
If you drive in dusty conditions, replaceevery 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
Replace dust and pollen filterIf you drive primarily in urban areas that have highconcentrations of soot in the air from industry andfrom diesel-powered vehicles, replace every 15,000miles (24,000 km).
Inspect drive beltReplace transmission fluidReplace spark plugsInspect valve clearanceReplace engine coolant
Maintenance Main ItemsReplace engine oilReplace engine oil and oil filterInspect front and rear brakesCheck parking brake adjustmentInspect these items:
Tie rod ends, steering gear box, and bootsSuspension componentsDriveshaft bootsBrake hoses and lines (including ABS/VSA)All fluid levels and condition of fluidsExhaust systemFuel lines and connections
AB
Symbol Symbol12
34
5
Main
tenance
Min
der
08/12/27 12:11:40 31TM8600 0351
2010 Insight
Fluid LocationsM
aintenance
347
RADIATOR CAP
ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK(Orange loop)
WASHER FLUID(Blue cap)
AUTOMATICTRANSMISSION (CVT)FLUID DIPSTICK(Yellow loop)
ENGINE COOLANTRESERVOIR
BRAKE FLUID(Black cap)
ENGINE OIL FILL CAP
08/12/27 12:11:44 31TM8600 0352
2010 Insight
Unscrew and remove the engine oilfill cap on the valve cover. Pour theoil slowly and carefully so you do notspill any. Clean up any spillsimmediately. Spilled oil coulddamage components in the enginecompartment.
Oil is a major contributor to yourengine’s performance and longevity.Always use a premium-grade 0W-20detergent oil displaying the APICertification Seal. This seal indicatesthe oil is energy conserving, and thatit meets the American PetroleumInstitute’s latest requirements.
Reinstall the engine oil fill cap, andtighten it securely. Wait a fewminutes, and recheck the oil level onthe engine oil dipstick. Do not fillabove the upper mark; you coulddamage the engine.
Adding Engine Oil
Recommended Engine Oil
348
ENGINE OIL FILL CAP
08/12/27 12:11:49 31TM8600 0353
2010 Insight
Honda Motor Oil is the preferred0W-20 lubricant for your vehicle. It ishighly recommended that you useHonda Motor Oil in your vehicle foroptimum engine protection. Makesure the API Certification Seal says‘‘For Gasoline Engines’’.
The oil viscosity or weight isprovided on the container’s label. You may use a synthetic motor oil if
it meets the same requirementsgiven for a conventional motor oil: itdisplays the API Certification Sealand it is the proper weight. You mustfollow the oil and filter changeintervals shown on the multi-information display.
Your vehicle does not require any oiladditives. Additives may adverselyaffect the engine or transmissionperformance and durability.
A very low-viscosity, fuel-efficient0W-20 oil is the engine lubricant foryour Insight. This special oil isformulated to help your engine useless fuel.
Adding Engine Oil
Synthetic Oil
Engine Oil Additives
Maintenance
349
API CERTIFICATION SEAL
Ambient Temperature
08/12/27 12:11:57 31TM8600 0354
2010 Insight
Changing the oil and filter requiresspecial tools and access fromunderneath the vehicle. The vehicleshould be raised on a service station-type hydraulic lift for this service.Unless you have the knowledge andproper equipment, you should havethis maintenance done by a skilledmechanic.
Run the engine until it reachesnormal operating temperature,then shut it off.
Open the hood, and remove theengine oil fill cap.
Remove the screws with a Phillips-head screwdriver, and clips with aflat-tipped screwdriver, then pullthe under-cover down.
Always change the oil and filteraccording to the maintenancemessages shown on the multi-information display. The oil and filtercollect contaminants that candamage your engine if they are notremoved regularly.
1.
2.3.
Changing the Oil and Filter
350
SCREW
CLIP
SCREWS
08/12/27 12:12:04 31TM8600 0355
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
Remove the oil drain bolt andwasher from the bottom of theengine. Drain the oil into anappropriate container.
Remove the oil filter, and let theremaining oil drain. A specialwrench (available from yourdealer) is required.
Make sure the oil filter gasket isnot stuck to the contacting surfaceof the engine. If it is, remove itbefore installing a new oil filter.
Engine oil change capacity(including filter):
Refill the engine with therecommended oil.
Put a new washer on the drain bolt,then reinstall the drain bolt.Tighten the drain bolt to:
Make sure to clean off any dirtand dust on the contacting surfaceof a new oil filter.
Install a new oil filter according tothe instructions that come with it.
7.
8.4. 5.
6.
Changing the Oil and FilterM
aintenance
351
WASHER OIL FILTER
BOLT
3.4 US qt (3.2 )
29 lbf·ft (39 N·m , 4.0 kgf·m)
08/12/27 12:12:14 31TM8600 0356
2010 Insight
Turn off the engine, let it sit forseveral minutes, then check the oillevel on the dipstick. If necessary,add more oil.
Put the under-cover back in placeand reinstall the holding clips andscrews. Lock the clips securely bypushing on the center of each clip.
Reinstall the engine oil fill cap.Start the engine. The oil pressureindicator should go out within 5seconds. If it does not, turn off theengine, and check your work.
Let the engine run for severalminutes, then check the drain boltand oil filter for leaks.
9.
10.
11.
12.
Changing the Oil and Filter
352
Improper disposal of engine oil can beharmf ul to the environment. If youchange your own oil, please dispose ofthe used oil properly. Put it in a sealedcontainer and take it to a recyclingcenter. Do not discard it in a trash binor dump it on the ground.
08/12/27 12:12:20 31TM8600 0357
2010 Insight
- -
If the coolant level in the reservetank is at or below the MIN line, addcoolant to bring it up to between theMIN and MAX lines. Inspect thecooling system for leaks.
Always use Honda Long-life Anti-freeze/Coolant Type 2. This coolantis pre-mixed with 50 percentantifreeze and 50 percent distilledwater. Never add straight antifreezeor plain water.
If Honda antifreeze/coolant is notavailable, you may use anothermajor-brand non-silicate coolant as atemporary replacement. Make sure itis a high-quality coolantrecommended for aluminum engines.Continued use of any non-Hondacoolant can result in corrosion,causing the cooling system tomalfunction or fail. Have the coolingsystem flushed and refilled withHonda antifreeze/coolant as soon aspossible.
CONTINUED
Adding Engine Coolant
Engine CoolantM
aintenance
353
RESERVE TANK
If you regularly drive your vehicleunder severe conditions in very lowtemperature (under 31°F, 35°C), ahigher concentration of coolant shouldbe used. Consult your Honda dealerf or more inf ormation on the propercoolant.
08/12/27 12:12:26 31TM8600 0358
2010 Insight
If the reserve tank is completelyempty, you should also check thecoolant level in the radiator.
The coolant level should be up tothe base of the filler neck. Addcoolant if it is low.
Do not add any rust inhibitors orother additives to your vehicle’scooling system. They may not becompatible with the coolant orengine components.
Pour coolant into the reserve tank.Fill it to halfway between the MAXand MIN marks. Put the cap backon the reserve tank.
Pour the coolant slowly andcarefully so you do not spill any.Clean up any spill immediately; itcould damage components in theengine compartment.
Put the radiator cap back on, andtighten it fully.
Remove the radiator cap bypushing down and turningcounterclockwise.
Relieve any pressure in the coolingsystem by turning the radiator capcounterclockwise, withoutpressing down.
Make sure the engine and radiatorare cool.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Engine Coolant
354
RADIATOR CAP
Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.
08/12/27 12:12:35 31TM8600 0359
2010 Insight
Check the fluid level in thewindshield washer reservoir at leastmonthly during normal use.
Check the fluid level by removingthe cap and looking at the levelgauge.
When you refill the reservoir, cleanthe edges of the windshield wiperblades with windshield washer fluidon a clean cloth. This will help tocondition them.
Fill the reservoir with a good-qualitywindshield washer fluid. Thisincreases the cleaning capability andprevents freezing in cold weather.
If the washer fluid is low, a‘‘WASHER FLUID LOW’’ messageappears on the multi-informationdisplay.
On U.S. models
On all Canadian models
Windshield WashersM
aintenance
355
Do not use engine antif reeze or avinegar/water solution in thewindshield washer reservoir. Antif reezecan damage your vehicle’s paint, whilea vinegar/water solution can damagethe windshield washer pump. Use onlycommercially-available windshieldwasher f luid.
08/12/27 12:12:42 31TM8600 0360
2010 Insight
Check the fluid level with the engineat normal operating temperature.
Remove the dipstick (yellow loop)from the transmission, and wipe itwith a clean cloth.
Insert the dipstick all the way intothe transmission securely asshown in the illustration.
If the level is below the lowermark, add fluid into the dipstickhole to bring it to the levelbetween the upper and lowermarks.
Pour the fluid slowly and carefullyso you do not spill any. Clean upany spill immediately; it coulddamage components in the enginecompartment.
Park the vehicle on level ground.Start the engine, let it run until theradiator fan comes on, then shutoff the engine. For accurateresults, wait about 60 seconds (butno longer than 90 seconds) beforedoing step 2.
Remove the dipstick and checkthe fluid level. There is a HOTside and a COLD side on thedipstick. The fluid level should bebetween the upper and lowermarks on the HOT side.
Always use Honda CVTF(Continuously VariableTransmission Fluid).
3.
4.
5.2.
1.
Continuously VariableTransmission (CVT)
Automatic Transmission Fluid
356
DIPSTICKUPPERMARKHOT
Range LOWERMARK
08/12/27 12:12:52 31TM8600 0361
2010 Insight
Check the brake fluid level in thereservoirs monthly.
Insert the dipstick all the way backinto the transmission securely.
The transmission should be drainedand refilled with new fluid when thisservice is indicated by a maintenancemessage on the multi-informationdisplay.
If you are not sure how to add fluid,contact your dealer.
Always use Honda Heavy DutyBrake Fluid DOT 3. If it is notavailable, you should use only DOT 3or DOT 4 fluid, from a sealedcontainer, as a temporaryreplacement.
Using any non-Honda brake fluid cancause corrosion and decrease the lifeof the system. Have the brakesystem flushed and refilled withHonda Heavy Duty Brake FluidDOT 3 as soon as possible.
Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is notcompatible with your vehicle’sbraking system and can causeextensive damage.
You will also see the ‘‘BRAKEFLUID LOW’’ message on the multi-information display when the brakefluid level is low.
Replace the brake fluid when thisservice is indicated by a maintenancemessage on the multi-informationdisplay.
6.
CONTINUED
Brake Fluid
Automatic Transmission Fluid, Brake FluidM
aintenance
357
08/12/27 12:13:01 31TM8600 0362
2010 Insight
The fluid level should be betweenthe MIN and MAX marks on the sideof the reservoir. If the level is at orbelow the MIN mark, your brakesystem needs attention. Have thebrake system inspected for leaks orworn brake pads.
Brake Fluid
358
MAX
MIN
08/12/27 12:13:04 31TM8600 0363
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
Open the hood.
Your vehicle has halogen headlightbulbs. When replacing a bulb, handleit by its base, and protect the glassfrom contact with your skin or hardobjects. If you touch the glass, cleanit with denatured alcohol and a cleancloth.
The headlights were properly aimedwhen your vehicle was new. If youregularly carry heavy items in thecargo area, readjustment may berequired. Adjustments should bedone by your dealer or anotherqualified technician.
To change the bulb on the rightside, remove the upper part of thewindshield washer reservoir tank.Use a flat-tipped screwdriver toremove the holding clip, thenremove the upper part by pulling itstraight up.
Remove the electrical connectorfrom the cover by pushing on thetab to unlock it, then slide theconnector off the cover.
Remove the cover on the back ofthe headlight assembly by turningit counterclockwise.
1. 2.
3.
Headlight Aiming
Replacing a Headlight Bulb
Lights
High Beam Headlight
Maintenance
359
HOLDING CLIP
CONNECTOR
Halogen headlight bulbs get very hotwhen lit. Oil, perspiration, or a scratchon the glass can cause the bulb tooverheat and shatter.
08/12/27 12:13:14 31TM8600 0364
2010 Insight
Remove the electrical connectorfrom the bulb by pushing on thetab and pulling the connectordown.
Remove the bulb from theheadlight assembly by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Install the new bulb, and turn itone-quarter turn clockwise to lockit in place.
Push the electrical connector backonto the bulb. Make sure it is onall the way.
Reinstall the cover over the backof the headlight assembly and turnit clockwise to lock it in place.Push the electrical connector backonto the cover.
Turn on the headlights to test thenew bulb.
4. 5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Lights
360
BULB
COVER
CONNECTOR
08/12/27 12:13:21 31TM8600 0365
2010 Insight
Install the new bulb, and turn itone-quarter turn clockwise to lockit in place.
Push the electrical connector backonto the bulb. Make sure it is onall the way.
Turn on the headlights to test thenew bulb.
Install the upper part of thewindshield washer reservoir tankin the reverse order of removal.
Remove the bulb from theheadlight assembly by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Remove the electrical connectorfrom the bulb by pushing on thetab and pulling the connectordown.
Open the hood.
(Right side)
3.
4.
5.
6.
2.
1.
10.
Lights
Low Beam Headlight
Maintenance
361
BULB
CONNECTOR
08/12/27 12:13:30 31TM8600 0366
2010 Insight
Open the hood.To change the bulb on the rightside, remove the upper part of thewindshield washer reservoir tank.Use a flat-tipped screwdriver toremove the holding clip, thenremove the upper part by pulling itstraight up.
Remove the socket from theheadlight assembly by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push the new bulb straightinto the socket until it bottoms.
Install the socket back into theheadlight assembly. Turn itclockwise to lock it in place.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
Install the upper part of thewindshield washer reservoir tankin the reverse order of removal.
(Right side)6.
1. 2.
3.
4.
5.
Lights
Replacing a Front Parking LightBulb
362
BULBHOLDING CLIP
SOCKET
08/12/27 12:13:39 31TM8600 0367
2010 Insight
Place a cloth on the edge of thelight assembly garnish. Removethe cover by carefully prying inthe notch on its left edge with aflat-tipped screwdriver.
Remove the socket from the frontturn signal light assembly byturning it one-quarter turncounterclockwise.
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push the new bulb straightinto the socket until it bottoms.
Insert the socket back into thefront turn signal light assembly.Turn it clockwise to lock it in place.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
Install the light assembly in thereverse order of removal. Makesure to secure the bolt.
Install the garnish in the originalposition securely.
Remove the bolt and pull the frontturn light assembly from thebumper while taking the tab outfrom the holder.
5.
6.
1.
7.
8.
3.
4.
2.
Lights
Replacing the Front Turn SignalLight Bulb
Maintenance
363
TAB
BOLTGARNISH
NOTCH
BULB
08/12/27 12:13:48 31TM8600 0368
2010 Insight
Open the hood.
Remove the socket from theheadlight assembly by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push the new bulb straightinto the socket until it bottoms.
Install the socket back into theheadlight assembly. Turn itclockwise to lock it in place.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
Lights
Replacing a Front Side MarkerLight Bulb
364
BULB
SOCKET
08/12/27 12:13:55 31TM8600 0369
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
Open the hatch.
Push on the area of the trim asshown in the illustration above todetach the upper hooks from thelight assembly.
Pry on the gap between the trimand light assembly carefully with aflat-tipped screwdriver to detachthe lower hooks.
Make sure that all hooks areremoved from the light assembly.Unclip the top half of the trimfrom the body by pulling it out.Then unclip the bottom half.
1.
2.
3. 4.
Lights
Replacing the Rear Bulbs
Maintenance
365
HOOKS
TRIM
HOOKS
CLIP
CLIP
08/12/27 12:14:03 31TM8600 0370
2010 Insight
Remove the two mounting boltswith an 8 mm wrench.
Pull the rear of the light assemblyout as shown in the illustrationabove ( ), then push theassembly back to the originalposition carefully ( ). The frontpart of the rear light assemblyraises slightly ( ).
Determine which of the threebulbs is burned out: back-up light,turn signal, or side marker.
Pull the whole light assemblyoutwards from the body carefully.
Remove the socket by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Remove the burned out bulb bypulling it straight out of its socket.
6.
7.
5. 8.
9.
10.
Lights
366
BOLT
ORIGINALPOSITION
Front
Front
Left side
BULB
SOCKETSNAP FASTENERS
Left side
08/12/27 12:14:12 31TM8600 0371
2010 Insight
Install the new bulb in the socketby pushing it straight in the socketuntil it bottoms.
Reinstall the socket into the lightassembly. Turn it clockwise tolock it in place.
Test the lights to make sure thenew bulb is working.
When reinstalling the taillightassembly, align and pop the snapfasteners in place. Reinstall andtighten the two mounting bolts. To reinstall the trim, set the
bottom edge of the trim in theoriginal position and push thebottom half of the trim to clip itback securely. Then push theupper half of the trim to securethe top clip.
Secure the hooks by pushing onthe areas of the trim as shown inthe illustration above.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15. 16.
LightsM
aintenance
367
08/12/27 12:14:20 31TM8600 0372
2010 Insight
Each outside mirror has side turnsignal lights. The lights should bereplaced by your dealer.
The high-mount brake light shouldbe replaced by your dealer.
The license plate has two lightsabove it. The bulbs should bereplaced by your dealer.
EX models
Lights
Side Turn Signal Lights
Rear License Plate Light Bulbs
High-mount Brake Light
368
08/12/27 12:14:25 31TM8600 0373
2010 Insight
Before using an automatic car wash,remove the radio antenna so it doesnot get damaged. Remove theantenna by unscrewing it. When youreinstall the antenna, tighten itsecurely.
Before entering or parking in areaswith low ceiling height, remove theantenna.
The driver’s floor mat that camewith your vehicle hooks over thefloor mat anchors. To lock eachanchor, turn the knob clockwise.This keeps the floor mat from slidingforward and possibly interfering withthe pedals.
If your seat belts get dirty, use a softbrush with a mixture of mild soapand warm water to clean them. Donot use bleach, dye, or cleaningsolvents. Let the belts air dry beforeyou use the vehicle.Dirt build-up in the loops of the seatbelt anchors can cause the belts toretract slowly. Wipe the insides ofthe loops with a clean clothdampened in mild soap and warmwater or isopropyl alcohol.
When cleaning or replacing, turn theknob counterclockwise to unhookthe floor mat. CONTINUED
On all Canadian models
Roof Antenna Floor MatsCleaning the Seat Belts
Roof Antenna, Cleaning the Seat Belts, Floor MatsM
aintenance
369
LOOP
To unlock
Driver’s floor mat is shown.
08/12/27 12:14:35 31TM8600 0374
2010 Insight
Check the condition of the wiperblades at least every 6 months.Replace them if you find signs ofcracking in the rubber, and areasthat are getting hard or if they leavestreaks and unwiped areas whenused.
If you remove a floor mat, make sureto re-anchor it when you put it backin your vehicle.
If you use a non-Honda floor mat,make sure it fits properly and that itcan be used with the floor matanchors. Do not put additional floormats on top of the anchored mats.
Make sure the rear floor mats areproperly positioned. If not, the floormat will interfere with the seatoperation and make the frontpassenger’s weight sensorsineffective.
This filter removes the dust andpollen that is brought in from theoutside through the climate controlsystem.
Have your dealer replace the filterwhen this service is indicated by amaintenance message on the multi-information display. It should bereplaced every 15,000 miles (24,000km) if you drive primarily in urbanareas that have high concentrationsof soot in the air, or if the flow fromthe climate control system becomesless than usual.
Wiper BladesDust and Pollen Filter
Floor Mats, Dust and Pollen Filter, Wiper Blades
370
08/12/27 12:14:41 31TM8600 0375
2010 Insight
To replace a wiper blade:
Raise each wiper arm off thewindshield, lifting the driver’s sidefirst, then the passenger’s side.
Disconnect the blade assemblyfrom the wiper arm:
When replacing a wiper blade,make sure not to drop the wiperblade or wiper arm down on thewindshield.
Put a cloth on the edge of thelock tab, then push up on thelock tab carefully with a flat-tipped screwdriver.
Pivot the blade assembly towardthe wiper arm until it releasesfrom the wiper arm.1.
2.
CONTINUED
Wiper BladesM
aintenance
371
WIPER ARMS LOCK TAB
WIPER ARM
Do not open the hood when the wiperarms are raised, or you will damage thehood and wiper arms.
08/12/27 12:14:50 31TM8600 0376
2010 Insight
Remove the blade from its holderby grabbing the tabbed end of theblade. Pull firmly until the tabscome out of the holder.
Make sure the two rubber tabsinside the blade fit to each notch ofthe reinforcement, as shown.
Make sure the blade is completelyinstalled.
Place the top of the wiper blade onthe end of the blade assembly, andslide the blade onto the assembly.
Examine the new wiper blades. Ifthey have no plastic or metalreinforcement along the backedge, remove the metalreinforcement strips from the oldwiper blade, and install them inthe slots along the edge of the newblade.
3.
4.
5.
Wiper Blades
372
BLADE
REINFORCEMENT
BLADE
08/12/27 12:14:57 31TM8600 0377
2010 Insight
Slide the wiper blade assemblyonto the wiper arm. Make sure itlocks in place.
Make sure the blade is completelyinstalled and that its edge is notbunched up.
Lower the wiper arm down againstthe windshield, the passenger’sside first, then the driver’s side.
To replace a rear wiper blade:
Raise the wiper arm off the rearwindow.
Disconnect the blade assemblyfrom the wiper arm by pivoting theblade assembly upward.
6.
7.
8.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Wiper BladesM
aintenance
373
REAR
08/12/27 12:15:06 31TM8600 0378
2010 Insight
Lower the wiper arm against thewindshield.
Install the wiper blade assemblyonto the wiper arm. Make sure itlocks in place.
Slide the new blade into the holder.Make sure it is engaged in the slotalong its full length.Insert both ends of the blade intothe holder. Make sure they aresecure.
Pull one end of the blade out fromthe holder.Slide the blade out of the holder.
Examine the new wiper blades. Ifthey have no plastic or metalreinforcement along the backedge, remove the metalreinforcement strips from the oldwiper blade, and install them inthe slots along the edge of the newblade.
3.
5.
4.
6.
7.
Wiper Blades
374
BLADE
REINFORCEMENT
08/12/27 12:15:14 31TM8600 0379
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
To safely operate your vehicle, yourtires must be the proper type andsize, in good condition with adequatetread, and correctly inflated.
The following pages give moredetailed information on how to takecare of your tires and what to dowhen they need to be replaced.
Keeping the tires properly inflatedprovides the best combination ofhandling, tread life, and ridingcomfort.
Underinflated tires wear unevenly,adversely affect handling and fueleconomy, and are more likely tofail from being overheated.Overinflated tires can make yourvehicle ride more harshly, aremore prone to damage from roadhazards, and wear unevenly.
The tire pressure monitoring system(TPMS) warns you when a tirepressure is low. See page formore information.
We recommend that you visuallycheck your tires every day. If youthink a tire might be low, check itimmediately with a tire gauge.
Even though your vehicle isequipped with TPMS, werecommend that you visually checkyour tires every day. If you think atire might be low, check itimmediately with a tire gauge.
Use a gauge to measure the airpressure in each tire at least once amonth. Even tires that are in goodcondition may lose 1 to 2 psi (10 to20 kPa, 0.1 to 0.2 kgf/cm ) permonth. Remember to check thespare tire at the same time.
Check the air pressures when thetires are cold. This means thevehicle has been parked for at least 3hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6km). Add or release air, if needed, tomatch the recommended cold tirepressures.
328
On U.S. models
On all Canadian models
On U.S. modelsTires Inflation Guidelines
TiresM
aintenance
375
Using tires that are excessivelyworn or improperly inflated cancause a crash in which you canbe seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regarding tireinflation and maintenance.
08/12/27 12:15:25 31TM8600 0380
2010 Insight
If you check air pressures when thetires are hot (driven for severalmiles/kilometers), you will seereadings 4 to 6 psi (30 to 40 kPa, 0.3to 0.4 kgf/cm ) higher than the coldreadings. This is normal. Do not letair out to match the recommendedcold air pressure. The tire will beunderinflated.
You should get your own tirepressure gauge and use it wheneveryou check your tire pressures. Thiswill make it easier for you to tell if apressure loss is due to a tire problemand not due to a variation betweengauges.
While tubeless tires have someability to self-seal if they arepunctured, you should look closelyfor punctures if a tire starts losingpressure.
The following chart shows therecommended cold tire pressures formost normal driving conditions.
The compact spare tire pressure is:
Every time you check inflation, youshould also examine the tires fordamage, foreign objects, and wear.
You should look for:
Bumps or bulges in the tread orside of the tire. Replace the tire ifyou find either of these conditions.
Cuts, splits, or cracks in the sideof the tire. Replace the tire if youcan see fabric or cord.
Excessive tread wear.
For convenience, the recommendedtire sizes and cold tire pressures areon a label on the driver’s doorjamb.
For additional information aboutyour tires, see page .421
Tire Size Cold Tire Pressure
Tires
Recommended Tire Pressures Tire Inspection
376
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
175/65R15 84S33 psi (230 kPa , 2.3kgf/cm )
Front/Rear:
08/12/27 12:15:37 31TM8600 0381
2010 Insight
Your tires have wear indicatorsmolded into the tread. When thetread wears down, you will see a 1/2inch (12.7 mm) wide band across thetread. This shows there is less than1/16 inch (1.6 mm) of tread left onthe tire.
A tire this worn gives very littletraction on wet roads. You shouldreplace the tire if you can see threeor more tread wear indicators.
The service life of your tires isdependent on many factors,including, but not limited to, drivinghabits, road conditions, vehicleloading, inflation pressure,maintenance history, speed, andenvironmental conditions (evenwhen the tires are not in use).
In addition to your regularinspections and inflation pressuremaintenance, it is recommended thatyou have annual inspectionsperformed once the tires reach fiveyears old. It is also recommendedthat all tires, including the spare, beremoved from service after 10 yearsfrom the date of manufacture,regardless of their condition or stateof wear.The last four digits of the TIN (tireidentification number) are found onthe sidewall of the tire and indicatethe date of manufacture (See
on page ).
In addition to proper inflation,correct wheel alignment helps todecrease tire wear. If you find a tireis worn unevenly, have your dealercheck the wheel alignment.
Have your dealer check the tires ifyou feel a consistent vibration whiledriving. A tire should always berebalanced if it is removed from thewheel. When you have new tiresinstalled, make sure they arebalanced. This increases ridingcomfort and tire life. For best results,have the installer perform a dynamicbalance.
421
Tires
Tire Service Life
TireLabeling
Tire Maintenance
Maintenance
377
INDICATOR LOCATION MARKS
TREAD WEAR INDICATOR
Improper wheel weights can damageyour vehicle’s aluminum wheels. Useonly Honda wheel weights f orbalancing.
08/12/27 12:15:46 31TM8600 0382
2010 Insight
*
*
*
To help increase tire life anddistribute wear more evenly, rotatethe tires according to themaintenance messages displayed onthe multi-information display. Movethe tires to the positions shown inthe illustration each time they arerotated. If you purchase directionaltires, rotate only front-to-back.
Replace your tires with radial tires ofthe same size, load range, speedrating, and maximum cold tirepressure rating (as shown on thetire’s sidewall).
When the tires are rotated, makesure the air pressures are checked.
It is best to replace all four tires atthe same time. If that is not possibleor necessary, replace the two fronttires or two rear tires as a pair.Replacing just one tire can seriouslyaffect your vehicle’s handling.
The ABS and VSA system works bycomparing the speed of each wheel.When replacing tires, use the samesize originally supplied with thevehicle. Tire size and constructioncan affect wheel speed and maycause the system to activate.
If you ever replace a wheel, makesure that the wheel’s specificationsmatch those of the original wheels.
Replacement wheels are available atyour dealer.
Mixing radial and bias-ply tires onyour vehicle can reduce brakingability, traction, and steeringaccuracy. Using tires of a differentsize or construction can cause theABS and vehicle stability assist(VSA) to work inconsistently.
Also be sure you use only TPMSspecific wheels. If you do not, thetire pressure monitoring system willnot work.
:
On U.S. models
If equipped
Tires
Tire Rotation Replacing Tires and Wheels
378
Front Front
(Front Non-directionalTires and Wheels)
(Front DirectionalTires and Wheels)
08/12/27 12:15:56 31TM8600 0383
2010 Insight
+
CONTINUED
Wheels:
Tires:
See page for DOT tire qualitygrading information, and page
for tire size information.
Tires marked ‘‘M S’’ or ‘‘AllSeason’’ on the sidewall have an all-weather tread design suitable formost winter driving conditions.
For the best performance in snowyor icy conditions, you should installsnow tires or tire chains. They maybe required by local laws undercertain conditions.
If you mount snow tires on yourvehicle, make sure they are radialtires of the same size and load rangeas original tires. Mount snow tires onall four wheels. The tractionprovided by snow tires on dry roadsmay be lower than your original tires.Check with the tire dealer formaximum speed recommendations.
Because your vehicle has limited tireclearance, Honda stronglyrecommends using the chains listedbelow, made by Security ChainCompany (SCC).
Mount tire chains on your tires whenrequired by driving conditions orlocal laws. Install them only on thefront tires.
Cable-type: SCC RADIAL CHAINSC1026
420
421
Tires
Wheel and Tire Specifications
Winter Driving
Snow Tires
Tire Chains
Maintenance
379
15 x 5 1/2 J
175/65R15 84S
Installing improper tires on yourvehicle can affect handling andstability. This can cause a crashin which you can be seriouslyhurt or killed.
Always use the size and type oftires recommended in thisowner’s manual.
08/12/27 12:16:07 31TM8600 0384
2010 Insight
When installing cables, follow themanufacturer’s instructions, andmount them as tight as you can.Make sure they are not contactingthe brake lines or suspension. Driveslowly with them installed. If youhear them coming into contact withthe body or chassis, stop andinvestigate. Remove them as soon asyou begin driving on cleared roads.
Clean the wheels as you would therest of the exterior. Wash them withthe same solution, and rinse themthoroughly.
Aluminum alloy wheels have aprotective clear-coat that keeps thealuminum from corroding andtarnishing. Cleaning the wheels withharsh chemicals (including somecommercial wheel cleaners) or a stiffbrush can damage the clear-coat. Toclean the wheels, use a milddetergent and a soft brush or sponge.
If equipped
Tires
Wheels
380
Using the wrong chains, or notproperly installing chains, candamage the brake lines andcause a crash in which you canbe seriously injured or killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regarding theselection and use of tire chains.
Traction devices that are the wrongsize or improperly installed candamage your vehicle’s brake lines,suspension, body, and wheels. Stopdriving if they are hitting any part ofthe vehicle.
08/12/27 12:16:13 31TM8600 0385
2010 Insight
-
Check the condition of the 12 voltbattery monthly by looking at thetest indicator window. The label onthe battery explains the testindicator’s colors.
If your vehicle’s 12 volt battery isdisconnected or goes dead, the IMAbattery level gauge reading will notbe correct the next time you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. It will show less than theactual level temporarily. It will showthe correct level after you drive forat least 30 minutes.
Check the terminals for corrosion (awhite or yellowish powder). Toremove it, cover the terminals with asolution of baking soda and water. Itwill bubble up and turn brown. Whenthis stops, wash it off with plainwater. Dry off the battery with acloth or paper towel. Coat theterminals with grease to help preventfurther corrosion.
If additional battery maintenance isneeded, see your dealer or aqualified technician.
Battery posts,terminals, and related accessoriescontain lead and lead compounds.
If you need to connect the battery toa charger, disconnect both cables toprevent damaging your vehicle’selectrical system. Always disconnectthe negative ( ) cable first, andreconnect it last. CONTINUED
WARNING:
Wash your hands after handling.
Checking the 12 Volt BatteryM
aintenance
381
TEST INDICATOR WINDOW
The battery gives off explosivehydrogen gas during normaloperation.
A spark or flame can cause thebattery to explode with enoughforce to kill or seriously hurt you.
Wear protective clothing and aface shield, or have a skilledtechnician do the batterymaintenance.
08/12/27 12:16:21 31TM8600 0386
2010 Insight
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected, or goes dead, the timesetting may be lost. To reset the time,see page .
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, the audiosystem may disable itself. The nexttime you turn on the radio, you willsee ‘‘ENTER CODE’’ in thefrequency display. Use the presetbuttons to enter the code (see page
).
The navigation system will alsodisable itself. The next time you turnon the ignition switch, the systemwill require you to enter a PINbefore it can be used. Refer to thenavigation system manual.
254
253
On vehicles with navigation system
Checking the 12 Volt Battery
382
08/12/27 12:16:25 31TM8600 0387
2010 Insight
Fill the fuel tank.
If you need to park your vehicle foran extended period (more than 1month), there are several things youshould do to prepare it for storage.Proper preparation helps preventdeterioration and makes it easier toget your vehicle back on the road. Ifpossible, store your vehicle indoors.
Wash and dry the exteriorcompletely.
Clean the interior. Make sure thecarpeting, floor mats, etc., arecompletely dry.
Leave the parking brake off. Putthe transmission in Park.
Block the rear wheels.
If the vehicle is to be stored for alonger period, it should besupported on jackstands so thetires are off the ground.
Leave one window open slightly (ifthe vehicle is being storedindoors).
Disconnect the 12 volt battery.
Support the front wiper bladearms with a folded towel or rag sothey do not touch the windshield.
Cover the vehicle with a‘‘breathable’’ cover, one madefrom a porous material such ascotton. Non-porous materials, such
as plastic sheeting, trap moisture,which can damage the paint.
Reconnect the 12 volt battery anddrive your vehicle every month forabout 30 minutes. This will keepthe IMA battery charged and ingood condition.
If possible, periodically run theengine until it reaches fulloperating temperature (thecooling fans cycle on and offtwice). Preferably, do this once amonth.
To minimize sticking, apply asilicone spray lubricant to all doorand hatch seals. Also, apply avehicle body wax to the paintedsurfaces that mate with the doorand hatch seals.
Vehicle StorageM
aintenance
383
If this vehicle is unused f or over onemonth, the service lif e of the 100VNickel-Metal Hydride battery will bereduced and the battery may bepermanently damaged.
08/12/27 12:16:36 31TM8600 0388
2010 Insight
384
08/12/27 12:16:39 31TM8600 0389
2010 Insight
This section covers the morecommon problems that motoristsexperience with their vehicles. Itgives you information about how tosafely evaluate the problem and whatto do to correct it. If the problem hasstranded you on the side of the road,you may be able to get going again.If not, you will also find instructionson getting your vehicle towed.
......................Compact Spare Tire . 386....................Changing a Flat Tire . 387
.............If the Engine Won’t Start . 394................................Jump Starting . 396
..............If the Engine Overheats . 398.........Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 401
12 Volt Battery Charging System.....................................Indicator . 402
.......Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 403...............Brake System Indicator . 404
..............................................Fuses . 405..............................Fuse Locations . 410
......................Emergency Towing . 412..........If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck . 413
Taking Care of the UnexpectedTaking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
385
08/12/27 12:16:42 31TM8600 0390
2010 Insight
Check the inflation pressure of thecompact spare tire every time youcheck the other tires. It should beinflated to:
Replace the tire when you can seethe tread wear indicator bars. Thereplacement should be the same sizeand design tire, mounted on thesame wheel. The spare tire is notdesigned to be mounted on a regularwheel, and the spare wheel is notdesigned for mounting a regular tire.
Use the compact spare tire as atemporary replacement only. Getyour regular tire repaired or replaced,and put it back on your vehicle assoon as you can.
Follow these precautions:
Never exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
This tire gives a harsher ride andless traction on some roadsurfaces. Use greater cautionwhile driving.
Do not use your compact sparetire on another vehicle unless it isthe same make and model.
Do not mount snow chains on thecompact spare tire.
After the flat tire is replaced withthe spare tire, the low tirepressure/TPMS indicator stays onwhile driving. After several miles(kilometers) driving, this indicatorbegins to flash, then stays onagain. You will also see a ‘‘CHECKTPMS SYSTEM’’ message on themulti-information display. This isnormal; the system cannotmonitor the spare tire pressure.Manually check the spare tirepressure to be sure it is correct.
On U.S. models
Compact Spare Tire
386
INDICATOR LOCATION MARK
TREAD WEAR INDICATOR BAR
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
08/12/27 12:16:51 31TM8600 0391
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
If you have a flat tire while driving,stop in a safe place to change it.Drive slowly along the shoulder untilyou get to an exit or an area to stopthat is far away from the traffic lanes.
Park the vehicle on firm, level, andnon-slippery ground. Put thetransmission in Park. Apply theparking brake.
Turn on the hazard warning lights,and turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position. Have allpassengers get out of the vehiclewhile you change the tire.
Open the hatch.
Remove the cargo area floor bycarefully pulling the front edge ofthe floor straight up.
4.
3.
2.
1.
Changing a Flat TireTaking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
387
HOLDER
FLOOR
TAB
The vehicle can easily roll offthe jack, seriously injuringanyone underneath.
Follow the directions forchanging a tire exactly, andnever get under the vehiclewhen it is supported only by thejack.
08/12/27 12:16:59 31TM8600 0392
2010 Insight
Loosen each wheel nut 1/2 turnwith the wheel nut wrench.
Take the box out of the spare tire.
Take the spare tire casing out ofthe cargo area.
Unscrew the wing bolt and takethe spare tire out of its well.
Remove the jack compartmentcover by pulling the knob.
Turn the jack’s end bracketcounterclockwise to loosen it, thenremove the jack.
6.
7.
10.5. 8.
9.
Changing a Flat Tire
388
WHEEL NUT WRENCH
BOX JACK KNOB
COVERSPARE TIRECASING SPARE TIRE
08/12/27 12:17:07 31TM8600 0393
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
Remove the wheel nuts, thenremove the flat tire. Handle thewheel nuts carefully; they may behot from driving. Place the flat tireon the ground with the outsidesurface facing up.
Use the extension and the wheelnut wrench as shown to raise thevehicle until the flat tire is off theground.
Place the jack under the jackingpoint nearest the tire you need tochange. Turn the end bracketclockwise until the top of the jackcontacts the jacking point. Makesure the jacking point tab isresting in the jack notch.
Remove the wheel cover bycarefully prying under its edgewith the flat tip of the extension.
11. 13.
14.
12.On LX models
Changing a Flat Tire
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
389
WHEEL NUT WRENCH EXTENSION
JACKING POINTS EXTENSION WHEEL NUT
WHEEL COVER
08/12/27 12:17:16 31TM8600 0394
2010 Insight
Before mounting the spare tire,wipe any dirt off the mountingsurface of the wheel and hub witha clean cloth. Wipe the hubcarefully; it may be hot fromdriving.
Lower the vehicle to the ground,and remove the jack.
Put on the spare tire. Put thewheel nuts back on finger-tight,then tighten them in a crisscrosspattern with the wheel nut wrenchuntil the wheel is firmly againstthe hub. Do not try to tighten thewheel nuts fully.
Tighten the wheel nuts securely inthe same crisscross pattern. Havethe wheel nut torque checked atthe nearest automotive servicefacility.Tighten the wheel nuts to:
18.
17.
16.
15.
Changing a Flat Tire
390
BRAKE HUB
80 lbf·ft (108 N·m , 11 kgf·m)
08/12/27 12:17:23 31TM8600 0395
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
Place the flat tire face down in thespare tire well.
Remove the spacer cone from thewing bolt, turn it over, and put itback on the bolt.
Remove the carpet from the sparetire casing and store it in thecasing.
Secure the flat tire by screwingthe wing bolt back into its hole.Store the box in the wheel of theflat tire.
Remove the center cap (ifequipped) before storing the flattire in the cargo area well.
Install the spare tire casing in theoriginal position in the spare tirewell.
20.
21.
19.
22.
23.
24.
EX models
Changing a Flat TireTaking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
391
SPACER CONE
WING BOLT
BOX For normal tire
For compactspare tire
CARPET
SPARE TIRECASING
CENTER CAP
08/12/27 12:17:32 31TM8600 0396
2010 Insight
Your vehicle’s original tire has atire pressure monitoring systemsensor. To replace a tire, refer to
(seepage ).
Store the center cap in the cargoarea. Make sure it does not getscratched or damaged.
Store the tools in the spare tirecasing and the jack in its holder.Turn the jack’s end bracketclockwise to lock it in place, andreinstall the cover.
Place the cargo area floor in itsoriginal position. Close the hatch.
25.
26.
27.
28.
330
U.S. models only
Changing a Flat Tire
Changing a Tire with TPMS
392
FLOOR
Loose items can fly around theinterior in a crash and couldseriously injure the occupants.
Store the wheel, jack, and toolssecurely before driving.
08/12/27 12:17:39 31TM8600 0397
2010 Insight
Make sure the wire support ring ishooked into the clips around theedge of the wheel cover.
Align the valve mark on the wheelcover to the tire valve on thewheel, then install the wheel cover.
Make sure the wire support ring ison the outer side of the tire valveas shown.
1.2. 3.LX models
Changing a Flat Tire
Installing a wheel cover
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
393
CLIPS CLIPS WIRE SUPPORT RING
08/12/27 12:17:46 31TM8600 0398
2010 Insight
The engine normally starts with theIMA motor. If the engine does notstart while the IMA battery charge isnormally sufficient, check thefollowing:
Check the transmission interlock.The transmission must be in Parkor neutral or the starter will notoperate.
Are you using a properly codedkey? An improperly coded key willcause the immobilizer systemindicator in the instrument panelto blink rapidly (see page ).
Do you have fuel? Check the fuelgauge; the low fuel indicator maynot be working.
There may be an electricalproblem, such as no power to thefuel pump. Check all the fuses(see page ).
Are you using the proper startingprocedure? Refer to
on page .
127
405303
If the Engine Won’t Start
Starting theEngine
394
08/12/27 12:17:52 31TM8600 0399
2010 Insight
When the IMA battery charge is low,the starter motor is used to start theengine. If the engine does not start,check the following:
If the headlights dim noticeably orgo out when you try to start theengine, either the 12 volt battery isdischarged or the connections arecorroded. Check the condition ofthe 12 volt battery and terminalconnections (see page ). Youcan then try jump starting thevehicle from a booster 12 voltbattery (see page ).
If you find nothing wrong, you willneed a qualified technician to findthe problem. See
on page .
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position. Turn on theheadlights, and check theirbrightness. If the headlights arevery dim or do not come on at all,the battery is discharged. See
on page .
Turn the ignition switch to theSTART (III) position. If theheadlights do not dim, check thecondition of the fuses. If the fusesare OK, there is probablysomething wrong with theelectrical circuit for the ignitionswitch or starter motor. You willneed a qualified technician todetermine the problem. See
on page .
412
381
396
396
412
If the Engine Won’t Start
EmergencyTowing
Jump Starting
Emergency Towing
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
395
08/12/27 12:17:57 31TM8600 0400
2010 Insight
Although this seems like a simpleprocedure, you should take severalprecautions.
To jump start your vehicle:
The numbers in the illustration showyou the order to connect the jumpercables.
You cannot start your vehicle bypushing or pulling it.
Open the hood, and check thephysical condition of the 12 voltbattery.
Turn off all the electricalaccessories: climate control, audiosystem, lights, etc. Put thetransmission in Park, and set theparking brake.
1.
2.
Jump Starting
396
BOOSTERBATTERY
A battery can explode if you donot follow the correct procedure,seriously injuring anyonenearby.
Keep all sparks, open flames,and smoking materials awayfrom the battery.
If a battery sits in extreme cold, theelectrolyte inside can f reeze.Attempting to jump start with a f rozenbattery can cause it to rupture.
08/12/27 12:18:05 31TM8600 0401
2010 Insight
-+
+
Start the vehicle. If the startermotor still operates slowly, checkthat the jumper cables have goodmetal-to-metal contact.
Once your vehicle is running,disconnect the negative cable fromyour vehicle, then from thebooster battery. Disconnect thepositive cable from your vehicle,then from the booster battery.
Keep the ends of the jumper cablesaway from each other and any metalon the vehicle until everything isdisconnected. Otherwise, you maycause an electrical short.
If the booster battery is in anothervehicle, have an assistant startthat vehicle and run it at a fast idle.
Connect the second jumper cableto the negative ( ) terminal onthe booster battery. Connect theother end to the grounding strapas shown. Do not connect thisjumper cable to any other part ofthe engine.
Connect one jumper cable to thepositive ( ) terminal on yourbattery. Connect the other end tothe positive ( ) terminal on thebooster battery.
7.
6.
4.
5.
3.
CONTINUED
Jump StartingTaking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
397
08/12/27 12:18:13 31TM8600 0402
2010 Insight
If your vehicle’s 12 volt battery isdisconnected or goes dead, the IMAbattery level gauge reading will notbe correct the next time you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. It will show less than theactual level temporarily. It will showthe correct level after you drive forat least 30 minutes.
The high temperature indicatorshould be off under most conditions.If the engine coolant temperaturegets higher than normal, theindicator will blink. If it stays on, youshould determine the reason (hotday, driving up a steep hill, etc.).
You will also see a ‘‘WATER TEMPHOT’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
If the vehicle overheats, you shouldtake immediate action. The onlyindication may be the hightemperature indicator blinking orremaining on. Or you may see steamor spray coming from under thehood.
67
If the Engine Overheats
Jump Starting, If the Engine Overheats
398
Driving with the high temperatureindicator on can cause serious damageto your engine.
08/12/27 12:18:19 31TM8600 0403
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
Safely pull to the side of the road.Put the transmission in Park, andset the parking brake. Turn off allthe accessories, and turn on thehazard warning lights.
If you see steam and/or spraycoming from under the hood, turnoff the engine. Wait until you seeno more signs of steam or spray,then open the hood.
If you do not see steam or spray,leave the engine running, andcheck the high temperatureindicator. If the high heat is due tooverloading, the engine shouldstart to cool down almostimmediately. If it does, wait untilthe high temperature indicatorgoes off, then continue driving.
If the high temperature indicatorstays on, turn off the engine.
Look for any obvious coolant leaks,such as a split radiator hose.Everything is still extremely hot,so use caution. If you find a leak, itmust be repaired before youcontinue driving (see
on page ).
If you don’t find an obvious leak,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank (see page
). Add coolant if the level isbelow the MIN mark.
If there was no coolant in thereserve tank, you may need to addcoolant to the radiator. Let theengine cool down until the hightemperature indicator goes offbefore checking the radiator.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
289
412
If the Engine Overheats
EmergencyTowing
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
399
Steam and spray from anoverheated engine canseriously scald you.
Do not open the hood if steamis coming out.
08/12/27 12:18:27 31TM8600 0404
2010 Insight
Using gloves or a large heavycloth, turn the radiator capcounterclockwise, without pushingdown, to the first stop. After thepressure releases, push down onthe cap, and turn it until it comesoff.
If the temperature stays normal,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. If it hasgone down, add coolant to theMAX mark. Put the cap back ontightly.
Start the engine, and set thetemperature to maximum heat(climate control to AUTO at‘‘ ’’). Add coolant to theradiator up to the base of the fillerneck. If you do not have theproper coolant mixture available,you can add plain water.Remember to have the coolingsystem drained and refilled withthe proper mixture as soon as youcan.
Put the radiator cap back ontightly. Run the engine, and checkthe high temperature indicator. Ifit begins to blink or comes onagain, the engine needs repair(see on page
).
8.
9.
10.
11.
412
If the Engine Overheats
Emergency Towing
400
Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.
08/12/27 12:18:33 31TM8600 0405
2010 Insight
If necessary, add oil to bring thelevel back to the full mark on thedipstick (see page ).
The engine running generates the oilpressure. When the Auto Idle Stop isactivated, the engine is stopped, theoil pressure is dropped, and the lowoil pressure indicator does not comeon.
Safely pull off the road, and shutoff the engine. Turn on the hazardwarning lights.
Let the vehicle sit for a minute.Open the hood, and check the oillevel (see page ). An enginevery low on oil can lose pressureduring cornering and other drivingmaneuvers.
Start the engine and watch the oilpressure indicator. If it does not goout within 10 seconds, turn off theengine. There is a mechanicalproblem that needs to be repairedbefore you can continue driving(see on page
).
This indicator should nevercome on when the engine is
running. If it starts flashing or stayson, the oil pressure has dropped verylow or lost pressure. Serious enginedamage is possible, and you shouldtake immediate action.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKENGINE OIL LEVEL’’ message onthe multi-information display whenthis indicator comes on.
1.
2.
3.
4.
288
348
412
Low Oil Pressure Indicator
Emergency Towing
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
401
Running the engine with low oilpressure can cause serious mechanicaldamage almost immediately. Turn of fthe engine as soon as you can saf ely getthe vehicle stopped.
08/12/27 12:18:41 31TM8600 0406
2010 Insight
--
If the charging systemindicator comes on brightly
when the engine is running, the 12volt battery is not being charged.
Go to a service station or garagewhere you can get technicalassistance.
Immediately turn off all electricalaccessories. Try not to use otherelectrically operated controls such asthe power windows. Keep the enginerunning; starting the engine willdischarge the battery rapidly.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKCHARGING SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display (seepage ).
The charging system indicator mayalso come on if the Integrated MotorAssist (IMA) battery charge dropsbelow a desired level and the enginestarts to recharge the battery.
This indicator may blink after youstart the vehicle in the morningwhen the temperature is below 20°F ( 30°C). It will stop blinkingwhen the IMA battery warms up.
63
12 Volt Battery Charging System Indicator
402
08/12/27 12:18:47 31TM8600 0407
2010 Insight
If the indicator comes on repeatedly,even though it may turn off as youcontinue driving, have your vehiclechecked by your dealer as soon aspossible.
Your vehicle has certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that are part of the on-boarddiagnostics for the emissionssystems. In some states, part of theemissions testing is to make surethese codes are set. If they are notset, the test cannot be completed.
If the indicator comes onwhile driving, it means one
of the engine’s emissions controlsystems may have a problem. Eventhough you may feel no difference inyour vehicle’s performance, it canreduce your fuel economy and causeincreased emissions. Continuedoperation may cause serious damage.
If your vehicle’s battery has beendisconnected or gone dead, thesecodes are erased. It can take severaldays of driving under variousconditions to set the codes again.
To check if they are set, turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position, without starting the engine.The malfunction indicator lamp willcome on for 20 seconds. If it thengoes off, the readiness codes are set.If it blinks five times, the readinesscodes are not set. If possible, do nottake your vehicle for an emissionstest until the readiness codes are set.Refer to formore information (see page ).
If you have recently refueled yourvehicle, the indicator coming oncould be due to a loose or missingfuel fill cap. You will also see a‘‘TIGHTEN FUEL CAP’’ message onthe multi-information display.Tighten the cap until it clicks at leastonce (see page ). Tightening thecap will not turn the indicator offimmediately; it can take several daysof normal driving.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKEMISSION SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display. Formore information, see page .
286
89
428
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Readiness Code Emissions Testing
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
403
If you keep driving with theMalf unction Indicator Lamp on, youcan damage your vehicle’s emissionscontrols and engine. Those repairs maynot be covered by your vehicle’swarranties. This indicator may alsocome on with the ‘‘D’’ indicator.
08/12/27 12:18:55 31TM8600 0408
2010 Insight
However, if the brake pedal does notfeel normal, you should takeimmediate action. A problem in onepart of the system’s dual circuitdesign will still give you braking attwo wheels. You will feel the brakepedal go down much farther beforethe vehicle begins to slow down, andyou will have to press harder on thepedal.
Slow down and pull to the side of theroad when it is safe. Because of thelong distance needed to stop, it ishazardous to drive the vehicle. Youshould have it towed and repaired assoon as possible (see
on page ).
If this indicator comes on for anyother reason, have your vehicleinspected by your dealer. There maybe a malfunction with the electricbrake distribution (EBD) system.Avoid hard braking and high speeddriving.
If the fluid level is low, take yourvehicle to a dealer, and have thebrake system inspected for leaks orworn brake pads.
If the brake system indicator comeson while driving, the brake fluid levelis probably low. Press lightly on thebrake pedal to see if it feels normal.If it does, check the brake fluid levelthe next time you stop at a servicestation (see page ).
The brake system indicator normallycomes on when you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position and asa reminder to check the parkingbrake. If you do not release theparking brake, the indicator will stayon, and you will see a ‘‘RELEASEPARKING BRAKE’’ message on themulti-information display.
You will also see a ‘‘BRAKE FLUIDLOW’’ or ‘‘CHECK BRAKESYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
412
357
89
Brake System Indicator
EmergencyTowing
(Red)
404
U.S. Canada
08/12/27 12:19:01 31TM8600 0409
2010 Insight
The vehicle’s fuses are contained inthree fuse boxes.
The interior fuse box is behind thedashboard on the driver’s side.
The interior fuse box label isattached on the back side of thecover. To see the interior fuse boxlabel, remove the cover by pulling ittoward you while holding the bottomcenter part of cover.
CONTINUED
FusesTaking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
405
INTERIOR
COVER
LABEL
FUSE BOX
08/12/27 12:19:08 31TM8600 0410
2010 Insight
The under-hood fuse box is locatednext to the battery. To open it, pushthe tab as shown.
The under-hood fuse is on thepositive terminal of the battery. Toopen it, push the tabs as shown.
Fuses
406
TABUNDER-HOOD
TAB(On the battery)
Next to the battery
08/12/27 12:19:13 31TM8600 0411
2010 Insight
If something electrical in yourvehicle stops working, the first thingyou should check for is a blown fuse.Determine from the chart on pages
and , or the diagram on thefuse box lid, which fuse or fusescontrol that device. Check thosefuses first, but check all the fusesbefore deciding that a blown fuse isthe cause. Replace any blown fuses,and check if the device works.
Turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position. Make sure theheadlights and all otheraccessories are off.
Remove the cover from the under-hood fuse box located on thebattery (see page ).
Check each of the large fuses inthe under-hood fuse box on the 12volt battery by looking throughthe top at the wire inside.Replacement of these fuses shouldbe done by your dealer.
Check the smaller fuses in theunder-hood fuse boxes and all thefuses in the interior fuse box bypulling out each one with the fusepuller provided in the interior fusebox.
1. 2.
410 411
406
4.
3.
CONTINUED
Checking and Replacing Fuses
FusesTaking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
407
BLOWN
FUSE PULLER
08/12/27 12:19:22 31TM8600 0412
2010 Insight
If you cannot drive the vehiclewithout fixing the problem, and youdo not have a spare fuse, take a fuseof the same rating or a lower ratingfrom one of the other circuits. Makesure you can do without that circuittemporarily (such as the accessorypower socket or radio).
If you replace the blown fuse with aspare fuse that has a lower rating, itmight blow out again. This does notindicate anything wrong. Replace thefuse with one of the correct rating assoon as you can.
Look for a blown wire inside thefuse. If it is blown, replace the fusewith one of the spare fuses of thesame rating or lower.
The fuse puller is in the interior fusebox.
5.
Fuses
408
BLOWNFUSE PULLER
08/12/27 12:19:27 31TM8600 0413
2010 Insight
If the replacement fuse of thesame rating blows in a short time,there is probably a seriouselectrical problem with yourvehicle. Leave the blown fuse inthat circuit, and have your vehiclechecked by a qualified technician.
When the audio system is disabled,the clock setting in the audio systemwill be canceled. You will need toreset the clock according to theinstructions in the audio systemsection in this owner’s manual.
The navigation system will alsodisable itself. The next time you turnon the ignition switch, the systemwill require you to enter a PINbefore it can be used. Refer to thenavigation system manual.
If the radio fuse is removed, theaudio system will disable itself. Thenext time you turn on the radio, youmay see ‘‘ENTER CODE’’ in thefrequency display. Use the presetbuttons to enter the digit code (seepage ).
6.
253
On vehicles with navigation system
FusesTaking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
409
Replacing a f use with one that has ahigher rating greatly increases thechances of damaging the electricalsystem. If you do not have areplacement f use with the proper ratingf or the circuit, install one with a lowerrating.
08/12/27 12:19:33 31TM8600 0414
2010 Insight
-
--
-
-
**
*
*
*
No. No. Amps.Circuits ProtectedAmps. Circuits Protected1234567891011121314151617
18
19
202122
23242526272829303132333435363738394041424344
10 A10 A
10 A30 A20 A10 A30 A7.5 A10 A20 A10 A15 A15 A30 A15 A15 A
10 A7.5 A7.5 A
Back UpTPMSDriver’s Power WindowNot UsedBack Up LightSRSTransmission SOLOPDSNot UsedA/CABS/VSAIMAACC SocketAccessoryDaytime Running LightRear WiperFront Passenger’s PowerWindowRear Passenger’s SidePower WindowRear Driver’s Side PowerWindowFuel PumpWasherMeter
15 A(7.5 A)
20 A
10 A10 A10 A7.5 A
7.5 A7.5 A10 A20 A7.5 A7.5 A10 A20 A
20 A
20 A
15 A15 A7.5 A
HazardStop/HornNot UsedLAFDoor Lock MainHeadlight MainSmall LightRadiator Fan motorIGPSRight Headlight Low BeamIG CoilLeft Headlight Low BeamDoor Lock Motor 2 (Lock)Door Lock Motor 1 (Lock)ABS/VSA FSRSelectable Door LockIGPNot UsedNot UsedIMA 1MG ClutchSTS
1 : U.S. models2 : EX models
1
2
2
Fuse Locations
410
INTERIOR FUSE BOX
08/12/27 12:19:40 31TM8600 0415
2010 Insight
*
*
*
*
-
-
-
**
*
No. Circuits Protected
No.
Amps.
Circuits ProtectedAmps.
No. Amps. Circuits Protected12
Ignition Coil (EX)Ignition Coil (IN)
454647484950515253545556575859
6015 A15 A
Hatch LockNot UsedCondenser Fan MotorLeft Headlight High BeamDoor Lock Motor 2 (Unlock)Door Lock Motor 1 (Unlock)Right Headlight High BeamDBWIMA 2Not UsedHeated MirrorFront WiperBlower MotorABS/VSA MotorRear DefoggerRear DefoggerNot UsedIG Main
7.5 A
30 A10 A15 A15 A10 A15 A10 A
10 A30 A30 A30 A30 A40 A
50 A
123
100 A60 A20 A
Battery, Main, ACGEPSHorn, Stop, Hazard
1 :2 :
3 :
U.S. LX modelU.S. models except LX model and allCanadian modelsEX models
2
3
1
2
Fuse LocationsTaking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
411
UNDER-HOOD FUSE BOXES
On the battery Next to the battery
08/12/27 12:19:49 31TM8600 0416
2010 Insight
-
-
If, due to damage, your vehicle mustbe towed with the front wheels onthe ground, do this:
With the front wheels on the ground,it is best to tow the vehicle no fartherthan 50 miles (80 km), and keep thespeed below 35 mph (55 km/h).
If your vehicle needs to be towed,call a professional towing service ororganization. Never tow your vehiclewith just a rope or chain. It is verydangerous.
There are two ways to tow yourvehicle:
The towtruck uses two pivoting arms that gounder the tires (front) and lift themoff the ground. The other two tiresremain on the ground.
The operatorloads your vehicle on the back of atruck.
Start the engine.Press on the brake pedal. Movethe shift lever through all itspositions.Shift to D position and hold for 5seconds, then to N.Turn off the engine.Release the parking brake.Leave the ignition switch in theACCESSORY (I) position so thesteering wheel does not lock.Wheel-lif t Equipment
Flat-bed Equipment
This is anacceptable way to tow yourvehicle.
This is the best way totransport your vehicle.
Emergency Towing
412
Improper towing preparation willdamage the transmission. Follow theabove procedure exactly. If you cannotshif t the transmission or start theengine, your vehicle must betransported with the f ront wheels of fthe ground.
08/12/27 12:19:58 31TM8600 0417
2010 Insight
To use the towing hook:
Remove the cover from the frontbumper using your fingers, or pryit off using a cloth and a flat-tippedscrewdriver.
If your vehicle gets stuck in sand,mud, or snow, call a towing serviceto pull it out (see page ).
For very short distances, such asfreeing the vehicle, you can use thedetachable towing hook that mountson the anchor in the front bumper.
Remove the towing hook andwheel nut wrench from the toolcase in the cargo area.
1.
2.
412
CONTINUED
If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck
Emergency Towing, If Your Vehicle Gets StuckTaking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
413
Trying to lif t or tow your vehicle by thebumpers will cause serious damage.The bumpers are not designed tosupport the vehicle’s weight.
The steering system can be damaged ifthe steering wheel is locked. Leave theignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I)position, and make sure the steeringwheel turns f reely bef ore you begintowing.
08/12/27 12:20:07 31TM8600 0418
2010 Insight
Screw the towing hook into thehole, and tighten it with the wheelnut wrench.
3.
If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck
414
WHEELNUTWRENCH
To avoid damage to your vehicle, usethe towing hook f or straight, f latground towing only. Do not tow at anangle. The tow hook should not be usedto tow the vehicle onto a f lat bed. Donot use it as a tie down.
08/12/27 12:20:11 31TM8600 0419
2010 Insight
-
The diagrams in this section giveyou the dimensions and capacities ofyour vehicle and the locations of theidentification numbers. It alsoincludes information you shouldknow about your vehicle’s tires andemissions control systems.
................Identification Numbers . 416................................Specifications . 418
DOT Tire Quality Grading......................(U.S. Vehicles) . 420
Uniform Tire Quality..................................Grading . 420.................................Treadwear . 420
......................................Traction . 420.............................Temperature . 421
.................................Tire Labeling . 421Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) Required Federal............................Explanation . 423
.......................Emissions Controls . 425.....................The Clean Air Act . 425
Crankcase Emissions Control....................................System . 425
Evaporative Emissions Control....................................System . 425
Onboard Refueling Vapor................................Recovery . 425
...Exhaust Emissions Controls . 426....................PGM-FI System . 426
Ignition Timing Control................................System . 426
Exhaust Gas Recirculation...................(EGR) System . 426
Three Way Catalytic...........................Converter . 426
....................Replacement Parts . 426..Three Way Catalytic Converter . 427
........................Emissions Testing . 428
Technical InformationTechnicalInform
ation
415
08/12/27 12:20:15 31TM8600 0420
2010 Insight
Your vehicle has several identifyingnumbers in various places.
The vehicle identification number(VIN) is the 17-digit number yourdealer uses to register your vehiclefor warranty purposes. It is alsonecessary for licensing and insuringyour vehicle. The easiest place tofind the VIN is on a plate fastened tothe top of the dashboard. You cansee it by looking through thewindshield on the driver’s side. It isalso on the certification labelattached to the driver’s doorjamb,and is stamped on the enginecompartment bulkhead. The VIN isalso provided in bar code on thecertification label.
The VIN is also located on theengine bulkhead. Remove the coveron the engine compartmentbulkhead to view the VIN. Alwaysclose the cover when finished.
Identif ication Numbers
416
COVER
CERTIFICATION LABEL
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATIONNUMBER (VIN)
08/12/27 12:20:20 31TM8600 0421
2010 Insight
The engine number is stamped intothe engine block.
The transmission number is on alabel on top of the transmission.
The IMA Motor Number is stampedon the motor housing.
Identif ication NumbersTechnicalInform
ation
417
ENGINE NUMBER
TRANSMISSION NUMBER
IMA MOTOR NUMBER
08/12/27 12:20:25 31TM8600 0422
2010 Insight
*
*
*
*
Specifications
418
Dimensions
Weights
Seating Capacities
Capacities
Engine
172.3 in (4,377 mm)66.7 in (1,695 mm)56.2 in (1,427 mm)100.4 in (2,550 mm)58.7 in (1,492 mm)58.1 in (1,475 mm)
LengthWidthHeightWheelbaseTrack
Gross vehicle weight rating See the certification label attachedto the driver’s doorjamb.
3.4 US qt (3.2 )3.2 US qt (3.0 )4.0 US qt (3.8 )
TotalFrontRear
523
Excluding the oil remaining in the engine
Including the coolant in the reserve tank and that remaining in theengineReserve tank capacity: 0.116 US gal (0.44 )
2.6 US qt (2.5 )5.12 US qt (4.85 )
Fuel tank
EnginecoolantEngine oil
Automatictransmissionfluid (CVTF)Windshieldwasherreservoir
Type
Bore x StrokeDisplacementCompression ratioSpark plugs DILFR6F11G
10.8 : 182 cu-in (1,339 cm )
2.87 x 3.15 in (73.0 x 80.0 mm)
3.0 US qt (2.8 )5.5 US qt (5.2 )
10.6 US gal (40 )1.202 US gal (4.55 )1.332 US gal (5.04 )
Water cooled 4-stroke SOHCi-VTEC gasoline engine with
Hybrid Electric Motor
FrontRear
Approx.
1 :
2 :
(NGK)
ChangeTotalChange
Including filterWithout filter
TotalChangeTotal
U.S. VehiclesCanada Vehicles
1
2
08/12/27 12:20:41 31TM8600 0423
2010 Insight
- -
-
--
**
-----
-
------
-
*
*
*
*
*
*
SpecificationsTechnicalInform
ation
419
Air Conditioning
Tires
Alignment
Fuses
12 Volt Battery
Lights
HFC-134a (R-134a)15.8 17.6 oz (450 500 g)
SP-10
12 V 60 W
Refrigerant typeCharge quantityLubricant oil type
12 V 55 W
Size
Pressure
Toe-in
Camber
Caster
Interior
Under-hood
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )33 psi (230 kPa , 2.3 kgf/cm )
175/65R15 84S
3°20’1°
0°0.1 in (2.5 mm)0.00 in (0.0 mm)
Capacity 12 V12 V
35 AH/20 HR28 AH/5 HR
12 V 21 W
T135/80D15 99M
12 V 5 W
See page 410 or the fuse labelattached to the inside of the fusebox door under the steeringcolumn.See page 411 or the fuse boxcover.
Headlights
Front turn signal lightsFront parking lightsFront side marker lightsSide turn signal lights(door mirror)Rear turn signal lightsStop/taillightsBack-up lightsRear side marker lightsLicense plate lightsSpot lightsCeiling lightCargo area lightHigh-mount brake lightGlove box light 12 V 3.4 W
12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V12 V
5 W8 W8 W5 W2 CP16 W
12 V 21 W
Replacement of a light bulb should be done by your dealer.
5 W12 V
FrontRearFrontRearFront
HighLow
Front/RearSpareFront/RearSpare
1 :2 :
(HB3)(H11)(Amber)
LED type
LED type
LED type
EX models
(Amber)
1
1
1
2
2
2
08/12/27 12:21:04 31TM8600 0424
2010 Insight
Quality grades can be found whereapplicable on the tire sidewallbetween tread shoulder andmaximum section width. Forexample:
All passenger car tires must conformto Federal Safety Requirements inaddition to these grades.
The traction grades, from highest tolowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Thosegrades represent the tire’s ability tostop on wet pavement as measuredunder controlled conditions onspecified government test surfacesof asphalt and concrete. A tiremarked C may have poor tractionperformance.
Warning: The traction gradeassigned to this tire is based onstraight-ahead braking traction tests,and does not include acceleration,cornering, hydroplaning, or peaktraction characteristics.
The tires on your vehicle meet allU.S. Federal Safety Requirements.All tires are also graded fortreadwear, traction, and temperatureperformance according toDepartment of Transportation(DOT) standards. The followingexplains these gradings.
The treadwear grade is a compara-tive rating based on the wear rate ofthe tire when tested under controlledconditions on a specified governmenttest course. For example, a tiregraded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on thegovernment course as a tire graded100. The relative performance oftires depends upon the actual condi-tions of their use, however, and maydepart significantly from the normdue to variations in driving habits,service practices and differences inroad characteristics and climate.
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Treadwear 200Traction AATemperature A
Treadwear Traction
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
420
08/12/27 12:21:12 31TM8600 0425
2010 Insight
The temperature grades are A (thehighest), B, and C, representing thetire’s resistance to the generation ofheat and its ability to dissipate heatwhen tested under controlledconditions on a specified indoorlaboratory test wheel. Sustained hightemperature can cause the materialof the tire to degenerate and reducetire life, and excessive temperaturecan lead to sudden tire failure. Thegrade C corresponds to a level ofperformance which all passenger cartires must meet under the FederalMotor Vehicle Safety Standard No.109. Grades B and A representhigher levels of performance on thelaboratory test wheel than theminimum required by law.
Warning: The temperature grade forthis tire is established for a tire thatis properly inflated and notoverloaded. Excessive speed,underinflation, or excessive loading,either separately or in combination,can cause heat buildup and possibletire failure.
The tires that came on your vehiclehave a number of markings. Thoseyou should be aware of are describedbelow.
CONTINUED
Temperature Tire Labeling
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles), Tire Labeling
TechnicalInform
ation
421
(4) (3) (2)
(1)
(1)
(1)(2)(3)(4)
TIRE LABELING EXAMPLE
Tire Size
Maximum Tire PressureMaximum Tire Load
Tire Identification Number (TIN)
08/12/27 12:21:20 31TM8600 0426
2010 Insight
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Tire type code.
Date of manufacture.Whenever tires are replaced, theyshould be replaced with tires of thesame size. The following is anexample of tire size with anexplanation of what each componentmeans.
Load index (a numerical codeassociated with the maximumload the tire can carry).
Speed symbol (analphabetical code indicatingthe maximum speed rating).
The tire identification number (TIN)is a group of numbers and lettersthat look like the following example.TIN is located on the sidewall of thetire.
This indicates that the tiremeets all requirements ofthe U.S. Department ofTransportation.
Max Press The maximum airpressure the tire canhold.
Max Load The maximum load thetire can carry atmaximum air pressure.
YearWeek
Tire width in millimeters.
Aspect ratio (the tire’s sectionheight as a percentage of itswidth).
Tire construction code (Rindicates radial).
Rim diameter in inches.
Manufacturer’sidentification mark.
RDOT
2202
S
65
15
175
84
EUYU
2KNR
Tire Labeling
Tire Size
Tire Identif ication Number (TIN)
Maximum Tire Load
Maximum Tire Pressure
422
DOT EUYU 2KNR 2202
175/65R15 84S
08/12/27 12:21:35 31TM8600 0427
2010 Insight
-
As an added safety feature, yourvehicle has been equipped with a tirepressure monitoring system (TPMS)that illuminates a low tire pressuretelltale
when one or more of your tires issignificantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tirepressure telltale illuminates, youshould stop and check your tires assoon as possible, and inflate them tothe proper pressure.
(If your vehicle has tires of adifferent size than the size indicatedon the vehicle placard or tireinflation pressure label, you shoulddetermine the proper tire inflationpressure for those tires.)
Each tire, including the spare (ifprovided), should be checkedmonthly when cold and inflated tothe inflation pressure recommendedby the vehicle manufacturer on thevehicle placard or tire inflationpressure label.
CONTINUED
U.S. models only
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal ExplanationTechnicalInform
ation
423
08/12/27 12:21:42 31TM8600 0428
2010 Insight
-
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire tooverheat and can lead to tire failure.Under-inflation also reduces fuelefficiency and tire tread life, and mayaffect the vehicle’s handling andstopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not asubstitute for proper tiremaintenance, and it is the driver’sresponsibility to maintain correct tirepressure, even if under-inflation hasnot reached the level to triggerillumination of the TPMS low tirepressure telltale.
TPMS malfunctions may occur for avariety of reasons, including theinstallation of replacement oralternate tires or wheels on thevehicle that prevent the TPMS fromfunctioning properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunctiontelltale after replacing one or moretires or wheels on your vehicle toensure that the replacement oralternate tires and wheels allow theTPMS to continue to functionproperly.
Your vehicle has also been equippedwith a TPMS malfunction indicatorto indicate when the system is notoperating properly. The TPMSmalfunction indicator is combinedwith the low tire pressure telltale.When the system detects amalfunction, the telltale will flash forapproximately one minute and thenremain continuously illuminated.This sequence will continue uponsubsequent vehicle start-ups as longas the malfunction exists.
When the malfunction indicator isilluminated, the system may not beable to detect or signal low tirepressure as intended.
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation
424
08/12/27 12:21:47 31TM8600 0429
2010 Insight
*
*
The burning of gasoline in yourvehicle’s engine produces several by-products. Some of these are carbonmonoxide (CO), oxides of nitrogen(NOx), and hydrocarbons (HC).Gasoline evaporating from the tankalso produces hydrocarbons. Con-trolling the production of NOx, CO,and HC is important to the environ-ment. Under certain conditions ofsunlight and climate, NOx and HCreact to form photochemical ‘‘smog.’’Carbon monoxide does not contri-bute to smog creation, but it is apoisonous gas.
The United States Clean Air Actsets standards for automobileemissions. It also requires thatautomobile manufacturers explain toowners how their emissions controlswork and what to do to maintainthem. This section summarizes howthe emissions controls work.
In Canada, Honda vehicles complywith the Canadian emissionrequirements, as specified in anagreement with EnvironmentCanada, at the time they aremanufactured.
Your vehicle has a positivecrankcase ventilation system. Thiskeeps gasses that build up in theengine’s crankcase from going intothe atmosphere. The positivecrankcase ventilation valve routesthem from the crankcase back to the
intake manifold. They are thendrawn into the engine and burned.
As gasoline evaporates in the fueltank, an evaporative emissionscontrol canister filled with charcoaladsorbs the vapor. It is stored in thiscanister while the engine is off. Afterthe engine is started and warmed up,the vapor is drawn into the engineand burned during driving.
The onboard refueling vaporrecovery (ORVR) system capturesthe fuel vapors during refueling. Thevapors are adsorbed in a canisterfilled with activated carbon. Whiledriving, the fuel vapors are drawninto the engine and burned off.
The Clean Air Act
Crankcase Emissions ControlSystem
Evaporative Emissions ControlSystem
Onboard Refueling VaporRecovery
Emissions ControlsTechnicalInform
ation
425
08/12/27 12:21:55 31TM8600 0430
2010 Insight
The exhaust emissions controlsinclude four systems: PGM-FI,ignition timing control, exhaust gasrecirculation, and three way catalyticconverter. These four systems worktogether to control the engine’scombustion and minimize theamount of HC, CO, and NOx thatcome out the tailpipe. The exhaustemissions control systems areseparate from the crankcase andevaporative emissions controlsystems.
The emissions control systems aredesigned and certified to work to-gether in reducing emissions tolevels that comply with the Clean AirAct. To make sure the emissionsremain low, you should use only newHonda replacement parts or theirequivalent for repairs. Using lowerquality parts may increase theemissions from your vehicle.
The emissions control systems arecovered by warranties separate fromthe rest of your vehicle. Read yourwarranty manual for more informa-tion.The PGM-FI system uses sequential
multiport fuel injection.It has three subsystems: air intake,engine control, and fuel control. Thepowertrain control module (PCM)uses various sensors to determinehow much air is going into theengine. It then controls how muchfuel to inject under all operatingconditions.
This system constantly adjusts theignition timing, reducing the amountof HC, CO, and NOx produced.
The exhaust gas recirculation (EGR)system takes some of the exhaustgas and routes it back into the intakemanifold. Adding exhaust gas to theair/fuel mixture reduces the amountof NOx produced when the fuel isburned.
The three way catalytic converter isin the exhaust system. Throughchemical reactions, it converts HC,CO, and NOx in the engine’s exhaustto carbon dioxide (CO ), nitrogen(N ), and water vapor.
2
2
Exhaust Emissions Controls Replacement Parts
PGM-FI System
Ignition Timing Control System
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)System
Three Way Catalytic Converter
Emissions Controls
426
08/12/27 12:22:05 31TM8600 0431
2010 Insight
The three way catalytic convertercontains precious metals that serveas catalysts, promoting chemicalreactions to convert the exhaustgasses without affecting the metals.The catalytic converter is referred toas a three-way catalyst, since it actson HC, CO, and NOx. A replacementunit must be an original Honda partor its equivalent.
The three way catalytic convertermust operate at a high temperaturefor the chemical reactions to takeplace. It can set on fire anycombustible materials that comenear it. Park your vehicle away fromhigh grass, dry leaves, or otherflammables.
A defective three way catalyticconverter contributes to air pollution,and can impair your engine’s per-formance. Follow these guidelines toprotect your vehicle’s three waycatalytic converter.
Always use unleaded gasoline.Even a small amount of leadedgasoline can contaminate thecatalyst metals, making the threeway catalytic converter ineffective.
Keep the engine well maintained.
Have your vehicle diagnosed andrepaired if it is misfiring, back-firing, stalling, or otherwise notrunning properly.
Three Way Catalytic ConverterTechnicalInform
ation
427
THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTERS
U.S. model is shown.
08/12/27 12:22:13 31TM8600 0432
2010 Insight
If you take your vehicle for anemissions test shortly after thebattery has been disconnected orgone dead, it may not pass the test.This is because of certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that must be set in the on-board diagnostics for the emissionssystems. These codes are erasedwhen the battery is disconnected,and set again only after several daysof driving under a variety ofconditions.
Without touching the acceleratorpedal, start the engine, and let itidle for 20 seconds.
Keep the vehicle in Park. Increasethe engine speed to 2,000 rpm, andhold it there until the temperaturegauge rises to at least 1/4 of thescale (about 3 minutes).
Without touching the acceleratorpedal, let the engine idle for 20seconds.
If the testing facility determines thatthe readiness codes are not set, youwill be requested to return at a laterdate to complete the test. If you mustget the vehicle retested within thenext two or three days, you cancondition the vehicle for retesting bydoing the following.
Make sure the gas tank is nearly,but not completely, full (around3/4).
Make sure the vehicle has beenparked with the engine off for 6hours or more.
Make sure the ambienttemperature is between 40° and95°F (4° and 35°C).
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Testing of Readiness Codes
Emissions Testing
428
08/12/27 12:22:20 31TM8600 0433
2010 Insight
Select a nearby lightly traveledmajor highway where you canmaintain a speed of 50 to 60 mph(80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20minutes. Drive on the highway inD. Do not use the cruise control.When traffic allows, drive for 90seconds without moving theaccelerator pedal. (Vehicle speedmay vary slightly; this is okay.) Ifyou cannot do this for acontinuous 90 seconds because oftraffic conditions, drive for at least30 seconds, then repeat it twomore times (for a total of 90seconds).
Then drive in city/suburbantraffic for at least 10 minutes.When traffic conditions allow, letthe vehicle coast for severalseconds without using theaccelerator pedal or the brakepedal.
Make sure the vehicle has beenparked with the engine off for 30minutes.
If the testing facility determines thereadiness codes are still not set, seeyour dealer.
7. 8.
9.
Emissions TestingTechnicalInform
ation
429
08/12/27 12:22:26 31TM8600 0434
2010 Insight
430
08/12/27 12:22:28 31TM8600 0435
2010 Insight
....Customer Service Information . 432....................Warranty Coverages . 433
Reporting Safety Defects..........................(U.S. Vehicles) . 434
.....................Authorized Manuals . 435
Warranty and Customer RelationsW
arrantyand
Custom
erR
elations
431
08/12/27 12:22:30 31TM8600 0436
2010 Insight
Honda dealership personnel aretrained professionals. They shouldbe able to answer all your questions.If you encounter a problem that yourdealership does not solve to yoursatisfaction, please discuss it withthe dealership’s management. Theservice manager or general managercan help. Almost all problems aresolved in this way.
If you are dissatisfied with thedecision made by the dealership’smanagement, contact HondaCustomer Service.
U.S. Owners:
Canadian Owners: When you call or write, please giveus this information:
Vehicle Identification Number(see page )
Name and address of the dealerwho services your vehicle
Date of purchase
Odometer reading of your vehicle
Your name, address, and tele-phone number
A detailed description of theproblem
Name of the dealer who sold thevehicle to you
In Puerto Rico and the U.S. VirginIslands:
416
Customer Service Information
432
American Honda Motor Co., Inc.Honda Automobile Customer ServiceMail Stop 500-2N-7A1919 Torrance BoulevardTorrance, California 90501-2746
Tel: (800) 999-1009
Honda Canada Inc.
Visit www.honda.ca for contactinformation
Tel: 1-888-9-HONDA-9Fax: Toll-free 1-877-939-0909
Bella InternationalP.O. Box 190816San Juan, PR 00919-0816
Tel: (787) 620-7546
Customer Relations
09/01/08 14:21:30 31TM8600 0437
2010 Insight
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Your new vehicle is covered by thesewarranties:
covers your new vehicle, except forthe battery, emissions controlsystems, and accessories, againstdefects in materials andworkmanship.
these twowarranties cover your vehicle’semissions control systems. Time,mileage, and coverage areconditional. Please read yourwarranty booklet for exactinformation.
providescoverage for as long as the pur-chaser of the muffler owns thevehicle.
provides proratedcoverage for a replacement batterypurchased from your dealer.
this warranty gives upto 100% credit toward a replacementbattery.
a seatbelt that fails to function properly iscovered by a limited warranty.Please read your warranty bookletfor details.
covers all Hondareplacement parts against defects inmaterials and workmanship.
Honda accessories are coveredunder this warranty. Time andmileage limits depend on the type ofaccessory and other factors. Pleaseread your warranty booklet fordetails.
all exterior body panels arecovered for rust-through from theinside for the specified time periodwith no mileage limit.
Restrictions and exclusions apply toall these warranties. Please read the2010 Honda warranty informationbooklet that came with your vehiclefor precise information on warrantycoverages. Your vehicle’s originaltires are covered by theirmanufacturer. Tire warrantyinformation is in a separate booklet.
Please refer to the 2010 warrantymanual that came with your vehicle.
Warranty Coverages
U.S. Owners
Canadian Owners
New Vehicle Limited Warranty
Emissions Control Systems DefectsWarranty and EmissionsPerformance Warranty
Replacement Muffler LifetimeLimited Warranty
Replacement Battery LimitedWarranty
Original Equipment Battery LimitedWarranty
Seat Belt Limited Warranty
Replacement Parts LimitedWarranty
Accessory Limited Warranty
Rust Perforation Limited Warranty
Warranty
andC
ustomer
Relations
433
09/01/13 09:16:33 31TM8600 0438
2010 Insight
If NHTSA receives similar com-plaints, it may open an investigation,and if it finds that a safety defectexists in a group of vehicles, it mayorder a recall and remedy campaign.However, NHTSA cannot becomeinvolved in individual problemsbetween you, your dealer, orAmerican Honda Motor Co., Inc.
If you believe that your vehicle has adefect which could cause a crash orcould cause injury or death, youshould immediately inform theNational Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration (NHTSA) in additionto notifying American Honda MotorCo., Inc.
To contact NHTSA, you may call theVehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at1-888-327-4236(TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to
; or write to:Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 NewJersey Avenue, SE., Washington, DC20590.You can also obtain otherinformation about motor vehiclesafety from .
Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Vehicles)
434
http://www.saf ercar.gov
http://www.saf ercar.gov
08/12/27 12:22:53 31TM8600 0439
2010 Insight
The publications shown below can be purchased from HelmIncorporated. You can order by phone or online:
Call Helm Inc. at 1-800-782-4356 (credit card orders only)Go online at
If you are interested in other years or models, contact Helm Inc.at 1-800-782-4356.
Covers maintenance and recommended procedures forrepair to engine and chassis components. It is writtenfor the journeyman mechanic, but it is simple enoughfor most mechanically inclined owners to understand.
Complements the Service Manual by providing in-depthtroubleshooting information for each electrical circuitin your vehicle.
Describes the procedures involved in the replacementof damaged body parts.
Purchasing Factory Authorized Manuals Service Manual:
Electrical Troubleshooting Manual:
Body Repair Manual:
(U.S. only)
Authorized ManualsA
uthorizedM
anuals
435
Publication
Form Number
61TM800
61TM800EL
61TMA30
31TM8600
31TM8800
31TM8M00
31TM8Q00
HON-R
Form Description
2010 Honda Insight Service Manual
2010 Honda Insight
Electrical Troubleshooting Manual
2010 Model Series Honda Insight
Body Repair Manual
2010 Honda Insight Owner’s Manual
2010 Honda Insight
Navigation System Owner’s Manual
2010 Honda Insight Honda Service History
2010 Honda Insight Technology Reference Guide
Order Form for Previous Years-
Indicate Year and Model Desired
www. helminc. com
09/01/13 09:16:45 31TM8600 0440
2010 Insight
436
08/12/27 12:23:05 31TM8600 0441
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
....................................Accessories . 293ACCESSORY (Ignition Key
.....................................Position) . 128.............Accessory Power Socket . 153
................Active Head Restraints . 141....................Additives, Engine Oil . 348
.............................Airbag (SRS) . 10, 25...Airbags, Additional Information . 25...Additional Safety Precautions . 37
..........Advanced Airbag System . 30.............................Airbag Service . 36
How the Passenger Airbag Off......................Indicator Works . 35
How the Side Airbag Off......................Indicator Works . 34
..How the SRS Indicator Works . 34How Your Front Airbags
.........................................Work . 28...How Your Side Airbags Work . 32
How Your Side Curtain Airbags.........................................Work . 33
........................SRS Components . 25..............Air Conditioning System . 160
.......................Air Pressure, Tires . 376
................................Ambient Meter . 72......................................Antifreeze . 353
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)...............................Indicator . 64, 326
...................................Operation . 326..............Anti-theft, Audio System . 253
Anti-theft Steering Column............................................Lock . 128..........................................Armrest . 143
................................Audio System . 166.......................Auto Door Locking . 107
...................Auto Door Unlocking . 108................................Auto Idle Stop . 321
...Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners . 23.............Automatic Speed Control . 257
.Automatic Transmission (CVT) . 311..........................Capacity, Fluid . 418
...............Checking Fluid Level . 356Paddle Shifters in the
..............................D Position . 316Paddle Shifters in the
...............................S Position . 319.....Recommended Shift Points . 320
.......................................Shifting . 312Shift Lever Position
...............................Indicators . 311
................Shift Lever Positions . 313....................Shift Lock Release . 315
......................Auxiliary Input Jack . 252
BatteryCharging System
...........................Indicator . 63, 402............................Jump Starting . 396
..............................Maintenance . 381............................Specifications . 419
..............................Before Driving . 283....................................Belts, Seat . 9, 21
...........................Beverage Holder . 149.......Bluetooth HandsFreeLink . 259
Brakes...........Anti-lock System (ABS) . 326
.............Break-in, New Linings . 284....................Bulb Replacement . 365
...........................................Fluid . 357...................Pad Wear Indicator . 325
.......................................Parking . 148...........System Indicator . 63, 64, 404
Index
A
B
IND
EX
I
08/12/27 12:23:10 31TM8600 0442
2010 Insight
.............................Braking System . 324.................Break-in, New Vehicle . 284
Brightness Control,...............................Instruments . 121
Bulb Replacement..........................Back-up Lights . 365
..............................Brake Lights . 365........Front Side Marker Lights . 364.........Front Turn Signal Lights . 363
.................................Headlights . 359..........................Parking Lights . 362
..........Rear Turn Signal Lights . 365............................Specifications . 419
..............................Bulbs, Halogen . 359
.........................................Card, PC . 215.........................Cargo Area Cover . 150..........................Cargo Area Light . 158
............................Capacities Chart . 418.............Carbon Monoxide Hazard . 56
.............................Carrying Cargo . 295.............CAUTION, Explanation of . iii
..................................Ceiling Light . 157...............................Center Pocket . 155
...................................Center Tray . 155........................Certification Label . 416
............................................Chains . 379....................Changing a Flat Tire . 387
Changing Oil........................................How to . 350......................................When to . 337
...Charging System Indicator . 63, 402............Checklist, Before Driving . 302
.....................................Child Safety . 38Child Seats
.............LATCH Anchor System . 47.............................Lower Anchor . 47............................Tether Anchor . 50
................Childproof Door Locks . 131.............................Climate Control . 160
.........................Clock, Setting the . 254........................CO in the Exhaust . 425
............Cold Weather, Starting in . 303..............................Compact Spare . 386
.................Console Compartment . 154.............Controls, Instruments and . 59
Coolant........................................Adding . 353
....................................Checking . 289.........................Proper Solution . 353
...............Temperature Indicator . 67Crankcase Emissions Control
........................................System . 425............Cruise Control Operation . 256
.........................Customer Service . 432
...............DANGER, Explanation of . iii...................................Dashboard . 3, 60
..............Daytime Running Lights . 120............Defects, Reporting Safety . 434
..............Defogger, Rear Window . 123
..............Defrosting the Windows . 163....................................Dimensions . 418
.............Dimming the Headlights . 119Dipstick
..........Automatic Transmission . 356..................................Engine Oil . 288
........................Directional Signals . 118Disc Brake Pad Wear
...................................Indicators . 325............................Disc Player . 173, 204
.....................Disposal of Used Oil . 352
Index
C
D
II
08/12/27 12:23:16 31TM8600 0443
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
Doors...........Auto Door Locking . 107, 130
.......Auto Door Unlocking . 108, 130............Childproof Door Locks . 131............Locking and Unlocking . 130..........DOT Tire Quality Grading . 421
...........Driver and Passenger Safety . 5...........................................Driving . 301
....................................Economy . 290..................Dust and Pollen Filter . 370
.......Eco Guide Feedback Monitor . 73Ecological Drive Assist System
..........................(ECON Assist) . 304................................ECON Button . 124
..................................ECON Mode . 124..............................Economy, Fuel . 290
............Emergencies on the Road . 385.............Battery, Jump Starting . 396.....Brake System Indicator . 63, 404
................Changing a Flat Tire . 387Charging System
...........................Indicator . 63, 402..................Checking the Fuses . 407
Low Oil Pressure...........................Indicator . 62, 401
Malfunction Indicator................................Lamp . 62, 403
..................Overheated Engine . 398.........................Emergency Brake . 148
....................Emergency Flashers . 122...........Emergency Hatch Opener . 137
......................Emergency Towing . 412.......................Emissions Controls . 425........................Emissions Testing . 428
Engine............Adding Engine Coolant . 353
Coolant Temperature...................................Indicator . 67
.........................If It Won’t Start . 394Malfunction Indicator
................................Lamp . 62, 403.........................Oil Life Display . 337
........Oil Pressure Indicator . 62, 401
..............Oil, What Kind to Use . 348...............................Overheating . 398
............................Specifications . 418
............................Speed Limiter . 314.......................................Starting . 303
.Evaporative Emissions Controls . 425
...............................Exhaust Fumes . 56Expectant Mothers, Use of Seat
........................................Belts by . 19
...................................Fan, Interior . 162.........................................Features . 159
....................Filling the Fuel Tank . 285Filters
.........................Dust and Pollen . 370...............................................Oil . 350
...........Flashers, Hazard Warning . 122...................Flat Tire, Changing a . 387
.....................................Floor Mats . 369Fluids
..........Automatic Transmission . 356..........................................Brake . 357
..................Windshield Washer . 355FM Stereo Radio
...................................Reception . 246........................Four-way Flashers . 122
............................Front Airbags . 10, 25
Index
F
E
IND
EX
III
08/12/27 12:23:21 31TM8600 0444
2010 Insight
.................................................Fuel . 284......................Fill Door and Cap . 285
...........................................Gauge . 73................Octane Requirement . 284
...............................Oxygenated . 284........................Reserve Indicator . 70
........................Tank, Filling the . 285.....................Fuses, Checking the . 407
.............Halogen Headlight Bulbs . 359...........................HandsFreeLink . 259
..............................................Hatch . 136......................................Opening . 136
............................Open Indicator . 68............Hazard Warning Flashers . 122
Headlights........................................Aiming . 359
.........Daytime Running Lights . 120..................High Beam Indicator . 69
......................Reminder Beeper . 119........Replacing Halogen Bulbs . 359
.................................Turning on . 119............................Head Restraints . 139.............................Heated Mirrors . 145
.............High Altitude, Starting at . 303...............High-Low Beam Switch . 118
.......................Hood, Opening the . 287....................................................Horn . 4
...............Gas Mileage, Improving . 290.........................................Gasoline . 284
...............Fuel Reserve Indicator . 70...........................................Gauge . 73
................Octane Requirement . 284........................Tank, Filling the . 285
................Gas Station Procedures . 285Gauges
.............................Charge/Assist . 74...............................................Fuel . 73
............Gearshift Lever Positions . 311..........Automatic Transmission . 311
......................................Glove Box . 154...Identification Number, Vehicle . 416
Ignition............................................Keys . 126
.........................................Switch . 128............Timing Control System . 426
IMA System Power Flow........................................Monitor . 84
......................Immobilizer System . 127.........Important Safety Precautions . 6
.........Indicators, Instrument Panel . 62
...Indicators, Messages (MID) . 62, 89...............ABS (Anti-lock Brake) . 64
..............................Auto Idle Stop . 66Brake (Parking and Brake
............................System) . 63, 404.............................Cruise Control . 69
.................................Cruise Main . 69................Door/Hatch Open . 12, 68
DRL (Daytime Running....................................Lights) . 120
.EPS (Electric Power Steering) . 68................................ECON Mode . 71
...................................High Beam . 69....High Temperature (Coolant) . 67
......................IMA Battery Level . 85.................................IMA System . 66
........Key (Immobilizer System) . 63
Index
I
H
G
IV
08/12/27 12:23:27 31TM8600 0445
2010 Insight
CONTINUED
Indicators, Messages (MID).....................................Lights On . 69......................................Low Fuel . 70
................Low Oil Pressure . 62, 401.....Low Temperature (Coolant) . 67
Low Tire Pressure/...............................TPMS . 66, 328
...Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 403..........................Security System . 70...........................Side Airbag Off . 65
.................................Seat Belt . 21, 62.........................................SRS . 34, 64
.........................System Message . 70.................................TPMS . 328, 329
Turn Signal and Hazard...................................Warning . 69
12 Volt Battery Charging..............................System . 63, 402
........................................VSA Off . 65.................................VSA System . 65...............................Infant Restraint . 43
Infant Seats......LATCH Anchorage System . 47
...........................Lower Anchors . 47
...........................Tether Anchors . 51
.....Inflation, Recommended Tire . 376...................................Pressures . 376
........................Information Display . 72.................................Inside Mirror . 144
.............................Inspection, Tire . 376............................Instrument Panel . 61
................Instrument Panel Lights . 62......Instrument Panel Brightness . 121
...............................Interior Lights . 157........................................Introduction . i
.......................................iPod . 181, 229
.......................Label, Certification . 416...............Lane Change, Signaling . 119
..................Lap/Shoulder Belts . 17, 22...........LATCH Anchorage System . 47
Lights....................Bulb Replacement . 359
.......................................Indicator . 62.......................................Parking . 118
................................Turn Signal . 118....................................Load Limits . 296
....LOCK (Ignition Key Position) . 128Locks
.....Anti-theft Steering Column . 128............................Fuel Fill Door . 286
..........................................Hatch . 136...............................Power Door . 130
........................Low Coolant Level . 289.........................Low Fuel Indicator . 70
................................Lower Anchors . 47...Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 62, 401
...Lubricant Specifications Chart . 418
................................................Keys . 127
.................Jacking up the Vehicle . 389.......................................Jack, Tire . 388
................................Jump Starting . 396
Index
J
K
L
IND
EX
V
08/12/27 12:23:33 31TM8600 0446
2010 Insight
..................................Maintenance . 335......Main Items and Sub Items . 342
........................................Minder . 337Owner’s Maintenance
...................................Checks . 345..........................................Safety . 336
.Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 62, 403.........................Meters, Gauges . 61, 72
...................Methanol in Gasoline . 284...........................................Mirrors . 144
....................................Adjusting . 144........................................Heated . 145
...MP3/WMA . 175, 190, 206, 217, 239
...................Neutral Gear Position . 313..................New Vehicle Break-in . 284
...................NOTICE, Explanation of . i...............Numbers, Identification . 416
...Octane Requirement, Gasoline . 284
.........................................Odometer . 73Oil
........................Change, How to . 350......................Change, When to . 337......................Checking Engine . 288..............Pressure Indicator . 62, 401
.......Selecting Proper Viscosity . 349.........ON (Ignition Key Position) . 128
Onboard Refueling Vapor....................................Recovery . 425
............................Outside Mirrors . 144....Outside Temperature Indicator . 80
....................Overheating, Engine . 398....Owner’s Maintenance Checks . 345
.........................Oxygenated Fuels . 284
..............................Paddle Shifters . 316............Panel Brightness Control . 121
........................Park Gear Position . 313...........................................Parking . 323
...............................Parking Brake . 148Parking Brake and Brake
.................System Indicator . 63, 404...............................Parking Lights . 118
..Parking Over Things that Burn . 323.............................PGM-FI System . 426
..................Playing the Radio . 166, 198........................Playing a Disc . 173, 204
...................Playing an iPod . 181, 229.........................Playing a PC Card . 215
Playing a USB Flash Memory................................Device . 188, 237
...................................Pollen Filter . 370.........Pregnancy, Using Seat Belts . 19.........Protecting Adults and Teens . 12
...Additional Safety Precautions . 20.....Advice for Pregnant Women . 19
........................Protecting Children . 38.......................Protecting Infants . 43
.......Protecting Larger Children . 52.........Protecting Small Children . 44
...................Radiator Overheating . 398.Radio/Disc/Sound System . 166, 198
.................Radio Theft Protection . 253...................Readiness Codes . 403, 428
Rear Lights, Bulb..............................Replacement . 365
Index
O
P
R
M
N
VI
08/12/27 12:23:39 31TM8600 0447
2010 Insight
CONTINUED..................................Safety Belts . 9, 21
............Safety Defects, Reporting . 434.................................Safety Features . 8
.........................................Airbags . 10.......................................Seat Belts . 9
.............Safety Labels, Location of . 57..............................Safety Messages . iii
.....................................Seat Belts . 9, 21...............Additional Information . 21
Automatic Seat Belt...............................Tensioners . 23
.....................................Cleaning . 369................Lap/Shoulder Belt . 17, 22
........................Maintenance . 24, 369Reminder Light and
................................Beeper . 21, 62...................System Components . 21
...............Use During Pregnancy . 19Wearing a Lap/Shoulder
.....................................Belt . 17, 22......................Seats, Adjusting the . 138
............................Security System . 255...............................Serial Number . 416
...........................Service Intervals . 346.............................Service Manual . 435
.........Service Station Procedures . 285..........................Setting the Clock . 254
...Shift Lever Position Indicators . 311........................Shift Lock Release . 315
..............................Side Airbags . 10, 32..........................Off Indicator . 34, 65
......................Side Curtain Airbags . 33Side Marker Lights, Bulb
..............................Replacement . 359.............................Signaling Turns . 119
.....................................Snow Tires . 379Spare Tire
......................................Inflating . 386............................Specifications . 419
....................Specifications Charts . 418................................Speed Control . 256
Speed-Sensitive Volume.......Compensation (SVC) . 172, 202
.......................................Spotlights . 157
..........................Rear View Mirror . 144...............Rear Window Defogger . 123..............Reclining the Seat-backs . 138
.........Recommended Shift Points . 320................Remote Audio Controls . 251
.....................Remote Transmitter . 132Replacement Information
..............Dust and Pollen Filter . 370................Engine Oil and Filter . 350
..........................................Fuses . 407................................Light Bulbs . 359
................Maintenance Minder . 337...........................................Tires . 375
.............................Wiper Blades . 370Replacing Seat Belts After a
............................................Crash . 24.............Reporting Safety Defects . 434
Reserve Tank, Engine...............................Coolant . 289, 353
...............................Restraint, Child . 38..................Reverse Gear Position . 313
................................Rotation, Tire . 378
IndexIN
DE
XS
VII
08/12/27 12:23:44 31TM8600 0448
2010 Insight
..........SRS, Additional Information . 25...Additional Safety Precautions . 37
..........Advanced Airbag System . 30.............................Airbag Service . 36
How the Passenger Airbag Off......................Indicator Works . 35
How the Side Airbag Off......................Indicator Works . 34
..How the SRS Indicator Works . 34How Your Front Airbags
.........................................Work . 28...How Your Side Airbags Work . 32
How Your Side Curtain..........................Airbags Work . 33........................SRS Components . 25
.............................SRS Indicator . 34, 64..START (Ignition Key Position) . 128
.......................Starting the Engine . 303In Cold Weather at High
..................................Altitude . 303................With a Dead Battery . 396
........Steam Coming from Engine . 398Steering Wheel
................................Adjustment . 125...........Anti-theft Column Lock . 128
....................Storing Your Vehicle . 383
......................................Sun Visors . 156Supplemental Restraint
......................................System . 25
......................................Servicing . 36.........................SRS Indicator . 34, 64
............System Components . 10, 25.........................................SVC . 172, 202
..................................Synthetic Oil . 349
Taillights, Changing..........................................Bulbs . 365
.Taking Care of the Unexpected . 385Technical Descriptions
......DOT Tire Quality Grading . 420.....Emissions Control Systems . 425
.....................Oxygenated Fuels . 284..........State Emissions Testing . 428
Three Way Catalytic...............................Converter . 427
...................Temperature Indicator . 67..............Tether Anchorage Points . 50
............................Theft Protection . 253..Three Way Catalytic Converter . 427
Tighten Fuel.............................Cap Message . 286
..........................Time, Setting the . 254....................................Tire Chains . 379
.........Tire, How to Change a Flat . 387...........................Tire Information . 420
.................................Tire Labeling . 421Tire Pressure Monitoring
............System (TPMS) . 328, 423.............................Check TPMS . 329
Low Tire Pressure/TPMS...........................Indicator . 66, 328
Required Federal............................Explanation . 423
...............................................Tires . 375..............................Air Pressure . 376
........................................Chains . 379.........................Checking Wear . 377..........................Compact Spare . 386
......DOT Tire Quality Grading . 420......................................Inflation . 375
..................................Inspection . 376..............................Maintenance . 377
...................................Replacing . 378......................................Rotating . 378
................................Service Life . 377
Index
T
VIII
08/12/27 12:23:48 31TM8600 0449
2010 Insight
Tires...........................................Snow . 379
............................Specifications . 419...................Tools, Tire Changing . 388
Towing.....................................A Trailer . 334
..................Emergency Towing . 412Transmission
Checking Fluid Level,..............................Automatic . 356
...........................Fluid Selection . 356..............Identification Number . 417.............Shifting the Automatic . 312
.....................................Treadwear . 377
.................................Trip Meter . 78, 79..................................Turn Signals . 119
Unexpected, Taking Care..........................................of the . 385
....Uniform Tire Quality Grading . 420........................Unleaded Gasoline . 284..............USB Adapter Cable . 191, 240
.USB Flash Memory Device . 189, 238.......Used Oil, How to Dispose of . 352
................................Vanity Mirror . 156.................Vehicle Capacity Load . 296
......................Vehicle Dimensions . 418....Vehicle Identification Number . 416
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA )....................................System . 332
...VSA Activation Indicator . 65, 332.........................VSA Off Switch . 333
........VSA System Indicator . 65, 332.............................Vehicle Storage . 383
.....................................Ventilation . 163.................................................VIN . 416
..................................Viscosity, Oil . 349
............WARNING, Explanation of . iii.........Warning Labels, Location of . 57
....................Warranty Coverages . 433Washer, Windshield
........Checking the Fluid Level . 355...................................Operation . 117
Wheels.............Adjusting the Steering . 125
............Alignment and Balance . 377.....................................Cleaning . 380
..........................Compact Spare . 386...............................Nut Wrench . 388
Windows.............................Auto Reverse . 147
................Operating the Power . 146.........................Rear, Defogger . 163
Windshield.....................................Cleaning . 117...................................Defroster . 164
.....................................Washers . 117Wipers, Windshield
.......................Changing Blades . 370...................................Operation . 117....................................Worn Tires . 376
.....Wrecker, Emergency Towing . 413
IndexIN
DE
X
WU
V
IX
08/12/27 12:23:54 31TM8600 0450
2010 Insight
Service Information Summary
Gasoline:
Fuel Tank Capacity:
Brake Fluid:
Tire Pressure (measured cold):Recommended Engine Oil:
Automatic Transmission Fluid(CVTF):
33 psi (230 kPa , 2.3 kgf/cm )
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
Honda Heavy Duty Brake FluidDOT 3 preferred, or a DOT 3 orDOT 4 brake fluid as a temporaryreplacement (see page ).
Front/Rear:
Spare Tire:
Unleaded gasoline, pump octanenumber of 87 or higher.
API Premium grade 0W-20detergent oil (see page ).
Oil change capacity (includingfilter):
3.4 US qt (3.2 )
Use Honda CVT Fluid(Continuously VariableTransmission Fluid) only
Fluid change capacity:3.0 US qt (2.8 )
10.6 US gal (40 )
348
357
08/12/27 12:24:09 31TM8600 0453
2010 Insight
This owner’s manual should beconsidered a permanent part of thevehicle and should remain with thevehicle when it is sold.
The information and specificationsincluded in this publication were ineffect at the time of approval forprinting. Honda Motor Co., Ltd.reserves the right, however, todiscontinue or change specificationsor design at any time without noticeand without incurring any obligationwhatsoever.
This owner’s manual covers allmodels of the Insight. You may finddescriptions of equipment andfeatures that are not on yourparticular model.
Owner’s Identif ication
OWNER
ADDRESS
V. I. N.
DELIVERY DATE
DEALER NAME DEALER NO.
ADDRESS
OWNER’S SIGNATURE
DEALER’S SIGNATURE
STREET
CITY STATE/PROVINCE/TERRITORY ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE
(Date sold to original retail purchaser)
STREET
CITY STATE/PROVINCE/TERRITORY ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE
08/12/27 11:26:03 31TM8600 0001
2010 Insight